Bibliography for VERTEBRATA
The VERTEBRATA bibliography is also available in CSV format.
- ABRS 2001. Census of Australian Vertebrates. Australian Biological Resources Study.
- Aarn [no initial] & Ivantsoff, W. 1996. Descriptive anatomy of Rhadinocentrus ornatus (Osteichthyes: Melanotaeniidae). Ichthyological Explorations of Freshwater 7(1): 41-58
- Aarn [no initial] & Ivantsoff, W. 1997. Descriptive anatomy of Cairnsichthys rhombosomoides and Iriatherina werneri (Teleostei: Atheriniformes), and a phylogenetic analysis of Melanotaeniidae. Ichthyological Explorations of Freshwater 8(2): 107-250
- Abbott, C.C. 1860. Description of new species of apodal fishes in the museum of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 12: 475-479 [Date published 30/Nov/1860]
- Abbott, I. 1972. Birds of Bass Strait. Evolution and ecology of the avifaunas of some Bass Strait islands, and comparisons with those of Tasmania and Victoria. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Victoria 85: 197-223
- Abbott, I. 2002. Origin and spread of the cat, Felis catus, on mainland Australia, with a discussion of the early impact on native fauna. Wildlife Research 29: 51-74
- Abe, T. 1952. Taxonomic studies on the puffers (Tetraodontidae, Teleostei) from Japan and adjacent regions. VII. Concluding remarks, with the introduction of two new genera, Fugu and Boesemanichthys. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 2(1): 35-44 figs 1-3
- Abe, T. 1953. New, rare or uncommon fishes from Japanese waters. II. Records of rare fishes of the families Diretmidae, Luvaridae and Tetragonuridae, with an appendix (description of a new species, Tetragonurus pacificus, from off the Solomon Islands). Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 3(1): 39-47
- Abe, T. 1960. Description of a new lutjanid fish of the genus Paracaesio from Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 8: 56-62
- Abe, T. 1966. Description of a new squaloid shark, Centroscyllium kamoharai from Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 13(4/6): 190-194 figs 1-8
- Abe, T. & Haneda, Y. 1972. Descriptions of two new species of the ponyfish genus Leiognathus from Indonesia. Science Reports of the Yokosuka City Museum 19: 1-7 figs 1-2
- Abe, T. & Hotta, H. 1963. Description of a new deep-sea fish of the genus Rondeletia from Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 10(2–6): 43-48 pls 11-12
- Abensperg-Traun, M. 1989. Some observations on the duration of lactation and movement of a Tachyglossus aculeatus acanthion (Monotremata: Tachyglossidae) from Western Australia. Australian Mammalogy 12: 33-34
- Abensperg-Traun, M. 1991. A study of home range, movements and shelter use in adult and juvenile echidnas, Tachyglossus aculeatus (Monotremata: Tachyglossidae), in Western Australian wheatbelt reserves. Australian Mammalogy 14: 13-21
- Abensperg-Traun, M. 1991. Survival strategies of the echidna Tachyglossus aculeatus (Monotremata: Tachyglossidae). Biological Conservation 58: 317-328
- Abensperg-Traun, M. & Steven, D. 1997. Ant- and termite-eating in Australian mammals and lizards: A comparison. Australian Journal of Ecology 22: 9-17
- Abensperg-Traun, M., Dickman, C.R. & De Boer, E.S. 1991. Patch use and prey defence in a mammalian myrmecophage, the echidna (Tachyglossus aculeatus) (Monotremata: Tachyglossidae): a test of foraging efficiency in captive and free-ranging animals. Journal of Zoology, London 225: 481-493
- Abenspergen, M.A. 1988. Food preference of the echidna, Tachyglossus aculeatus (Monotremata: Tachyglossidae), in the wheatbelt of Western Australia. Australian Mammalogy 11: 117-123
- Aberton, J.G., Wilson, B.A. & Chenery, K. 1994. Observations on the behaviour of Antechinus minimus maritimus (Marsupialia Dasyuridae). Victorian Naturalist 111: 135-138
- Abramov, A.A. 1992. Species composition and distribution of Epigonus (Epigonidae) in the world ocean. Journal of Ichthyology 32(5): 94-108 [original article in Russian in Voprosky Ikhtiologii 32(2): 17-31]
- Adam, H. & Strahan, R. 1963. Systematics and geographical distribution of myxinoids. pp. 1-8 in Brodal, A. & Fänge, R. (eds). The Biology of Myxine. Oslo : Universitetsforlaget.
- Adam, M.S., Merrett, N.R. & Andersen, C. 1998. Additions to the Fish Fauna of the Maldive Islands. Part 1: An annotated checklist of the deep demersal fishes of the Maldive Islands. Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 67: 1-19
- Adams, D. 1973. Broad-headed snake (Hoplocephalus bungaroides). Herpetofauna 5: 19-22
- Adams, M., Baverstock, P.R., Saunders, D.A., Schodde, R. & Smith, G.T. 1984. Biochemical systematics of the Australian cockatoos (Psittaciformes: Cacatuinae). Australian Journal of Zoology 32: 363-377
- Adams, M., Baverstock, P.R., Tidemann, C.R. & Woodside, D.P. 1982. Large genetic differences between sibling species of bats, Eptesicus from Australia. Heredity 48: 435-438
- Adams, M., Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S. & Reardon, T. 1987. Electrophoretic resolution of species boundaries in Australian Microchiroptera. II. The Pipistrellus group (Chiroptera: Vespertilionidae). Australian Journal of Biological Sciences 40: 163-170
- Adams, M., Cooper, N. & Armstrong, J. 2000. Revision of Dasycercus systematics. Unpublished report to the South Australian Department of Environment and Heritage, Adelaide.
- Adams, M., Reardon, T.R., Baverstock, P.R. & Watts, C.H.S. 1988. Electrophoretic resolution of species boundaries in Australian Microchiroptera. IV. The Molossidae (Chiroptera). Australian Journal of Biological Sciences 41: 315-326
- Agafonova, T.B. 1994. Systematics and distribution of Cubiceps (Nomeidae) of the world ocean. Journal of Ichthyology 34(5): 116-143 figs 1-16
- Agafonova, T.F. 1988. New data on the taxonomy and distribution of cigarfishes (Cubiceps, Nomeidae) of the Indian Ocean. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 28(4): 541-555 [English translation in J. Ichthyol. 28(6): 46-61]
- Agar, G., Jaensch, R. and Vervest, Rodney 1988. A Northern Pintail Anas acuta in Australia. Australian Bird Watcher 12(6): 204.205
- Agar, N.S. & Godwin, I.R. 1991. Red cell metabolism in brown antechinus, the bilby and the rufous hare-wallaby. Australian Journal of Zoology 39: 681-687
- Agassiz, J.L.R. 1838. Recherches sur les Poissons Fossiles. Neuchâtel (Switz.) Vol. 3 pp. 73–140, atlas pls 1a, 8a–b, 15, 17, 19–20, 24, 25b, 30, 31–35, 39–40.
- Agassiz, J.L.R. 1839. Recherches sur les Poissons Fossiles. Neuchâtel (Switz.) Vol. 4 pp. 1–16.
- Agassiz, J.L.R. 1843. Recherches sur les Poissons Fossiles. Neuchâtel (Switz.) Vol. 3 pp. 157–390, atlas pls 1, 18, 22, 26a, 38, 40b–d, 45, 47.
- Agassiz, J.L.R. 1844. Report on the fossil fishes of the London clay. Report of the 14th meeting of the British Association for the Advancement of Science 1844: 279-310
- Agassiz, J.L.R. 1857. Contributions to the Natural History of the United States. North American Testudinata. Boston : Little, Brown & Co. Vol. 1(2) pp. 233-450.
- Agassiz, J.L.R. in Spix, J.B. von & Agassiz, J.L.R. 1831. Selecta genera et species piscium quos in itinere per Brasiliam annos MDCCCXVII-MDCCCXX jussu et auspiciis Maximiliani Josephi I… colleget et pingendso curavit Dr J. B. de Spix…. Monachii. Selecta Piscium Brasiliam. Part 1. 1-82 pls 1-48 pp.
- Agassiz, L. 1846. Nomenclatoris Zoologici Index Universalis, continens nomina systematica classium, ordinum, familiarum et generum animalium omnium, tam viventium quam fossilium, secundum ordinem alphabeticum unicum disposita, adjectis homonymiis plantarum, nec non variis adnotationibus et emendationibus. Soloduri [= Solothurn, Switzerland] : Jent & Gassmann viii 393 pp. [published between 1846–1848]
- Ahl, E. 1923. Ichthyologische Mitteilungen 3. Ueber eine neue Art der Gattung Hepatus. Mitteilungen aus dem Zoologischen Museum in Berlin 11: 36-37
- Ahl, E. 1923. Zur Kenntnis der Knochenfischfamilie Chaetodontidae, insbesondere der Unterfamilie Chaetodontinae. Archiv für Naturgeschichte A 89(5): 1-205 pls 1-3
- Ahl, E. 1925. Herpetologische notizen. Zoologischer Anzeiger 65: 18-20
- Ahl, E. 1926. Neue Eidechsen und Amphibien. Zoologischer Anzeiger 67: 186-192
- Ahl, E. 1929. Beschreibung eines neuen Laubfrösches der Gattung Hyla von Java. Zoologischer Anzeiger 85: 269-271
- Ahl, E. 1932. Beschreibung einer neuen Schildkröte aus Australien. Sitzungsberichte der Gesellschaft Naturforschender Freunde zu Berlin 1932: 127-129
- Ahl, E. 1932. Eine neue Eidechse und zwei neue Frösche von der Insel Jobi. Mitteilungen aus dem Zoologischen Museum in Berlin 17: 892-899
- Ahl, E. 1935. Beschreibung einer neuen Eidechse aus West australien. Zoologischer Anzeiger 112: 204-205
- Ahl, E. 1935. Beschreibung eines neuen Laubfrösche aus Südaustralien. Zoologischer Anzeiger 109: 252-253
- Ahl, J.N. 1789. Specimen ichthyologicum de Muraena et Ophichtho. Inaug. Dissert. Uppsala 14 pp. 2 pls.
- Ahlstrom, E.H., Moser, H.G. & Cohen, D.M. 1984. Argentinoidei: development and relationships. 155-169 figs 82-88 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Ahlstrom, E.H., Richards, W.J. & Weitzman, S.H. 1984. Families Gonostomatidae, Sternoptychidae, and associated stomiiform groups: development and relationships. 184-198 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Aitken, K. 1998. Sharks and Rays of Australia. Sydney : New Holland (Australia) 96 pp.
- Aitken, P. 1979. The status of endangered Australian wombats, bandicoots and the marsupial mole. pp. 61-65 in Tyler, M.J. (ed.). The Status of Endangered Australasian Wildlife. Adelaide : Royal Zoological Society of South Australia.
- Aitken, P.F. 1968. Observations on Notomys fuscus (Wood Jones) (Muridae - Pseudomyinae) with notes on a new synonym. South Australian Naturalist 43: 37-45
- Aitken, P.F. 1971. Rediscovery of the Large Desert Sminthopsis (Sminthopsis psammophilus Spencer) on Eyre Peninsula, South Australia. Victorian Naturalist 88: 103-111
- Aitken, P.F. 1971. Whales from the coast of South Australia. Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 95: 95-103
- Aitken, P.F. 1972. Planigale gilesi (Marsupialia, Dasyuridae); a new species from the interior of south eastern Australia. Records of the South Australian Museum 16(10): 1-14
- Aitken, P.F. 1972. Sminthopsis murina (Waterhouse, 1938): A new record from Kangaroo Island, South Australia. South Australian Naturalist 46: 36-37
- Aitken, P.F. 1976. Vertebrate type-specimens in the South Australian Museum. V. Mammals. Records of the South Australian Museum 17: 197-202
- Aitken, P.F., Burbidge, A.A., Johnson, K.A. & Fuller, P.J. 1995. Central Hare-wallaby Lagorchestes asomatus. pp. 311-312 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Aitkin, L.M. & Gates, G.R. 1983. Connections of the auditory cortex of the brush-tailed possum, Trichosurus vulpecula. Brain, Behavior and Evolution 22: 75-88
- Aitkin, L.M., Nelson, J.E. & Shepherd, R.K. 1994. Hearing, vocalization and the external ear of a marsupial, the northern quoll, Dasyurus hallucatus. Journal of Comparative Neurology 349: 377-388
- Aizawa, M. 2002. Families Hemiramphidae, Exocoetidae, Belonidae, Scomberesocidae. pp. 1516-1518 in Nakabo, T. (ed.). Fishes of Japan with pictorial keys to the species. English edition. Tokyo : Toikai University Press pp. 867-1749.
- Aizawa, M. 2002. Stomiiformes. pp. 1474-1481 in Nakabo, T. (ed.). Fishes of Japan with Pictorial Keys to the Species. Tokyo : Tokai University Press Vol. 2 pp. 867-1747.
- Akihito, Meguro, K. & Sakamoto, K. 2003. A new species of gobiid fish, Cristatogobius rubripectoralis, from Australia. Ichthyological Research 50: 117-122
- Akihito, P. 1986. Some morphological characters considered to be important in gobiid phylogeny. pp. 629-639 in Uyeno, T., Arai, R., Taniuchi, T. & Matsuura, K. (eds). Indo-Pacific Fish Biology. Proceedings of the Second International Conference on Indo-Pacific Fishes. Tokyo : Ichthyological Society of Japan 985 pp.
- Akihito, P. & Meguro, K. 1974. On gobiid fishes Ophiocara porocephala and Ophieleotris aporos. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 21(2): 72-84 figs 1-4
- Akihito, P. & Meguro, K. 1975. Description of a new gobiid fish, Glossogobius aureus, with notes on related species of the genus. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 22(3): 127-142 figs 1-3
- Akihito, P. & Meguro, K. 1980. On the six species of the genus Bathygobius found in Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 27(3): 215-236
- Akihito, P. & Meguro, K. 1983. Myersina nigrivirgata, a new species of goby from Okinawa Prefecture in Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 29(4): 343-348
- Akihito, P. & Sakamoto, K. 1989. Reexamination of the status of the striped goby. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 36(1): 100-112 figs 1-7
- Akihito, P., Iwata, A., Kobayashi, T., Ikeo, K., Imanishi, T., Ono, H., Umehara, Y., Hamamatsu, C., Sugiyama, K., Ikeda, Y., Sakamoto, K., Fumihito, A., Ohno, S. & Gojobori, T. 2000. Evolutionary aspects of gobioid fishes based upon a phylogenetic analysis of mitochondrial cytochrome b genes. Gene 259: 5-15
- Alacs, E.A. 2008. Forensics, Phylogeography and Population Genetics: A Case Study using the Northern Snake-Necked Turtle, Chelodina rugosa. Canberra: University of Canberra. [PhD Thesis]
- Albertis, L.M. d' & Salvadori, T. 1879. Catalogo degli uccelli raccolti da L.M. d'Albertis durante la 2a e 3a esplorazone del Fiume Fly negli anni 1876 e 1877. Annali del Museo Civico di Storia Naturale Genova 14: 21-147
- Alcala, A.C. & Brown, W.A. 1967. Population ecology of the tropical scincoid lizard, Emoia atrocostata, in the Philippines. Copeia 1967: 596-604
- Alcock, A. 1891. Class Pisces. In, II. – Natural history notes from H. M. Indian marine survey steamer Investigator, Commander R.F. Hoskyn, R.N., commanding.–Series II., No. 1. On the results of deep-sea dredging during the season 1890-91. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 8(2,15): 16-34, 119-138 figs 1-5 pls 7-8
- Alcock, A.W. 1889. Natural History notes from H. M. Indian Marine Survey Steamer Investigator. — No. 10. List of the Pleuronectidae obtained in the Bay of Bengal in 1888 and 1889, with descriptions of new and rare species. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 58(23): 279-295 pls 16-18
- Alcock, A.W. 1889. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey Steamer Investigator, Commander Alfred Carpenter, R.N., D.S.O., commanding. — No. 13. On the bathybial fishes of the Bay of Bengal and neighbouring waters, obtained during the seasons 1885–1889. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 4(54, 57): 376-399, 450-461
- Alcock, A.W. 1889. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian marine survey steamer Investigator, Commander Alfred Carpenter, R.N., D.S.O., commanding.— No. 13. On the bathybial fishes of the Bay of Bengal and neighbouring waters, obtained during the seasons 1885-1889. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 4(24): 450-461
- Alcock, A.W. 1890. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey Steamer Investigator, Commander R.F. Hoskyn R.N., commanding. — No. 18. On the bathybial fishes of the Arabian Sea, obtained during season 1889–90. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 6(34): 295-311
- Alcock, A.W. 1890. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine survey steamer Investigator. No. 16. On the bathybial fishes collected in the Bay of Bengal during the season 1889–1890. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 6(33): 197-222 pls 8-9
- Alcock, A.W. 1890. On some undescribed shorefishes from the Bay of Bengal. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 6: 425-443 figs 1-3
- Alcock, A.W. 1891. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey steamer Investigator, Commander R.F. Hoskyn, R.N., commanding. Series II. No 1. On the results of deep sea dredging during the season 1890–91. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 8(43): 16-34 figs 1-2 pls 7-8
- Alcock, A.W. 1891. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey steamer Investigator, Commander R.F. Hoskyn, R.N., commanding. Series II. No 1. On the results of deep sea dredging during the season 1890–91. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 8(44): 119-138
- Alcock, A.W. 1892. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian marine survey steamer `Investigator,' Lieut. G.S. Gunn, R.N., commanding.— Series II, No. 5. On the bathybial fishes collected during the season of 1891-92. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 10(59): 345-365 pl. 18
- Alcock, A.W. 1894. Illustrations of the Zoology of the Royal Indian Marine Survey Steamer "Investigator". Part 2. Fishes. Calcutta, pls 8–13.
- Alcock, A.W. 1894. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey Steamer Investigator, Commander C.F. Oldham, R.N., commanding. Series 2(11). An account of a recent collection of bathybial fishes from the Bay of Bengal and from the Laccadive Sea. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 63(2,2): 115-137 pls 6-7
- Alcock, A.W. 1894. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey Steamer Investigator, Commander C.F. Oldham, R.N., commanding. Series 2(9). An account of the deep sea collection made during the season of 1892–93. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 62(2,4): 177-184 pl. 9
- Alcock, A.W. 1896. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian marine survey steamer Investigator, Series 2(2). A supplemental list of the marine fishes of India with descriptions of two new genera and eight new species. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 65(2,3): 301-338
- Alcock, A.W. 1898. Natural history notes from H.M. Indian Marine Survey Ship Investigator, Commander T.H. Heming, R.N., commanding. Series 2(25). A note on the deep-sea fishes with descriptions of some new genera and species including another probably viviparous ophidioid. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 2(22): 136-155
- Alcock, A.W. 1899. A Descriptive Catalogue of Indian Marine Deep-sea Fishes in the Indian Museum, collected by the Royal Indian Marine Survey ship Investigator. Calcutta 211 pp. 8 pls 1 map.
- Alcock, A.W. 1899. Halimochirurgus centriscoides, a new deep-sea fish from the Gulf of Manár. Proceedings of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 68: 78 [not seen]
- Alcock, A.W. in Wood-Mason, J. & Alcock, A. 1891. On the results of deep-sea dredging during the season 1890–91. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 8(2,15): 16-34, 119-138 figs 1-5 pls 7-8
- Alcorn, G.T. 1983. Germ cell development in female pouch young of the tammar wallaby (Macropus eugenii). Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 67: 319-325
- Aldridge, R.D. & Arackal, A.A. 2005. Reproductive biology and stress of captivity in male brown treesnakes (Boiga irregularis) on Guam. Australian Journal of Zoology 53: 249-256
- Alexander, W.B. 1917. Description of a new species of fish of the genus Evoxymetopon, Poey. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 2: 104 pl. 7 [dated 1915–1916]
- Alexander, W.B. 1919. A new species of marsupial of the subfamily Phalangerinae. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 4: 31-36
- Alexander, W.B. 1922. The Vertebrate Fauna of Houtman's Abrolhos (Abrolhos Islands), Western Australia. Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 34: 462-467 [Date published Feb 1922]
- Alexander, W.B. 1924. White's Journal of a Voyage to New South Wales. The Emu 23: 209-215
- Algar, D., Arnold, G.W. & Grassia, A. 1988. Effects of nitrogen and season on western grey kangaroo hematology. Journal of Wildlife Management 52: 616-619
- Allan, R. 2002. Australian Fish and How to Catch Them. Sydney : New Holland Publishers (Australia) 394 pp.
- Allen, G.H. 1950. Birds as a biotic factor in the environment of pastures, with particular reference to Galahs (Cacatua roseicapilla). Journal of the Australian Institute of Agricultural Science 16: 18-25
- Allen, G.M. 1933. Two new bats from Australia. Journal of Mammalogy 14: 149-151
- Allen, G.R. 1972. Anemonefishes, their Classification and Biology. Neptune CityNew Jersey : T.F.H. Publications 288 pp., 140 figs.
- Allen, G.R. 1973. Bodianus bimaculatus, a new species of wrasse (Pisces : Labridae) from the Palau Archipelago. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 86(32): 385-390 fig. 1
- Allen, G.R. 1973. Three new species of deep-dwelling damselfishes (Pomacentridae) from the south-west Pacific Ocean. The Australian Zoologist 18(1): 31-42 figs 1-3
- Allen, G.R. 1974. A review of the labrid genus Paracheilinus, with the description of a new species from Melanesia. Pacific Science 28(4): 449-455
- Allen, G.R. 1975. Damselfishes of the South Seas. New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications 237 pp. 251 figs.
- Allen, G.R. 1975. Four new damselfishes (Pomacentridae) from the southwest Pacific. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 99(2): 87-99 5 figs
- Allen, G.R. 1975. The Anemone Fishes. Their Classification and Biology. Neptune City, New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications Edn 2, 351 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 1976. Descriptions of three new fishes from Western Australia. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 59(1): 24-30 figs 1-3
- Allen, G.R. 1976. Two new species of damselfishes (Pomacentridae) from Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 4(2): 133-144 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. 1977. A new species of scorpaenid fish (Scorpaenidae) from Western Australia. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 101(3): 145-149 pl. 1
- Allen, G.R. 1977. A revision of the plesiopid fish genus Trachinops, with the description of a new species from Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 5(1): 59-72 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. 1978. A review of the archerfishes (family Toxotidae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 6(4): 355-378 figs 1-11
- Allen, G.R. 1978. The rainbowfishes of northwestern Australia (family Melanotaeniidae). Tropical Fish Hobbyist 26(10): 91-102 figs 1-15
- Allen, G.R. 1980. A generic classification of the rainbowfishes (family Melanotaeniidae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 8(3): 449-490 figs 1-24
- Allen, G.R. 1980. Butterfly and Angelfishes of the World. New York : John Wiley & Sons Vol. 2 pp. 149-352 figs 214-510.
- Allen, G.R. 1982. Inland Fishes of Western Australia. Perth : Western Australian Museum 86 pp. 6 figs 20 pls.
- Allen, G.R. 1983. A new genus and species of wrasse (Pisces: Labridae) from Rowley Shoals, Western Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 10(2): 43-46
- Allen, G.R. 1985. FAO Species Catalogue. Snappers of the World. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of lutjanid species known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125, Vol. 6. Rome : FAO 208 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 1985. A new species of cardinalfish (Apogonidae) from northern Australia and the Aru Islands. The Beagle. Occasional Papers of the Northern Territory Museum of Arts and Sciences 2(1): 11-15 figs 1-3
- Allen, G.R. 1985. Fishes of Western Australia. Book 9. 2207-2534 526 pls in Burgess, W.E. & Axelrod, H.R. (eds). Pacific Marine Fishes. Neptune, New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications.
- Allen, G.R. 1987. Descriptions of three new pseudochromid fishes of the genus Pseudoplesiops from Australia and surrounding regions. Records of the Western Australian Museum 13(2): 249-261
- Allen, G.R. 1987. New Australian Fishes. Part 2. Four new species of Apogonidae. Memoirs of Museum Victoria 48(1): 3-8
- Allen, G.R. 1987. New Australian fishes. Part 3. A new species of Pomacentrus (Pomacentridae). Memoirs of Museum Victoria 48(1): 9-11 fig. 1
- Allen, G.R. 1989. Freshwater Fishes of Australia. Neptune, New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications 240 pp., 63 pls.
- Allen, G.R. 1991. Damselfishes of the World. Melle, Germany : Mergus Verlag 271 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 1991. Field Guide to the Freshwater Fishes of New Guinea. Madang : Christensen Research Institute 268 pp. [Publication No. 9 of the Christensen Research Institute]
- Allen, G.R. 1992. A new species of cardinalfish (Apogonidae) from northern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 15(4): 697-701
- Allen, G.R. 1992. A new species of damselfish (genus Pomacentrus) from north-western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 15(4): 691-695
- Allen, G.R. 1993. Variichthys, a replacement name for the terapontid fish genus Varia and first record of V. lacustris from Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 16(3): 459-460
- Allen, G.R. 1993. Cardinalfishes (Apogonidae) of Madang Province, Papua New Guinea, with descriptions of three new species. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 20(1): 9-20
- Allen, G.R. 1993. Fishes of Ashmore Reef and Cartier Island. Records of the Western Australian Museum, Supplement 44: 67-86
- Allen, G.R. 1993. Two new species of damselfishes (Pomacentrus) with comments on the validity of two additional pomacentrid fishes. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 20(1): 21-26 9 figs
- Allen, G.R. 1995. Lutjanus rufolineatus, a valid species of snapper (Pisces, Lutjanidae) with notes on a closely allied species, Lutjanus boutton. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 22(1–2): 11-18
- Allen, G.R. 1995. Pseudochromis howsoni, a new species of dottyback fish (Pseudochromidae) from Ashmore Reef, Timor Sea. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 21(3-4): 83-85 [dated 1994]
- Allen, G.R. 1995. A new species of cardinalfish (Apogon : Apogonidae) from northwestern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 17: 177-180
- Allen, G.R. 1995. A new species of wrasse (Labridae: Cirrhilabrus) from Western Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 22(1–2): 14-18
- Allen, G.R. 1995. Two new species of damselfishes (Pomacentridae) from Indonesian Seas. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 21(3–4): 86-90
- Allen, G.R. 1996. New records of reef and shore fishes from northwestern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 18: 109-112
- Allen, G.R. 1997. Marine Fishes of Tropical Australia and South-east Asia. Perth : Western Australian Museum 292 pp. 106 pls.
- Allen, G.R. 1998. A review of the marine catfish genus Paraplotosus (Plotosidae) with the description of a new species from north-western Australia. Raffles Bulletin of Zoology 46(1): 123-134 figs 1-4
- Allen, G.R. 1999. Myersina larsonae, a new species of goby (Pisces: Gobiidae) from north-western Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 26(1–2): 49-51 figs 1-3
- Allen, G.R. 1999. Apogonidae. pp. 2602-2610 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 1999. Descriptions of a new wrasse (Pisces: Labridae; Cirrhilabrus) from North-western Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 25(3-4): 118-122 figs 1-4 [Date published 2 February 1999]
- Allen, G.R. 1999. Family Ambassidae. pp. 2433-2435 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 2001. Kurtidae. 3610 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Allen, G.R. 2001. Toxotidae. pp. 3212-3215 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Allen, G.R. 2001. Two new species of cardinalfishes (Apogonidae) from the Raja Ampat Islands, Indonesia. Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 4(4): 143-149
- Allen, G.R. 2004. Toxotes kimberleyensis, a new species of Archerfish (Pisces: Toxotidae) from fresh waters of Western Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 56: 225-230
- Allen, G.R., this work
- Allen, G.R. & Feinberg, M.N. 1998. Descriptions of a new genus and four new species of freshwater catfishes (Plotosidae) from Australia. Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 3(1): 9-18 figs 1-6
- Allen, G.R. & Ayling A.M. 1987. New Australian Fishes. Part 5. A new species of Acanthurus (Acanthuridae). Memoirs of Museum Victoria 48(1): 15-16
- Allen, G.R. & Boeseman, M. 1982. A collection of freshwater fishes from western New Guinea with descriptions of two new species (Gobiidae and Eleotridae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 10(2): 67-103 figs 1-7
- Allen, G.R. & Burgess, W.E. 1990. A review of the glass-fishes (Ambassidae) of Australia and New Guinea. Records of the Western Australian Museum, Supplement 34: 139-206
- Allen, G.R. & Cowan, M.A. 1995. First record of the false catshark, Pseudotriakis microdon, from Australian seas. Records of the Western Australian Museum 17: 235-236 fig. 1
- Allen, G.R. & Cross, N.J. 1982. Rainbowfishes of Australia and Papua-New Guinea. New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications 142 pp. figs.
- Allen, G.R. & Cross, N.J. 1983. A new species and two new records of squirrelfishes (Holocentridae) from the eastern Indian Ocean and Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 10(1): 5-8 figs 1-5
- Allen, G.R. & Emery, A.R. 1985. A review of the pomacentrid fishes of the genus Stegastes from the Indo-west Pacific with descriptions of two new species. Indo-Pacific Fishes 3: 1-31 figs 1-5 pls 1-3
- Allen, G.R. & Heemstra, P.C. 1976. Cheilodactylus rubrolabiatus, a new species of morwong (Pisces : Cheilodactylidae) from Western Australia, with a key to the cheilodactylid fishes of Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 4(4): 311-325 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. & Hoese, D.F. 1975. A review of the pomacentrid fish genus Parma, with descriptions of two new species. Records of the Western Australian Museum 3(4): 261-294 figs 1-18
- Allen, G.R. & Hoese, D.F. 1980. A collection of fishes from the Jardine River, Cape York Peninsula, Australia. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 63(2): 53-61 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. & Ivantsoff, W. 1982. Pseudomugil mellis, le honey Blue-eye, une nouvelle espèce de poisson Arc-en-ciel (Melanotaeniidae) d'Australie orientale. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 9(3): 83-86 figs 1-7
- Allen, G.R. & Jenkins, A.P. 1999. A review of the Australian freshwater gudgeons, genus Mogurnda (Eleotridae) with descriptions of three new species. Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 3(4): 141-155
- Allen, G.R. & Kuiter, R.H. 1976. A review of the plesiopid fish genus Assessor, with descriptions of two new species. Records of the Western Australian Museum 4(3): 201-215 figs 1-4
- Allen, G.R. & Kuiter, R.H. 1978. Heniochus diphreutes Jordan, a valid species of butterflyfish (Chaetodontidae) from the Indo-West Pacific. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 61(1): 11-18 figs 1-5
- Allen, G.R. & Larson, H.K. 1979. Parma bicolor, a new species of damselfish from southwestern Australia. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 6(1): 11-14 figs 1-4
- Allen, G.R. & Leggett, R. 1990. A collection of freshwater fishes from the Kimberley region of Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 14(4): 527-545 fig. 1
- Allen, G.R. & Merrick, J.R. 1984. A new species of freshwater grunter (Pisces : Terapontidae) from northern Australia. The Beagle. Occasional Papers of the Northern Territory Museum of Arts and Sciences 1(8): 75-80 figs 1-3
- Allen, G.R. & Morrison, S. 1996. A new species of cardinalfish (Apogonidae) from northern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 17: 439-442
- Allen, G.R. & Moyer, J.T. 1980. Ellerkeldia wilsoni, a new species of serranid fish from southwestern Australia. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 26(4): 329-333 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. & Pusey, B.J. 1999. Hephaestus tulliensis De Vis, a valid species of grunter (Terapontidae) from fresh waters of north-eastern Queensland, Australia. Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 3(4): 157-162 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1974. Five new species and a new genus of damselfishes (family Pomacentridae) from the South Pacific Ocean. Tropical Fish Hobbyist 21(9): 36-49 figs 1-5
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1977. Review of the sharpnose pufferfishes (subfamily Canthigasterinae) of the Indo-Pacific. Records of the Australian Museum 30(17): 475-517 figs 1-15
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1985. A new genus and species of plesiopid fish from Western Australia and the central-south Pacific Ocean. Records of the Western Australian Museum 12(2): 185-191 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1985. A new species of damselfish (Pomacentridae) from eastern Australia and the Norfolk Island Ridge. Records of the Western Australian Museum 12(2): 241-245
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1990. Hypoplectrodes cardinalis, a new name for the serranid fish H. ruber (Allen) from southwestern Australia, with discussion of H. semicinctus from Juan Fernandez Islands. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 17(2): 45-46
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1993. Three new species of cardinalfishes (Apogonidae) from Australia and adjacent seas. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 19(4): 107-114
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1995. Apogon virgulatus Allen et Randall, a junior synonym of Apogon cavitiensis (Jordan et Seale). Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 22(1/2): 10
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 1996. Three new species of wrasses (Labridae: Cirrhilabrus) from Papua New Guinea and the Solomon Islands. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 23(3–4): 101-112
- Allen, G.R. & Randall, J.E. 2002. Four new Indo-Pacific species of cardinalfishes (Apogonidae). Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 5(3): 115-126
- Allen, G.R. & Robertson, D.R. 1974. Descriptions of four new damselfishes (Pomacentridae) from Papua New Guinea and eastern Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 29(4): 153-167 pls 1-5
- Allen, G.R. & Russell, B.C. 1986. Part VII Fishes. 79-103 in Berry, P.F. (ed.). Faunal Surveys of the Rowley Shoals, Scott Reef and Seringapatam Reef, northwestern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum, Supplement 25: 1-106
- Allen, G.R. & Sarti, N. 1983. Pseudomugil cyanodorsalis, une nouvelle espèce de blue-eye (Melanotaeniidae) d'Australie nord-occidentale. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 10(2): 47-50 figs 1-4
- Allen, G.R. & Smith-Vaniz, W.F. 1994. Fishes of Cocos (Keeling) Islands. Atoll Research Bulletin 412: 1-21
- Allen, G.R. & Starck, W.A. 1982. The anthiid fishes of the Great Barrier Reef, Australia, with the description of a new species. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 9(2): 47-56 figs 1-28
- Allen, G.R. & Steene, R. 2004. Chaetodontoplus vanderloosi, a new species of angelfish (Pomacanthidae) from Papua New Guinea. Aqua, Journal of Ichthyology and Aquatic Biology 8(1): 23-30
- Allen, G.R. & Steene, R.C. 1979. The Fishes of Christmas Island, Indian Ocean. Aust. Natl. Parks Wldlf. Ser. Spec. Publ. 2. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service 81 pp. 15 pls.
- Allen, G.R. & Swainston, R. 1988. The Marine Fishes of North-Western Australia. A field guide for anglers and divers. Perth, WA : Western Australian Museum vi 201 pp., 70 pls.
- Allen, G.R. & Talbot, F.H. 1985. Review of the snappers of the genus Lutjanus (Pisces: Lutjanidae) from the Indo-Pacific, with the description of a new species. Indo-Pacific Fishes 11: 1-87
- Allen, G.R. in Hoese, D.F., Bray, D.J., Paxton, J.R. & Allen, G.R. 2006. Fishes. In, Beesley, P.L. & Wells, A. (eds) Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Volume 35. ABRS & CSIRO Publishing : Australia Part 1, pp. xxiv 1–670; Part 2, pp. xxi 671–1472; Part 3, pp. xxi 1473–2178.
- Allen, G.R., Cross, N.J. & Hoese, D.F. 2006. Family Osteoglossidae. pp. 217-218 in Beesley, P.L. & Wells, A. (eds). Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Volume 35 Australia : ABRS & CSIRO Publishing Parts 1-3 2178 pp.
- Allen, G.R., Hoese, D.F., Paxton, J.R., Randall, J.E., Russell, B.C., Starck, W.A., Talbot, F.H. & Whitley, G.P. 1976. Annotated checklist of the fishes of Lord Howe Island. Records of the Australian Museum 30(15): 365-454 figs 1-2
- Allen, G.R., Kuiter, R.H. & Randall, J.E. 1994. Descriptions of five new species of cardinalfishes (Apogonidae: Apogon) from Maumere Bay, Flores, Indonesia and surrounding regions. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 21(1–2): 27-38
- Allen, G.R., Larson, H.K. & Midgley, S.H. 1993. A new species of Scortum Whitley (Pisces: Terapontidae) from the Northern Territory, Australia. The Beagle, Records of the Museums and Art Galleries of the Northern Territory 10(1): 71-74
- Allen, G.R., Larson, H.K. & Russell, B.C. 1989. Draft list of fishes of Ashmore Reef. Unpublished report of the Northern Territory Museum and Art Gallery, Darwin.
- Allen, G.R., Midgley, S.H. & Allen, M. 2002. Field Guide to the Freshwater Fishes of Australia. Perth : Western Australian Museum 394 pp.
- Allen, G.R., Steene, R. & Allen, M. 1998. A Guide to Angelfishes & Butterflyfishes. Cairns : Odyssey Publishing/Tropical Reef Research 250 pp. figs.
- Allen, G.R., Steene, R.C.& Orchard, M. 2007. Fishes of Christmas Island. Christmas Island : Christmas Island Natural History Association Edn 2, 284 pp.
- Allen, J.A. 1905. The Mammalia of southern Patagonia. Report of the Princeton University Expedition to Patagonia, 1896–1899 Zool. 3: 1-210 pls i-xxix
- Allen, R.J. 1987. Alexandra's Parrots in the Great Victoria Desert. South Australian Ornithologist 30: 75
- Allen, T.B. 2001. Shark Attacks: Their Causes and Avoidance. New York : Lyons Press 293 pp.
- Alleyne, H.G. & Macleay, W.J. 1877. The ichthyology of the Chevert Expedition. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1(3–4): 261-281, 321-359, pls 3-9, pls 10-17
- Alleyne, H.G. & Macleay, W.J. 1877. The ichthyology of the Chevert Expedition. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1(3–4): 261-281, 321-359, pls 3-9, 10-17
- Alleyne, H.G. & Macleay, W.J. 1877. The ichthyology of the Chevert Expedition (2). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1(4): 321-359 pls 10-17
- Allison, F.R. 1983. North Queensland Long-eared Bat Nyctophilus bifax. 333 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Australian Museum Complete Book of Australian Mammals. The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Angus & Robertson.
- Allison, F.R. 1988. Molossidae. pp. 892-909 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Volume 1B Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service 827 pp.
- Allison, F.R. 1995. Hoary Wattled Bat Chalinolobus nigrogriseus. pp. 515-516 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Allison, F.R. & Hoye, G.A. 1995. Eastern Freetail-bat Mormopterus norfolkensis. pp. 484-485 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Alston, E.R. 1877. On the rodents and marsupials collected by the Rev. G. Brown in Duke-of-York Island, New Britain, and New Ireland. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1877: 123-127 pls 18-19 [publication date established from Alston, E.R. 1878. Supplementary note on rodents and marsupials from Duke-of-York Island and New Ireland. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1877: 743–744 [743]]
- Alston, E.R. 1879. In Anon. Abstract. (Untitled) Zoological Society, June 17. Nature (London) 20: 210-211
- Alston, E.R. 1879. On the Acanthomys of Gray. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1879: 645-647
- Amadon, D. 1942. Birds collected during the Whitney South Sea Expedition. L Notes on some non-passerine genera, 2. American Museum Novitates 1176: 1-21
- Amadon, D. 1943. Birds collected during the Whitney South Sea Expedition. 52 Notes on some non-passerine genera, 3. American Museum Novitates 1237: 1-22
- Amadon, D. & Bull, J. 1988. Hawks and owls of the world. Proceedings of the Western Foundation of Vertebrate Zoology 3: 295-357
- Amano, M., Miyasaki, N. & Yanagisawa, F. 1996. Life history of Fraser's dolphin, Lagenodelphis hosei, based on a school captured off the coast of Japan. Marine Mammal Science 12: 199-214
- Amaoka, K. 1963. A revision of the flatfish referable to the genus Engyprosopon found in the waters around Japan. Bulletin of the Misaki Marine Biological Institute. Kyoto University 4: 107-121
- Amaoka, K. 1963. A revision of the flatfish referable to the genus Psettina found in waters around Japan. Bulletin of the Misaki Marine Biological Institute. Kyoto University 4: 53-62 figs 1-6
- Amaoka, K. 1969. Studies on the sinestral flounders found in the waters around Japan. Taxonomy, anatomy, and physiology. Journal of the Shimonoseki College of Fisheries 18: 65-340
- Amaoka, K. & Arai, M. 1998. Redescription of a rare bothid, Asterorhombus bleekeri (Macleay), and description of a new species of Asterorhombus from northwestern Australia (Teleostei: Pleuronectiformes). Ichthyological Research 45(3): 249-257
- Amaoka, K. & Hensley, D.A. 2001. Paralichthyidae. pp. 3842-3862 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Amaoka, K. & Larson, H.K. 1999. New species of Psettina (Pleuronectiformes: Bothidae) from off Western Australia, and record of a rare species. Copeia 1999(4): 1072-1078 figs 1-3
- Amaoka, K. & Mihara, E. 2000. Pisces Pleuronectiformes: Flatfishes from New Caledonia and adjacent waters. Genus Arnoglossus. Mémoires du Muséum Nationale d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 184: 783-813
- Amaoka, K. & Mihara, E. 2001. Asterorhombus annulatus (Weber, 1913), a valid species distinct from Asterorhombus intermedius (Bleeker, 1865) (Pleuronectiformes: Bothidae). Ichthyological Research 48: 192-196
- Amaoka, K. & Shen, S.-C. 1993. A new bothid flatfish Parabothus taiwanensis collected from Taiwan (Pleuronectiformes: Bothidae). Bulletin of Marine Science 53(3): 1042-1047
- Amaoka, K. & Toyoshima, M. 1981. A new ogcocephalid fish, Dibranchus japonicus, from Japan. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 28(2): 115-121 figs 1-4
- Amaoka, K. & Yamamoto, E. 1984. Review of the genus Chascanopsetta, with the description of a new species. Bulletin of the Faculty of Fisheries, Hokkaido University 35(4): 201-224
- Amaoka, K. &.Fujii, R. 1999. Fishes of the Döderlein collection. pp. 147-165 in Nishikawa, T. (ed.). Preliminary Taxonomical and Historical Studies on Prof. Ludwig Döderlein's Collection of Japanese Animals made in 1880–81 and deposited at several European Museums. Nagoya, Japan : Seiten pp. 1-266.
- Amaoka, K., Arai, M. & Gomon, M.F. 1997. A new species of Arnoglossus (Pleuronectiformes: Bothidae) from the southwestern coast of Australia. Ichthyological Research 44(2): 131-136 figs 1-3
- Amaoka, K., Mihara, E. & Rivaton, J. 1993. Pisces, Pleuronectiformes: Flatfishes from the waters around New Caledonia. — A revision of the genus Engyprosopon. Mémoires du Muséum Nationale d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 158: 377-426
- Amaoka, K., Mihara, E. & Rivaton, J. 1997. Pisces, Pleuronectiformes: flatfishes from the waters around New Caledonia. Six species of the bothid genera Tosarhombus and Parabothus. Mémoires du Muséum Nationale d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 174: 143-171
- Amaoka, K., Nakaya, K., Araya, H. & Yasui, T. 1983. Fishes from the North-eastern Sea of Japan and the Okhotsk Sea of Hokkaido. Tokyo : Japan Fisheries Resource Conservation Association 371 pp.
- Amaoka, K., Senou, H. & Ono, A. 1994. Record of the bothid flounder Asterorhombus fijiensis from the western Pacific, with observations on the use of the first dorsal-fin ray as a lure. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 41(1): 23-28 figs 1-3
- American Ornithologists' Union. 1983. Check-list of North American Birds. 6th Edn American Ornithologists' Union xxix 877 pp.
- Ames, P.L. 1971. The Morphology of the Syrinx in Passerine Birds. Peabody Museum of Natural History, Bulletin 37: vi 194 pp. 21 pls
- Ames, P.L. 1975. The application of the syringeal morphology to the classification of the Old World insect eaters (Muscicapidae). Bonner Zoologische Beiträge 26: 107-134
- Amey, A.P., Kutt, A.S. & Hutchinson, M. 2005. A new species of Lerista (Scincidae) from Central Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 50(2): 125-131
- Amirthalingam, C. 1969. A new fish from the Red Sea. Sudan Notes and Records 50: 129-133 pl. 1
- Amos, B., Schlotterer, C. & Tauz, D. 1993. Social structure of pilot whales revealed by analytical DNA profiling. Science (Washington, DC) 260: 670-672
- Andersen, K. 1909. Notes on the genus Acerodon, with a synopsis of its species and subspecies, and descriptions of four new forms. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 3: 20-29
- Andersen, K. 1910. Ten new fruit-bats of the genera Nyctimene, Cynopterus and Eonycteris. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 6: 621-625
- Andersen, K. 1911. Six new fruit-bats of the genera Macroglossus and Syconycteris. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 7: 641-643
- Andersen, K. 1912. Catalogue of the Chiroptera in the Collection of the British Museum. Megachiroptera. London : British Museum Vol. 1 Edn 2, cii 854 pp.
- Anderson, J. 1802. Notices of a singular animal, lately discovered in New South Wales, with a figure. Recreations in Agriculture, Natural-history, Arts and Miscellaneous Literature 2 2: 562-565
- Anderson, J. 1871. On some Indian reptiles. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1871: 149-211
- Anderson, J. 1878. Anatomical and Zoological Researches; comprising an account of zoological results of two expeditions to western Yunnan in 1868 and 1875; and a monograph of the two cetacean genera, Platanista and Orcella. London : Bernard Quaritch I (text), Vol. II (plates) 984 pp.
- Anderson, J. 1881. Catalogue of Mammalia in the Indian Museum, Calcutta. Pt 1. Primates, Prosimiae, Chiroptera, and Insectivora. Calcutta : Indian Museum xvi 225 pp.
- Anderson, M.E. 1986. Order Zoarciformes. pp. 342-343 in Smith, M.M. & Heemstra, P.C. (eds). Smith's Sea Fishes. Johannesburg : Macmillan South Africa xx + 1047 pp. 144 pls.
- Anderson, M.E. 1994. Systematics and osteology of the Zoarcidae (Teleostei: Perciformes). Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 60: 1-120
- Anderson, M.E. 2001. Family Zoarcidae. pp. 3493-3494 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Anderson, M.E. 2005. Three new species of Microbrotula (Teleostei: Ophidiiformes; Bythitidae) from the Indo-West Pacific. Zootaxa 1006: 33-42
- Anderson, M.E. & Heemstra, P.C. 2003. Review of the glassfishes (Perciformes: Ambassidae) of the western Indian Ocean. Cybium 27(3): 199-209
- Anderson, M.E. & Leslie, R.W. 2001. Review of the deep-sea anglerfishes (Lophiiformes: Ceratioidei) of southern Africa. Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 70: 1-32
- Anderson, P.K. 1981. The behaviour of the dugong (Dugong dugon) in relation to conservation and management. Bulletin of Marine Science 31: 640-647
- Anderson, P.K. 1986. Dugongs of Shark Bay, Australia - seasonal migration, water, and forage. National Geographic Research 2: 473-490
- Anderson, P.K. 1994. Dugong distribution, the seagrass Halophila spinulosa, and thermal environment in winter in deeper waters of eastern Shark Bay, Western Australia. Wildlife Research 21: 381-388
- Anderson, P.K. 1997. Shark Bay dugongs in summer. I. Lek mating. Behaviour 134: 433-462
- Anderson, P.K. & Barclay, R.M.R. 1995. Acoustic signals of solitary dugongs: Physical characteristics and behavioural correlates. Journal of Mammalogy 76: 1226-1237
- Anderson, R. 1978. Gold on Four Feet.Commercial deer farming: a new rural industry of outstanding potential. Collingwood : R. Anderson & Assoc. 160 pp.
- Anderson, R. 1979. Deer farming in Australia. Proceedings of the Post-graduate Committee of Veterinary Science University of Sydney 49: 55-71
- Anderson, W.A., Gehringer, J.W. & Berry, F.H. 1966. Family Synodontidae. pp. 31-102 figs 8-35 in Olsen, Y.H. (ed.). Fishes of the Western North Atlantic. Lizardfishes, other Iniomi, Deepsea Gulpers. Yale University : The Sears Foundation for Marine Research Mem. I Pt 5 647 pp. 220 pls.
- Anderson, W.D. 1981. A new species of Indo-west Pacific Etelis (Pisces Lutjanidae), with comments on other species of the genus. Copeia 1981(4): 820-825
- Anderson, W.D. & Allen, G.R. 2001. Lutjanidae. pp. 2840-2918 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Anderson, W.D. & Johnson, G.D. 1984. A new species of Callanthias (Pisces: Perciformes: Percoidei: Callanthiidae) from the southeastern Pacific Ocean. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 97(4): 942-950
- Anderson, W.D. Jr 1999. Family Callanthiidae. pp. 2553-2554 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Anderson, W.D. Jr & Heemstra, P.C. 1989. Ellerkeldia, a junior synonym of Hypoplectrodes, with redescriptions of the type species of the genera (Pisces: Serranidae: Anthiinae). Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 102(4): 1001-1017
- Anderson, W.D. Jr, Parin, N.V. & Randall, J.E. 1990. A new genus and species of anthiine fish (Pisces: Serranidae) from the eastern South Pacific with comments on anthiine relationships. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 103(4): 922-930
- Anderson, W.D., Jr & Springer, V. 2005. Review of the perciform fish genus Symphysanodon Bleeker (Symphysanodontidae), with descriptions of three new species, S. mona, S. parini, and S. rhax. Zootaxa 994: 1-44
- Anderson, W.D., Jr. 1987. Systematics of the fishes of the family Lutjanidae (Perciformes: Percoidei), the snappers. pp. 1-31 in Polovina, J.J. & Ralston, S. (eds). Tropical Snappers and Groupers: Biology and Fisheries Management. Boulder : Westview Press Inc. 659 pp.
- Anderson, W.D., Talwar, P.K. & Johnson, G.D. 1977. A replacement name for Tangia Chan (Pisces: Perciformes: Lutjanidae) with redescription of the genus and type-species. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 89(44): 509-518 fig. 1
- Andersson, L.G. 1913. Results of Dr. E. Mjöberg's Swedish Scientific Expeditions to Australia 1910–1913. 4. Batrachians. Kongliga Svenska Vetenskaps Academiens Nya Handlingar, Stockholm ns 52: 1-26
- Andersson, L.G. 1916. Results of Dr. E. Mjöberg's Swedish Scientific Expeditions to Australia 1910–1913. 9. Batrachians from Queensland. Kongliga Svenska Vetenskaps Academiens Nya Handlingar, Stockholm ns 52: 1-20
- Ando, K., Tagawa, T. & Uchida, T.A. 1980. A karyotypic study on four species of the Indonesian fruit-eating bats, belonging to Cynopterus, Eonycteris and Macroglossus (Chiroptera: Pteropidae). Caryologia 33: 41-53
- Andrawartha, B. & Tuma, D. 2007. Fil-o-Fish Australia, Recrational & Commercial Fish Handbook. Balnarring, Victoria : Candlelight Publishing 623 pp.
- Andrew, D.L. & Settle, G.A. 1982. Observations on the behaviour of species of Planigale (Dasyuridae, Marsupialia) with particular reference to the narrow-nosed planigale (Planigale tenuirostris). pp. 311-324 in Archer, M. (ed.). Carnivorous Marsupials. Sydney : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Vol. 1 i-vi, 396 pp.
- Andrew, M.H. & Lange, R.T. 1986. The spatial distributions of sympatric populations of kangaroos and sheep: examples of dissociation between these species. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 367-373
- Andrew, T.G., Hecht, T., Heemstra, P.C. & Lutjeharms, J.R.E. 1995. Fishes of the Tristan da Cunha group and Gough Island, south Atlantic Ocean. Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 63: 1-43 figs 1-34 pls 1-2
- Andrews, A.P. 1985. A new species of Galaxias (Pisces : Galaxiidae) from southern Tasmania. Papers and Proceedings of the Royal Society of Tasmania 119: 55-60 fig. 1 pl. 1
- Andrews, A.P. 1992. A descriptive catalogue of the type material (chordates) in the Tasmanian Museum. Papers and Proceedings of the Royal Society of Tasmania 126: 109-113
- Andrews, C.W. 1900. Mammals. pp. 22-37 in Andrews, C.W. (ed.). A Monograph of Christmas Island (Indian Ocean): physical features and geology; with descriptions of the fauna and flora by numerous contributors. London : British Museum (Natural History) xiii 337 pp.
- Andrews, C.W. 1909. An account of Andrew's visit to Christmas Island in 1908. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1909: 101-103
- Andrews, C.W. (ed.) 1900. A Monograph of Christmas Island (Indian Ocean): physical features and geology; with descriptions of the fauna and flora by numerous contributors. London : British Museum (Natural History) xiii 337 pp.
- Andrews, R.C. 1908. Description of a new species of Mesoplodon from Canterbury Province, New Zealand. Bulletin of the American Museum of Natural History 24: 203-215
- Andriashev, A.P. 1960. Families of fishes new to the Antarctic. 1. Paradiplospinus antarcticus gen. et sp. n. (Pisces, Trichiuridae). Zoologicheskii Zhurnal 39(2): 244-249 [in Russian]
- Andriashev, A.P. 1962. Bathypelagic fishes of the Antarctic. 1. Family Myctophidae. Akademii Nauk SSSR, Issledovaniya Fauny Morei 1(9): 216-294 figs 1-36 [in Russian; Bur. Comm. Fish. Ichthyol. Lab. Transl. 29]
- Andriashev, A.P. 2003. Liparid Fishes (Liparidae, Scorpaeniformes) of the Southern Ocean and adjacent Waters. Russian Academy of Sciences Zoological Institute, Saint Petersburg. Biological Results of the Russian Antarctic Expeditions, Vol. 9. Explorations of the Fauna of the Seas, 53(61). 1-475 pp.
- Angel, M.F. 1936. Deux gekkos nouveaux de Madagascar appartenant au genre Phyllodactylus. Bulletin de la Société Zoologique de France 61: 508-511
- Angermann, R. 1983. The taxonomy of Old World Lepus. Acta Zoologica Fennica 174: 17-21
- Annandale, N. 1908. A new sting ray of the genus Trygon from the Bay of Bengal. Records of the Indian Museum 2(4): 393-394
- Annandale, N. 1909. Report on the fishes taken by the Bengal fisheries steamer "Golden Crown." Part I, Batoidei. Memoirs of the Indian Museum 2(1): 1-60
- Annandale, N. 1913. Some new and interesting Batrachia and lizards from India, Ceylon and Borneo. Records of the Indian Museum 9: 301-307
- Anon. 1791. In Phillip, A. Voyage du Gouverneur Phillip à Botany-Bay, avec une description de l'établissement des Colonies du Port Jackson et de l'Île Norfolk; faite sur des papiers authentiques, obtenus des divers Departemens, auxquels on a ajouté les journaux des Lieutenans Shortland, Watts, Ball, et du Capitaine Marshall, avec un récit de leurs nouvelles découvertes. Traduit de l'Anglais. Paris : Buisson iv 443 pp.
- Anon. 1798. Review of Tome I of `Histoire naturelle des poissons' by Lacépède (1798). Allgemeine Literatur-Zeitung, Berlin 3(287): 674-685
- Anon. 1839. [A letter from Alexander Gordon, Esq. read]. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1838: 149
- Anon. 1839. [No title]. 454 in Knight, C. (ed.). Penny Cyclopaedia. London : Publisher unknown Vol. 14.
- Anon. 1854. Bandicoot. 382 in Knight, C. (ed.). The English Cyclopaedia. A new dictionary of universal knowledge conducted by Charles Knight. Natural History. London : Bradbury & Evans Vol. 1 viii 1135 pp.
- Anon. 1856. IV. Museum. pp. 9-10 in Reports of the Council and Auditors of the Zoological Society of London, read at the Annual General Meeting, April 29th, 1856. Zoological Society of London : London.
- Anon. 1859. Descriptive Catalogue of the Specimens of Natural History in spirit contained in the Museum of The Royal College of Surgeons of England. Vertebrata: Pisces, Reptilia, Aves, Mammalia. London : Royal College of Surgeons of England xxii 248 pp.
- Anon. 1863. June 4, 1863. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of London 7: li-lii
- Anon. 1886. Note of exhibit (Untitled). Abstr. Proc. Linn. Soc. N.S.W. 1886: v. [for 24th November]
- Anon. 1903. Catalogue of the Books, Manuscripts, and Drawings in the British Museum (Natural History). Vol. 1. A—D. London : British Museum viii 500 pp.
- Anon. 1929. A bat colony. The Australian Zoologist 6: 106-107
- Anon. 1960. Type specimens in the Western Australian Museum. Western Australian Museum Annual Report 1959-60: 28-30
- Anon. 1975. [Status of Tursiops spp.]. 923-926 in International Whaling Commission. Review of biology and fisheries for smaller cetaceans. Journal of the Fisheries Research Board of Canada 32: 889-983
- Anon. 1977. Report of the Special Meeting of the Scientific Committee on Sei and Bryde's Whales. Rep. Int. Whal. Comm. (Special Issue 1). 150 pp.
- Anon. 1978. Southern Hemisphere Baleen Whales. pp. 54-56 in [Committee] (ed.). Mammals in the Seas. FAO Fisheries Series 5(1). Rome : FAO/UN.
- Anon. 1978. Sperm Whale. pp. 59-63 in [Committee] (ed.). Mammals in the Seas. FAO Fisheries Series 5(1). Rome : FAO/UN.
- Anon. 1979. Eggs under incubation. Victorian Herpetological Society Newsletter 16: 22
- Anon. 1983. Conservation of the Dalgyte. SWANS 13(1): 15-17
- Anon. 1986. Right Whales: past and present status. Rept. Int. Whal. Comm. Special Issue 10. 289 pp.
- Anon. 2002. Royal National Park Deer Management Strategy. Sutherland, New South Wales : NSW National Parks and Wildlife Service, Sydney South Region.
- Anon. (Férussac, ed.) 1829. [Review of] Voyage autour du monde. Livraison 11. Bulletin des Sciences Naturelles et de Géologie 17: 267
- Anon. (Férussac, ed.) 1830. [Review of] Voyage autour du monde. Livraisons 14–17. Bulletin des Sciences Naturelles et de Géologie 21: 309-311
- Anon. In Field, B. (ed.) 1825. Geographical Memoirs on New South Wale; by various hands: containing … together with other papers on the aborigines, the geology, the timber, the astronomy, and the meteorology of New South Wales and Van Diemen's Land. London : John Murray xvi 504 pp.
- Anon. [Horton, D.] 1968. New lizard found in New England. The Armidale Express 7 Feb 1968: 5
- Anon. [Hunter, J.] in, White, J. 1790. Journal of a Voyage to New South Wales with sixty-five plates of non descript animals, birds, lizards, serpents, curious cones of trees and other natural productions. London : J. Debrett xvii 335 pp.
- Anonymous 1928. Notes and Comments. The Emu 27: 221 [Date published 1 Jan 1928]
- Anonymous 1986. Kakadu National Park Plan of Management. 6. Fauna. Australian National Parks and Wildlife Service, Canberra. 186 pp. 39-58 pp.
- Ansell, W.F.H. & Topál, G. 1976. The type locality of Miniopterus schreibersi (Kuhl) (Mammalia: Chiroptera). Vertebrata Hungarica 17: 15-17
- Anstee, S.D. 1996. Use of external mound structures as indicators of the presence of the pebble mound mouse, Pseudomys chapmani, in mound systems. Wildlife Research 23: 429-434
- Anstee, S.D., Roberts, J.D. & O'Shea, J.E. 1997. Social structure and patterns of movement of the western pebble-mound mouse, Pseudomys chapmani, at Marandoo, Western Australia. Wildlife Research 24: 295-306
- Anstis, M. 1973. Notes on Hoplocephalus bungaroides (broad headed snake) in captivity. Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Bulletin of Herpetology 1: 5-7
- Anstis, M. 1974. Australian frogs. Part 2. The behaviour and life history of Litoria verreauxi (Hylidae). Bulletin of Herpetology 1: 19-21
- Anstis, M. 1976. Breeding biology and larval development of Litoriam verreauxi (Anura: Hylidae). Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 100: 193-202
- Anstis, M. 1981. Breeding biology and range extension for the New South Wales frog Kyarranus sphagnicolus (Anura: Leptodactylidae). Australian Journal of Herpetology 1: 1-9
- Anstis, M., Roberts, J.D. & Altig, R. 2007. Direct development in two Myobatrachid Frogs, Arenophryne rotunda Tyler and Myobatrachus gouldii Gray, from Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 23: 259-272
- Antinori, O. 1864. Catalogo descrittivo di una Collezione di Uccelli fatta nell' interno dell' Affrica centrale Nord. Milano xxix, 118 pp.
- Aoyagi, H. 1949. Notes on the gobioid fishes of the Riu Kiu Islands. Zoological Magazine, Tokyo 58: 171-173 [in Japanese]
- Aoyagi, H. 1954. Description of one new genus and three new species of Blenniidae from the Riu-Kiu Islands. Zoological Magazine, Tokyo 63(5): 213-217
- Aoyagi, H. 1954. Studies on the coral fishes of the Riu-Kiu Islands. VIII. Gobiesocidae, Limnichthidae, Callionymidae, Parapercidae, Brotulidae, Bothidae and Soleidae. Zoological Magazine, Tokyo 63(6): 235-238
- Aplin, K.P. 1998. Three new blindsnakes (Squamata: Typhlopidae) from northwestern Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 19: 1-12
- Aplin, K.P. & Adams, A. 1998. Morphological and genetic discrimination of new species and subspecies of gekkonid and scincid lizards (Squamata: Lacertilia) from the Carnarvon Basin region of Western Australia. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 81: 201-223
- Aplin, K.P. & Archer, M. 1987. Recent advances in marsupial systematics with a new syncretic classification. pp. xv-lxxii in Archer, M. (ed.). Possums and Opossums: studies in evolution. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons with the Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 2 vols lxxii 788 pp.
- Aplin, K.P. & Donnellan, S.C. 1993. A new species of blindsnake, genus Ramphotyphlops (Typhlopidae, Squamata), from northwestern Western Australia, with a redescription of R. hamatus Storr, 1981. Records of the Western Australian Museum 16(2): 243- 256
- Aplin, K.P. & Smith 2001. Checklist of the frogs and reptiles of Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum Suppl. 63: 51-74
- Aplin, K.P. in Aplin, K.P. & Archer, M. 1987. Acrobatidae. xxii in Archer, M. (ed.). Possums and Opossums: studies in evolution. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons with the Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 2 vols lxxii 788 pp.
- Aplin, K.P., Brown, P.R., Jacob, J., Krebs, C.J. & Singleton, G.R. 2004. Field Methods for Rodent Studies in Asia and the Pacific. ACIAR Monograph No. 100. Canberra : Australian Centre for International Agricultural Research.
- Aplin, K.P., Chesser, T. & Have, J. 2003. Evolutionary biology of the genus Rattus: profile of an archetypal rodent pest. In, Singleton, G.R., Hinds, L.A., Krebs, C.K. & Spratt, D.M. (eds). Rats, Mice and People: Rodent Biology and Management. Canberra : Australian Centre for International Agricultural Research.
- Araga, C. & Yoshino, T. in Masuda, H., Araga, C. & Yoshino, T. 1975. Coastal Fishes of Southern Japan. Tokyo : Tokai University. Press 382 pp. 11 figs 143 pls.
- Arai, M. & Amaoka, K. 1996. Arnoglossus macrolophus Alcock (Pleuronectiformes: Bothidae); a valid species distinct from A. tapeinosomus (Bleeker). Ichthyological Research 43(4): 359-365 figs 1-4
- Arai, R. 1969. A new iniomous fish of the genus Neoscopelus from Suruga Bay, Japan. Bulletin of the National Science Museum, Tokyo 12(3): 465-470 figs 1-3 pl. 1 [Tokyo]
- Arai, T. & Iwamoto, T. 1979. A new species of the macrourid fish genus Coelorinchus from off Tasmania, New Zealand and the Falkland Islands. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 26(3): 238-246 figs 1-7
- Archer, F.I. & Perrin, W.F. 1999. Stenella coeruleoalba. Mammalian Species 603: 1-9
- Archer, M & Bartholomai, A. 1978. Tertiary mammals of Australia: a synoptic review. Alcheringa 2: 1-19
- Archer, M. 1975. Ningaui, a new genus of tiny dasyurids (Marsupialia) and two new species, N. timealeyi and N. ridei, from arid Western Australia. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 17: 237-249
- Archer, M. 1976. Application for the suppression of the name Sminthopsis murina var. constricta Spencer, 1896 (Marsupialia, Dasyuridae). Bulletin of Zoological Nomenclature 33: 127-128
- Archer, M. 1976. Revision of the marsupial genus Planigale Troughton (Dasyuridae). Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 17: 341-365 pls 43-51
- Archer, M. 1976. The basicranial region of marsupicarnivores (Marsupial), interrelationships of carnivorous marsupials, and affinities of the insectivorous peramelids. Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 59: 217-322
- Archer, M. 1977. Revision of the dasyurid marsupial genus Antechinomys Krefft. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 18: 17-29 pls 8-13
- Archer, M. 1979. The status of Australian dasyurids, thylacinids and myrmecobiids. pp. 29-43 in Tyler, M.J. (ed.). The Status of Endangered Australasian Wildlife. Adelaide : Royal Zoological Society of South Australia.
- Archer, M. 1979. Two new species of Sminthopsis Thomas (Dasyuridae: Marsupialia) from northern Australia, S. butleri and S. douglasi. The Australian Zoologist 20: 327-345
- Archer, M. 1981. Results of the Archbold Expeditions. No. 104 Systematic revision of the marsupial dasyurid genus Sminthopsis Thomas. Bulletin of the American Museum of Natural History 168: 61-224
- Archer, M. 1981. Systematic revision of the dasyurid marsupial genus Sminthopsis Thomas. Bulletin of the American Museum of Natural History 18: 61-224
- Archer, M. 1982. A review of Miocene thylacinids (Thylacinidae, Marsupialia), the phylogenetic position of the Thylacinidae and the problem of a priorisms in character analysis. pp. 445-476 in Archer, M. (ed.). Carnivorous Marsupials. Sydney : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Vol. 2 i-iv, 407 pp.
- Archer, M. 1982. Review of the dasyurid (Marsupialia) fossil record, integration of data bearing on phylogenetic interpretation, and suprageneric classification. pp. 397-443 in Archer, M. (ed.). Carnivorous Marsupials. Sydney : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Vol. 2 i-iv, 407 pp.
- Archer, M. 1984. Effects of humans on the Australian vertebrate fauna. pp. 151-161 in Archer, M. & Clayton, G. (eds). Vertebrate Zoogeography & Evolution in Australasia — Animals in Space & Time. Carlisle : Hesperian Press.
- Archer, M. 1984. The Australian marsupial radiation. pp. 633-808 in Archer, M. & Clayton, G. (eds). Vertebrate Zoogeography & Evolution in Australasia — Animals in Space & Time. Carlisle : Hesperian Press.
- Archer, M. 1984. The status of Australian dasyurids, thylacinids and myrmecobiids. pp. 1015-1021 in Archer, M. & Clayton, G. (eds). Vertebrate Zoogeography & Evolution in Australasia — Animals in Space & Time. Carlisle : Hesperian Press.
- Archer, M. & Kirsch, J.A.W. 1977. The case for the Thylacomyidae and Myrmecobiidae, Gill, 1872, or why are marsupial families so extended. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 102: 18-25
- Archey, G. 1921. A new species of shark. Transactions of the New Zealand Institute 53(23): 195-196 figs 1-2 pl. 39
- Armati-Gulson, P. & Lowe, J. 1984. The development of the reproductive system of the common Ringtail Possum, Pseudocheirus peregrinus (Marsupialia: Petauridae). Australian Mammalogy 7: 75-88
- Armstrong, G. 1982. Notes on feeding and growth rates in juvenile Chelodina longicollis. Herpetofauna 13: 27
- Armstrong, K.N. 2000. Roost microclimates of the bat Rhinonicteris aurantius in limestone cave in Geike Gorge, Western Australia. Australian Mammalogy 22: 69-70
- Armstrong, K.N. 2001. The roost habitat and distribution of the orange leaf-nosed bat, Rhinonicteris aurantius, in the Pilbara region of Western Australia. 28: 95-104
- Armstrong, K.N. 2006. Resolving the correct nomenclature of the orange leaf-nosed bat Rhinonicteris aurantia (Gray, 1845) (Hipposideridae). Australian Mammalogy 28: 125-130
- Armstrong, K.N. & Coles, R.B. 2007. Echolocation call frequency differences between isolates of Rhinonicteris aurantia (Chiroptera: Hipposideridae): implications of nasal chamber size. Journal of Mammalogy 88: 94-104
- Armstrong, M.H., Braun, E.L., & Kimball, R.T. 2001. Phylogenetic utility of the avian ovomucoid intron G: a comparison of the nuclear and mitochondrical phylogenies in Galliformes. Auk 118: 799-804
- Armstrong, S.M., Chesworth, M.J., Willig, R., Coleman, G.J. & Cassone, V.M. 1990. Unusual circadian activity rhythms in captive bandicoots Isoodon obesulus and Isoodon macrourus. pp. 271-283 in Seebeck, J.H., Brown, P.R., Wallis, R.L. & Kemper, C.M. (eds). Bandicoots and Bilbies. Chipping Norton : Surrey Beatty & Sons 392 pp.
- Arnason, U., Gullberg A. & Widegren, B. 1993. Cetacean mitochondrial DNA control region: sequences of all extant baleen whales and two sperm whale species. Molecular Biology and Evolution 10(5): 960–970
- Arnborn, T., Fedak, M.A., Boyd, I.L. & McConnell, B.J. 1993. Variation in weaning mass of pups in relation to maternal mass, postweaning fast duration, and weaned pup behaviour in southern elephant seals (Mirounga leonina) at South Georgia. Canadian Journal of Zoology 71: 1772-1781
- Arnold, A.H., Goldstraw, P.W., Hayes, A.G. & Wright, B.F. 1990. Recovery management of the eastern barred bandicoot in Victoria: the Hamilton conservation strategy. pp. 179-192 in Clark, T.W. & Seebeck, J.H. (eds). Management and conservation of small populations. Brookfield : Chicago Zoological Society 295 pp.
- Arnold, D.C. 1956. A systematic revision of the fishes of the teleost family Carapidae (Percomorphi, Blennioidea), with descriptions of two new species. Bulletin of the British Museum (Natural History) Historical Series 4(6): 245-307 figs 1-20
- Arnold, G.W., Grassia, A., Steven, D.E. & Weeldenburg, J.R. 1991. Population ecology of western grey kangaroos in a remnant of wandoo woodland at Baker's Hill, southern Western Australia. Wildlife Research 18: 561-575
- Arnold, G.W., Lecrivain, E., Johnson, K.G. & Grassia, A. 1988. Effects of weather conditions in summer on the maintenance of western grey kangaroos, Macropus fuliginosus. Australian Wildlife Research 15: 129-138
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D., Weeldenburg, J. & Brown, O.E. 1986. The use of alpha-chloralose for the repeated capture of western grey kangaroos, Macropus fuliginosus. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 527-533
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E. & Grassia, A. 1990. Associations between individuals and classes in groups of different size in a population of western grey kangaroos, Macropus fuliginosus. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 551-562
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E. & Weeldenburg, J.R. 1989. The effect of daylength and weather conditions on the time spent by western grey kangaroos (Macropus fuliginosus) on farmland. Applied Animal Behaviour Science 24: 353-360
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E. & Weeldenburg, J.R. 1989. The use of surrounding farmland by western grey kangaroos living in a remnant of wandoo woodland and their impact on crop production. Australian Wildlife Research 16: 85-93
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E. & Weeldenburg, J.R. 1994. Comparative ecology of western grey kangaroos (Macropus fuliginosus) and euros (M. robustus erubescens) in Durokoppin Nature Reserve, isolated in the central wheatbelt of Western Australia. Wildlife Research 21: 307-322
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E., Grassia, A. & Weeldenburg, J. 1992. Home range size and fidelity of western grey kangaroos (Macropus fuliginosus) living in remnants of wandoo woodland and adjacent farmland. Wildlife Research 19: 137-145
- Arnold, G.W., Steven, D.E., Weeldenburg, J.R. & Smith, E.A. 1993. Influences of remnant size, spacing pattern and connectivity on population boundaries and demography in euros Macropus robustus living in a fragmented landscape. Biological Conservation 64: 219-230
- Arnold, G.W., Weeldenburg, J.R. & Ng, V.M. 1995. Factors affecting the distribution and abundance of western grey kangaroos (Macropus fuliginosus) and euros (M. robustus) in a fragmented landscape. Landscape Ecology 10: 65-74
- Arnold, P. 1997. Occurrence of dwarf minke whales (Balaenoptera acutorostrata) on the northern Great Barrier Reef, Australia. Report of the International Whaling Commission 47: 419-424
- Arnold, P., Marsh, H. & Heinsohn, G. 1987. The occurrence of two forms of minke whales in east Australian waters with a description of external characters and skeleton of the diminutive or dwarf form. Scientific Reports of the Whales Research Institute, Tokyo 38: 1-46
- Arnold, P.W. & Heinsohn, G.E. 1996. Phylogenetic status of the Irrawaddy dolphin Orcaella brevirostris (Owen in Grey): A cladistic analysis. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 39: 141-204
- Arnold, P.W., Birtles, R.A., Dunstand, A., Lukoschek, V. & Matthews, M. 2005. Colour patterns of the dwarf minke whales Balaenoptera acutorostrata sensu lato: description, cladistic analysis and taxonomic implicatons. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 51: 277-307
- Arnould, J.P.Y. & Warneke, R.M. 2002. Growth and condition in Australian fur seals (Arctocephalus pusillus doriferus) (Carnivora: Pinnpedia). Australian Journal of Zoology 50: 53-66
- Arrowsmith, J. 1849. Map of Captn. Sturt's route from Adelaide into the centre of Australia, constructed from his original protractions, and other official documents.
- Artaud, S. 1803. Manuel d'Histoire Naturelle, traduit de l'allemand, de J. Fr. Blumenbach, Professeur a l'Université de Gottingue. Tome premier. Metz : Collignon xvi 528 pp.
- Arthington, A. & McKenzie, F. 1997. Review of Impacts of Displaced/Introduced Fauna Associated with Inland Waters. State of the Environment Technical Paper Series (Inland Waters). Department of the Environment : Canberra. 69 pp.
- Arthington, A.H., Milton, D.A. & McKay, R.J. 1983. Effects of urban development and habitat alterations on the distribution and abundance of native and exotic freshwater fish in the Brisbane region, Queensland. Australian Journal of Ecology 8(2): 87-101
- Arthur, W. 1885. Notes on New Zealand fishes. Transactions of the New Zealand Institute 17(16): 160-172 pl. 14
- Artner, H. 2003. Die rezenten Schildkrötenarten der Erde. Emys 10(6): IV-XXXVIII
- Artner, H. 2008. The world's extant turtles, Part 1. Emys 15: 4-32
- Arundel, J.H., Dempster, K.J., Harrigan, K.E. & Black, R. 1990. Epidemiological observations on the helminth parasites of Macropus giganteus Shaw in Victoria. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 39-51
- Asano, H. 1962. Studies on the congrid eels of Japan. Bulletin of the Misaki Marine Biological Institute. Kyoto University (1): 1-143 figs 1-62
- Ascanius, P. 1772. Icones rerum naturalium ou figures enluminées d'histoire naturelle du Nord. Cah. 2 pp. 1–8 pls 11–20 Copenhagen. [date fide Dean, B. 1917 Vol. 1: 38]
- Ashby, E. 1905. South Australian Ornithological Association. The Emu 5(1): 26-27 [Date published 1 Jul 1905]
- Ashby, E. 1910. Description of a new Acanthiza. The Emu 9(3): 137-138 [Date published 1 Jan 1910]
- Ashby, E. 1911. Description of a new Epthianura. The Emu 10(3): 251-252 [Date published 21 Jan 1911]
- Ashby, E. 1911. Description of a new Rhipidura. The Emu 11(1): 41 [Date published Jul 1911]
- Ashby, E. 1914. Halcyon macleayii coeruleus subsp. n.- The Northern Forest Kingfisher. South Australian Ornithologist 1(1): 20-21
- Ashby, E. 1914. Description of some interesting birds from the Northern Territory. South Australian Ornithologist 1(4): 26-27
- Ashby, E. 1915. Notes on Polophilus phasianinus melanurus Gld. (North-western Coucal). South Australian Ornithologist 2: 72
- Ashby, E. 1917. Description of a new sub-species of Platycercus elegans (Gmelin). The Emu 17: 43-45
- Ashby, E. 1920. Birds of Mount Compass District, South Australia. The Emu 19(4): 299-303 [Date published 29 May 1920]
- Ashby, E. 1921. Notes on birds observed in Western Australia from Perth northwards to Geraldton. The Emu 20(3): 130-137 [Date published 3 Jan 1921]
- Ashby, E. 1922. The Dusky Miner (Myzantha obscura), Gould, with its subspecies compared with the Yellow-throated Miner (Myzantha flavigula), Gould. The Emu 21(4): 252-256 [Date published 1 Apr 1922]
- Ashby, E. 1925. A review of Australian members of the Genus Zosterops. The Emu 25(2): 112-119 [Date published Oct 1925]
- Ashby, E. 1925. The Adelaide Rosella (Platycercus adelaidae. The Emu 25: 89-90
- Ashby, E. 1927. Sericornis osculans in Victoria. The Emu 26(4): 313-314 [Date published 1 Apr 1927]
- Ashby, E. 1927. The Grampian Range of Victoria and its bird life. The Emu 26(4): 285-292 [Date published 1 Apr 1927]
- Ashby, E. 1930. Notes on birds observed in mid-western Australia in October, 1927, with a decription of a new species of Coracina. The Emu 29(3): 183-192 [Date published 1 Jan 1930]
- Ashwell, K.W.S., Marotte, L.R., Li, Lixin & Waite, P.M.E. 1996. Anterior commissure of the wallaby (Macropus eugenii): Adult morphology and development. Journal of Comparative Neurology 366: 478-494
- Aslin, H.J. 1972. Nest-building of Leporillus conditor in captivity. South Australian Naturalist 47: 43-46
- Aslin, H.J. 1975. Reproduction in Antechinus maculatus Gould (Dasyuridae). Australian Wildlife Research 2: 77-80
- Aslin, H.J. 1983. Reproduction in Sminthopsis ooldea (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Australian Mammalogy 6: 93-95
- Aslin, H.J. 1995. Ooldea Dunnart Sminthopsis ooldea. pp. 152-153 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Aslin, H.J. & Lim, L. 1995. Kowari Dasyuroides byrnei. pp. 59-61 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Aslin, H.J. & Watts, C.H.S. 1980. Breeding of a captive colony of Notomys fuscus Wood Jones (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Wildlife Research 7: 379-383
- Aston, H.I. 1987. Influx of the grey-headed flying-fox Pteropus poliocephalus (Chiroptera: Pteropodidae) to the Melbourne area, Victoria, in 1986. Victorian Naturalist 104: 9-13
- Atherton, R.G. & Greeves, D. 1986. Torresian Imperial-Pigeon Ducula spilorrhoa on Green Is., north-eastern Queensland. The Emu 85: 261-263 [publication date Mathews, G.M. 1920. Dates of ornithological works. Austral Avian Records 4: 1–27]
- Atherton, R.G. & Haffenden, A.T. 1982. Observations on the reproduction and growth of the long-tailed pygmy possum, Cercartetus caudatus (Marsupialia, Burramyidae), in captivity. Australian Mammalogy 5: 253-259
- Atherton, R.G. & Haffenden, A.T. 1995. Long-tailed Pygmy-possum Cercartetus caudatus. pp. 211-212 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Atherton, R.G., Matthew, P.A. & Winter, J.W. 1980. Notes on the crop contents and locality records of the Marbled Frogmouth Podargus ocellatus marmoratus Gould from Cape York Peninsula. Sunbird 11: 71-72
- Attard, S.M. & McKillup, S.C. 1998. Reproduction and growth of the bandicoot Isoodon macrourus at four sites in Rockhampton, Queensland. Australian Mammalogy 20: 409-410
- Attiwill, A.R. 1960. Red-tailed Black Cockatoo in South-East of South Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 23: 37-38 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp. Waterhouse, F.H. 1885. The Dates of Publication of some of the Zoological Works of the late John Gould, F.R.S. London : R.H. Porter xi 59 pp. [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp. Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]]
- Au, K.-C. 1979. Systematic study on the barracudas (Pisces: Sphyraenidae) from a northern sector of the South China Sea. Journal of Natural History 13: 619-647, 2 figs
- Augee, M. & Gooden, B. 1993. Echidnas of Australia and New Guinea. Kensington : University of NSW Press 76 pp.
- Augee, M.L. (ed.) 1978. Monotreme biology. Proceedings of a symposium held in Sydney, May 1978. The Australian Zoologist 20: 1-257
- Augee, M.L. (ed.) 1992. Platypus and Echidnas. Mosman : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 296 pp.
- Augee, M.L. (ed.) 2004. Monotremes III. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 125: 217-327
- Augee, M.L., Beard, L.A., Grigg, G.C. & Raison, J.K. 1992. Home range of echidnas in the Snowy Mountains. pp. 225-231 in Augee, M.L. (ed.). Platypus and Echidnas. Mosman : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 296 pp.
- Augee, M.L., Smith, B. & Rose, S. 1996. Survival of wild and hand-reared ringtail possums (Pseudocheirus peregrinus) in bushland near Sydney. Wildlife Research 23: 99-108
- Austin, C.N. 1956. Range extention of three bird species. The Emu 56: 80-81
- Australian Herpetological Society Members 1976. (Observations on the eastern water dragon Physignathus lesueurii in the natural state and in captivity). Herpetofauna 8: 20-22
- Axelrod, H.R. 1973. A colorful beauty from the coral reefs of Indonesia. Tropical Fish Hobbyist 21(April): 5-10 2 figs
- Ayling, A.M. & Russell, B.C. 1977. The labrid fish genus Pseudojuloides with description of a new species. The Australian Zoologist 19(2): 169-178 figs 1-10
- Ayling, T. & Cox, G.J. 1982. Collins Guide to the Seafishes of New Zealand. Auckland : Collins 343 pp. 48 pls 475 figs.
- Ayres, W.O. 1848. On a very curious fish for which the name Malacosteus niger is proposed. Proceedings of the Boston Society of Natural History 3: 69-70
- Ayres, W.O. 1855. Description of new species of Californian fishes. Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 1 1(1): 76-77
- Babu Rao, M. 1966. A new species of Stolephorus Lacépède from the east coast of India (Pisces : Engraulidae). Annals and Magazine of Natural History 13 9: 101-110 pls 3-4
- Backhouse, G.N. & Slater, G. 1995. Recovery plan for the eastern barred bandicoot Perameles gunnii 1995-96. Dept. Conservation and Natural Resources and Zoological Board of Victoria, Melbourne.
- Badcock, J. 1982. A new species of the deep-sea fish genus Cyclothone Goode & Bean (Stomiatoidei, Gonostomatidae) from the tropical Atlantic. Journal of Fish Biology 20(2): 197-211
- Badham, J.A. 1971. Albumin formation in eggs of the agamid Amphibolurus barbatus barbatus. Copeia 1971: 543-545
- Badham, J.A. 1976. The Amphibolurus barbatus species-group (Lacertilia: Agamidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 24: 423-443
- Badman, F.J. 1981. Bourke's Parrot in the western Lake Eyre drainage. South Australian Ornithologist 28: 161-164
- Baehr, M. 1976. Beiträge zur Verbreitung und Ökologie Tasmanischer Reptilien. Stuttgarter Beiträge zur Naturkunde. Serie A (Biologie) 292: 1-24
- Baehr, M. 1976. Beobachtungen zur bipeden Fortbewegung bei der australischen Agame Physignathus longirostris (Boulenger). Stuttgarter Beiträge zur Naturkunde. Serie A (Biologie) 291: 1-7
- Bagarinao, T. 1994. Systematics, distribution, genetics, and life history of milkfish. Environmental Biology of Fishes 39: 23-41
- Bagarinao, T. 1999. Ecology and Farming of Milkfish. Iliolo, Philippines : SEAFDEC Agriculture Department 153 pp.
- Bagarinao, T. 1999. Family Chanidae. pp. 1822-1824 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Bailey, P. & Best, L.A. 1992. A red kangaroo, Macropus rufus, recovered 25 years after marking in north-western New South Wales. Australian Mammalogy 15: 141
- Baird, R.C. 1971. The systematics, distribution and zoogeography of the marine hatchetfishes (family Sternoptychidae). Bulletin of the Museum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard 142(1): 1-128 figs 1-80
- Baird, R.F. 1985. Avian fossils from Quaternary deposits in 'Green Waterhole Cave', south-eastern South Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 37: 353-370
- Baird, R.F. 1986. Historical records of the Glossy Black Cockatoo Calyptorhynchus lathami and Red-tailed Black Cockatoo C. magnificus in south-eastern Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 30: 38-45
- Baird, S.F. 1858. Report Expl. Survey Pacific Ocean. Pacific R.R. Report IX. Richmond Catalogue.
- Baissac, J. de B. 1953. Contribution a l'étude des poissons de l'Île Maurice. V. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Arts and Sciences of Mauritius 1(3): 185-240 [dated 1952]
- Baissac, J. de B. 1956. Description d'un nouveau Serranidae de l'Île Maurice. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Arts and Sciences of Mauritius 1(4): 395-396
- Baker, A. 1998. Whales and Dolphins of Australia and New Zealand. Wellington : Victoria University Press.
- Baker, A.N. 1983. Whales and Dolphins of New Zealand and Australia. Wellington : Victoria University Press 133 pp.
- Baker, A.N. 1985. Pygmy right whale Caperea marginata (Gray, 1846). pp. 345-354 in Ridgway, S.H. & Harrison, R.J. (eds). Handbook of Marine Mammals. Volume 3. The sirenians and baleen whales. London : Academic Press 362 pp.
- Baker, A.N. 2001. Status, relationshoips, and distribution of Mesoplodon bowdoini Andrews, 1908 (Cetacea: Ziphiidae). Marine Mammal Science 17: 473-493
- Baker, C.S., Perry, A., Bannister, J.L. et al. 1993. Abundant mitochondrial DNA variation and world-wide population structure in humpback whales. Problemi Attuali di Scienza e di Cultura 90: 8239-8243
- Baker, C.S., Slade, R.W., Bannister, J.L. et al. 1994. Hierarchical structure of mitochondrial DNA gene flow among humpback whales Megaloptera novaeangliae, world-wide whales. Molecular Ecology 3: 313-328
- Baker, E.C.S. 1942. Cuckoo Problems. London : H.F. & G. Witherby 207 pp.
- Baker, G.D. & Degabrielle, R. 1987. The diet of the red fox (Vulpes vulpes) in the Eldorado Hills of north-east Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 104: 39-42
- Baker, J.K. 1979. The rainbow skink, Lampropholis delicata, in Hawaii. Pacific Science 33: 207-212
- Baker, J.R. & Bird, T.F. 1936. The seasons in a tropical rainforest (New Hebrides).—Part 4. Insectivorous bats (Vespertilionidae and Rhinolophidae). Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 40: 143-161 pl. 4
- Baker, M.L., Canfield, P.J., Gemmell, R.T., Spencer, P.B.S. & Agar, N.S. 1995. Erythrocyte metabolism in the koala, the common brushtail possum and the whiptail wallaby. Comparative Haematology International 5: 163-169
- Baker, M.W. de C. & Croft, D.B. 1993. Vocal communication between the mother and young of the eastern grey kangaroo, Macropus giganteus, and the red kangaroo, M. rufus (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 41: 257-272
- Baker, S.J. 1990. Escaped exotic mammals in Britain. Mammal Review 20: 75-96
- Bakker, A.J., Parkinson, A.L. & Head, S.I. 2005. Contractile properties of single-skinned skeletal muscle fibres of the extensor digitorum longus muscle of the Australian short-nosed echidna. Australian Journal of Zoology 53: 237-240
- Bakker, H.R. & Bradshaw, S.D. 1983. Renal function in the spectacled hare-wallaby, Lagorchestes conspicillatus: effects of dehydration and protein deficiency. Australian Journal of Zoology 31: 101-108
- Bakker, H.R. & Bradshaw, S.D. 1989. Rate of water turnover and electrolyte balance of an arid-zone marsupial, the spectacled hare-wallaby (Lagorchestes conspicillatus) on Barrow Island. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 92(A): 521-529
- Bakker, H.R., Bradshaw, S.D. & Main, A.R. 1982. Water and electrolyte metabolism of the tammar wallaby Macropus eugenii. Physiological Zoology 55: 209-219
- Balcomb, K.C. 1989. Baird’s Beaked Whale Berardius bairdii Stejneger, 1833: Arnoux’s Beaked Whale Berardius arnuxii Duvernoy, 1851. pp. 261-288 in Ridgway, S.H. & Harrison, R.J. (eds). Handbook of Marine Mammals. Volume 4. River dolphins and the larger toothed whales. London : Academic Press 442 pp.
- Baldamus, E. 1870. [Title not located]. Journal für Ornithologie 17
- Baldwin, C.C. 1990. Morphology of the larvae of American Anthiinae (Teleostei: Serranidae), with comments on relationships within the subfamily. Copeia 1990(4): 913-955
- Baldwin, C.C. & Johnson, G.D. 1993. Phylogeny of the Epinephelinae (Teleostei: Serranidae). Bulletin of Marine Science 52(1): 240-283
- Baldwin, C.C. & Johnson, G.D. 1996. Interrelationships of Aulopiformes. pp. 355-404 in Stiassny, M.L.J., Parenti, L.R. & Johnson, G.D. (eds). Interrelationships of Fishes. San Diego : Academic Press 496 pp.
- Baldwin, C.C. & Johnson, G.D. 1999. Paxton concilians: a new genus and species of pseudamine apogonid (Teleostei: Percoidei) from northwestern Australia: The sister group of the enigmatic Gymnapogon. Copeia 1999(4): 1050-1071
- Baldwin, C.C. & Smith, W.L. 1998. Belonoperca pylei, a new species of seabass (Teleostei: Serranidae: Epinephelinae: Diploprionini) from the Cook Islands with comments on relationships among diploprionins. Ichthyological Research 45(4): 325-339
- Baldwin, C.C., Johnson, G.D. & Colin, P.L. 1991. Larvae of Diploprion bifasciatum, Belonoperca chabanaudi and Grammistes sexlineatus (Serranidae: Epinephelinae) with a comparison of known larvae of other epinephelines. Bulletin of Marine Science 48(1): 67-93
- Baldwin, W.J. 1972. A new genus and new species of Hawaiian gobiid fish. Pacific Science 26(1): 125-128 figs 1-4
- Ball, D. 2004. Distribution and habitat of the false water rat, Xeromys myoides Thomas, 1889 (Rodentia: Muridae) in intertidal areas of central eastern Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 49: 487-494
- Ball, T., Adams, E. & Goldingay, R.L. 2009. Diet of the squirrel glider in a fragmented landscape near Mackay, central Queensland. Australian Journal of Zoology 57(5): 295-304
- Balushkin, A.V. 2000. Morphology, classification, and evolution of notothenioid fishes of the Southern Ocean (Notothenioidei, Perciformes). Journal of Ichthyology 40(Supplement 1): 74-109
- Balushkin, A.V. & Fedorov, V.V. 1985. Caulophryne pietschi sp. nov. - a new species of Moss anglerfish (Caulophrynidae) from the southwestern Pacific Ocean. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 25(6): 1035-1037
- Bamber, R.C. 1915. Reports on the marine biology of the Sudanese Red Sea, from collections made by Cyril Crossland, M.A., B.Sc., F.Z.S. — XXII. The fishes. Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 31: 477-485 pl. 46
- Bancroft, E.N. 1829. On the fish known in Jamaica as the sea devil (Cephalopholis manta). Zoological Journal London 4: 444-457
- Bankier, R.A. 1841. A new species of the Australian genus Alcyone. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 1 6: 394-395
- Banks, C. 1981. Notes on seasonal colour change in a western brown snake. Herpetofauna 13: 29-30
- Banks, P.B. 1998. Responses of Australian bush rats, Rattus fuscipes, to the odour of introduced Vulpes vulpes. Journal of Mammalogy 79: 1260-1264
- Banks, P.B. 1999. Predation by introduced foxes on native bush rats in Australia: do foxes take the doomed surplus? Journal of Applied Ecology 36: 1063-1071
- Banks, P.B. & Dickman, C.R. 2000. Effects of winter food supplementation on reproduction, body mass, and numbers of mammals in montane Australia. Canadian Journal of Zoology 78: 1775-1783
- Banks, S.C., Finlayson, G.R., Lawson, S.J., Lindenmayer, D.B., Petkau, D., Ward, S.J. & Taylor, A.C. 2005. The effects of habitat fragmentation due to forestry plantation establishment on demography and genetic variation in a marsupial carnivore, Antechinus agilis. Biological Conservation 12: 851-597
- Banks, S.C., Hoyle, S.D., Horsuup, A., Sunnucks, P. & Taylor, A.C. 2003. Demographic monitoring of an entire species (the northern hairy-nosed wombat, Lasiorhinus krefftii) by genetic analysis of non-invasively collected material. Animal Conservation 6: 101-107
- Bannikov, A.F. & Tyler, J.C. 1995. Phylogenetic revision of the fish families Luvaridae and †Kushlukiidae (Acanthuroidei), with a new genus and two new species of Eocene luvarids. Smithsonian Contributions to Zoology 81: 1-45
- Bannister, J.L. 1974. Whale populations and current research off Western Australia. pp. 239-254 in Schevill, W.E. (ed.). The Whale Problem. A status report. Cambridge, Mass : Harvard University Press pp. 1-419.
- Bannister, J.L. 1985. Southern right (Eubalaena australis) and humpback (Megaptera novaeangliae) whales off Western Australia: some recent aerial survey work. pp. 105-113 in Ling, J.K. & Bryden, M.M. (eds). Studies of sea mammals in south latitudes. Adelaide : South Australian Museum 132 pp.
- Bannister, J.L. 1986. Southern Right Whales: Status off Australia from 20th Century 'incidental' sightings and aerial survey. pp. 153–158 in, Rept. Int. Whal. Comm. Special Issue 10. 289 pp.
- Bannister, J.L. 1989. Balaenidae. pp. 988-992 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1B 827 pp.
- Bannister, J.L. 1989. Balaenopteridae. pp. 982-987 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1B 827 pp.
- Bannister, J.L. 1989. Physeteridae. pp. 965-969 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1B 827 pp.
- Bannister, J.L. 1990. Southern right whales off Western Australia. Reports of the International Whaling Commission 12(special issue): 279-288
- Bannister, J.L. 2001. Status of southern right whales (Eubalaena australis) off Australia. Journal of Cetacean Research and Management Special Issue 2: 103-110
- Bannister, J.L. & Hedley, S.L. 2001. Southern Hemisphere Group IV humpback whales: their status from recent aerial survey. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 47: 587-598
- Bannister, J.L., Kemper, C.M. & Warneke, R.M. 1996. The Action Plan for Australian Cetaceans. Canberra : Australian Nature Conservation Agency 242 pp.
- Bannister, J.L., Kirkwood, G.P. & Wayte, S.E. 1991. Increase in humpback whales off Western Australia. Reports of the International Whaling Commission 41: 461-465
- Barbour, T. 1914. On some Australian reptiles. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 27: 201-206
- Barbour, T. 1921. Reptiles and amphibians from the British Solomon Islands. Proceedings of the New England Zoological Club 7: 91-112
- Barbour, T. & Cole, 1906. On Reptilia, Amphibia and Pisces. Bulletin of the Museum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard 50: 146-155
- Barbour, T. & Loveridge, A. 1929. Typical reptiles and amphibians in the Museum of Comparative Zoology. Bulletin of the Museum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard 69: 205-360
- Barboza, P.S. 1993. Effects of restricted water intake on digestion, urea cycling and renal functioning in wombats (Marsupialia: Vombatidae) from contrasting habitats. Australian Journal of Zoology 41: 527-536
- Barboza, P.S. & Hume, I.D. 1992. Digestive tract morphology and digestion in the wombats (Marsupialia, Vombatidae). Journal of Comparative Physiology B 162: 552-560
- Barboza, P.S. & Hume, I.D. 1992. Hindgut fermentation in the wombats - two marsupial grazers. Journal of Comparative Physiology B 162: 561-566
- Barclay Rose, A. 1973. The food of the White-throated Nightjar. Australian Birds 8: 31-32
- Barclay Rose, A. 1976. Mass of wild birds of the order Caprimulgiformes. Australian Bird Bander 14: 50-51
- Barker, J., Grigg, G. & Tyler, M. 1995. A Field Guide to Australian Frogs. Chipping Norton, NSW : Surrey Beatty & Sons 1995 edn xi, 407 pp.
- Barker, R.D. & Caughley, G. 1990. Distribution and abundance of kangaroos (Marsupialia: Macropodidae) at the time of European contact: Tasmania. Australian Mammalogy 13: 157-166
- Barker, R.D. & Caughley, G. 1994. The distribution and abundance of kangaroos (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). Australian Mammalogy 17: 73-84
- Barker, R.D. & Vestjens, W.J.M. 1990. The Food of Australian Birds. 2 Passerines. Canberra : CSIRO Australia.
- Barker, S.C. 1990. Behaviour and social organisation of the allied rock-wallaby Petrogale assimilis, Ramsey, 1877 (Marsupialia: Macropodoidea). Australian Wildlife Research 17: 301-311
- Barlow, N.D. 1994. Predicting the effect of a novel vertebrate biocontrol agent - a model for viral vectored immunocontraception of New Zealand possums. Journal of Applied Ecology 31: 454-462
- Barnard, H.G. 1911. Field notes from Cape York. The Emu 11: 17-32
- Barnard, H.G. 1926. Birds of the Cardwell District, Queensland, Pt 1. The Emu 26: 1-13
- Barnard, H.G. 1935. Notes on the Large-tailed Nightjar. The Emu 34: 176-177
- Barnard, K.H. 1923. Diagnoses of new species of marine fishes from South African waters. Annals of the South African Museum 13(8): 439-444
- Barnard, K.H. 1925. A monograph of the marine fishes of South Africa. Part 1. (Amphioxus, Cyclostomata, Elasmobranchii, and Teleostei — Isospondyli to Heterosomata). Annals of the South African Museum 21(1): 1-418 figs 1-18 pls 1-17
- Barnard, K.H. 1927. A monograph of the marine fishes of South Africa. Part 2. (Teleostei — Discocephali to end. Appendix). Annals of the South African Museum 21(2): 419-1065 figs 19-32 pls 18-37
- Barnard, K.H. 1927. Diagnoses of new genera and species of South African marine fishes. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 9 20(8): 66-79
- Barnard, K.S. 1925. Descriptions of new species of marine fishes from S. Africa. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 9 15(88): 498-504
- Barnes, L.G. 1985. Evolution, taxonomy and antitropical distribution of the the porpoises (Phocoenidae, Mammalia). Marine Mammal Science 1: 149-163
- Barnett, B. 1977. Additional notes on new-born centralian bluetongues, Tiliqua multifasciata. Victorian Herpetological Society Newsletter 1: 10
- Barnett, B. 1980. Captive breeding and a novel egg incubation technique of the Children's python (Liasis childreni). Herpetofauna 11: 15-18
- Barnett, M.A. & Gibbs, R.H. 1968. Four new stomiatoid fishes of the genus Bathophilus with a revised key to the species of Bathophilus. Copeia 1968(4): 826-832
- Barnett, S.A. 1976. The Rat: a Study in Behavior. Revised Edition. Canberra : Australian National University Press xiv 318 pp.
- Barneville, B. de 1847. Note sur un nouveau genre d'Anguilliformes. Revue de Zoologie, Paris 1847: 219-220
- Barnicoat, F.C. 1976. Breeding of the Little Lorikeet. Aviculture Magazine 82: 65-67
- Barratt, D.G. 1997. Predation by house cats, Felis catus (L.) in Canberra, Australia. I. Prey composition and preference. Wildlife Research 24: 263-278
- Barratt, D.G. 1998. Predation by house cats, Felis catus (L.), in Canberra, Australia. II. Factors affecting the amount of prey caught and estimates of wildlife impact. Wildlife Research 25: 475-488
- Barrett, C. 1931. Australian Birds & Butterflies. Series 3. Melbourne : Sun Nature Book Series 44 pp.
- Barrett, C. 1933. Water Life. Sun Nature Book 4. Melbourne : Sun News Pictorial Vol. 1 44 pp. 167 figs.
- Barrett, C. 1950. Reptiles of Australia. London : Cassell 168 pp.
- Barrett-Hamilton, G.E.H. 1911. A History of British Mammals. Pt IV. London : Gurney & Jackson 25-32,169-208-1 pl. (unnumbered), pl.
- Barrow, G.J. 1964. Hydromys chrysogaster —some observations. Queensland Naturalist 17: 43-44
- Bartholemew, G.A. & Tucker, V.A. 1963. Control of changes in body temperature, metabolism, and circulation by the agamid lizard, Amphibolurus barbatus. Physiological Zoology 36: 199-218
- Bartholemew, G.A., Tucker, V.A. & Lee, A.K. 1965. Oxygen consumption, thermal conductance, and heart rate in the Australian skink Tiliqua scincoides. Copeia 1965: 169-173
- Bartholomai, A. 1975. The genus Macropus Shaw (Marsupialia: Macropodidae) in the Cainozoic deposits of Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 17: 195-235
- Bartholomew, G.A., Leitner, P. & Nelson, J.E. 1964. Body temperature, oxygen consumption, and heart rate in three species of Australian flying foxes. Physiological Zoology 37: 179-198
- Barton, O. 1950. A new Siganus, from the Great Barrier Reef, Australia. American Museum Novitates 1464: 1-2
- Barwick, R.E. & Bryant, C. 1966. Physiological and biochemical aspects of hibernation in the scincid lizard Egernia cunninghami (Gray, 1832). Physiological Zoology 39: 1-20
- Bass, A.J. 1979. Records of little-known sharks from Australian waters. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 103(4): 247-254 figs 1-5 [1978]
- Bass, A.J., D'Aubrey, J.D. & Kistnasamy, N. 1975. Sharks of the east coast of southern Africa. Part 4. The families Odontaspididae, Scapanorhynchidae, Isuridae, Cetorhinidae, Alopiidae, Orectolobidae and Rhiniodontidae. Investigational Report. Oceanographical Research Institute, Durban 39: 1-102 figs 1-24 pls 1-15
- Bass, A.J., D'Aubrey, J.D. & Kistnasamy, N. 1975. Sharks of the east coast of southern Africa. Part 5. The families Hexanchidae, Chlamydoselachidae, Heterodontidae, Pristiophoridae and Squatinidae. Investigational Report. Oceanographical Research Institute, Durban 43: 1-50 figs 1-12 pls 1-9
- Bass, A.J., D'Aubrey, J.D. & Kistnasamy, N. 1976. Sharks of the east coast of southern Africa. Part 6. The families Oxynotidae, Squalidae, Dalatiidae and Echinorhinidae. Investigational Report. Oceanographical Research Institute, Durban 45: 1-103 figs 1-36 pls 1-11 [S. Afr.]
- Bass, D.A. 1990. Dispersal of an introduced shrub (Crataegus monogyna) by the brush-tailed possum (Trichosurus vulpecula). Australian Journal of Ecology 15: 227-229
- Bassett-Hull, A.F. 1910. The Birds of Lord Howe and Norfolk Islands. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 34: 636-693
- Bates, P.J. & Harrison, D.L. 1997. Bats of the Indian subcontinent. Sevenoaks : Harrison Zoological Museum 258 pp.
- Bath, H. 1977. Revision der Blenniini (Pisces: Blenniidae). Senckenbergiana Biologica 57(4/6): 167-234 figs 1-77
- Bath, H. 1989. Eine weitere Unterart von Parablennius tasmanianus (Richardson 1849) (Pisces: Blenniidae). Senckenbergiana Biologica 69(4/6): 293-300
- Bath, H. 1992. Zwei neue Arten der Gattung Salarias Cuvier 1817 von den Philippinen und von Westaustralien (Pisces: Blenniidae). Senckenbergiana Biologica 72(4/6): 225-236
- Bath, H. 1996. Beitrag zur Osteologie der Arten der Tribus Parablenniini. Die Beziehungen der Knochen des Schädeldaches zum Seitenorgan-System und zu den Weichteilbildungen der Kopfoberseite sowie die systematische Bedeutung der Befunde nebst Bemerkungen. Senckenbergiana Biologica 76(1/2): 65-92
- Bath, H. 2001. Osteology and morphology of fishes of the subfamily Salariinae and its junior synonym Parablenniinae (Pisces: Blenniidae). Stuttgarter Beiträge zur Naturkunde. Serie A (Biologie) 628: 1-42
- Bath, H. 2004. Revision of the genus Rhabdoblennius Whitley (Pisces: Blenniidae: Salariinae), with descriptions of two new species. Stuttgarter Beiträge zur Naturkunde. Serie A (Biologie) 669: 1-26
- Bath, H. 2008. Review of the genus Parablennius Miranda-Ribeiro from Australia and New Caledonia (Pisces: Blenniidae: Salariinae). Stuttgarter Beiträge zur Naturkunde. Serie A (Biologie) Neue Serie 1: 77-94
- Bath, H. & Hutchins, B. 1986. Die Blenniini des australischen Raums und Neuseelands mit Beschreibung einer neuen Art und einer neuen Unterart. Senckenbergiana Biologica 66(4/6): 167-213 figs 1-47
- Bath, H. & Randall, J.E. 1991. Synopsis der Gattung Salarias Cuvier 1817 mit Beschreibung einer neuen Art (Pisces: Blenniidae). Senckenbergiana Biologica 71(4/6): 245-258 figs 1-9
- Battersby, J.C. 1959. Reptiles. Zoological Records 93: 1-122
- Bauchot, J.E., Desoutter, M. & Randall, J.E. 1984. Catalogue critique des types de Poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire naturelle (suite) (Famille des Serranidae). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 4e supplément 6(3): 3-82
- Bauchot, M.-L. 1963. Catalogue critique des types de poissons du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. II. Familles des Chaetodontidae, Scatophagidae, Toxotidae, Monodactylidae, Ephippidae, Scorpidae, Pempheridae, Kyphosidae, Girellidae. Publications du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 20: 115-195
- Bauchot, M.-L. 1970. Catalogue critique des types de poissons du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle (Lampridiformes, Stéphanobéryciformes, Béryciformes, Zéiformes, Coryphaeniformes). Publications Diverses du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 24: 1-55
- Bauchot, M.-L. & Desoutter, M. 1989. Catalogue critique des types de poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire naturelle. (Suite) Sous-ordre des Percoidei (Familles des Aplodactylidae, Apolectidae, Arripidae, Cepolidae, Cheilodactylidae, Chironemidae, Cirrhitidae, Echeneidae, Enoplosidae, Embiotocidae, Gerreidae, Lactariidae, Latrididae, Leiognathidae, Lobotidae, Malacanthidae, Menidae, Nandidae, Oplegnathidae, Owstoniidae, Pomatomidae et Rachycentridae). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 11(2): 1-58
- Bauchot, M.-L. & Guibé, J. 1960. Catalogue des types de poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire Naturelle. Famille des Scaridae. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 2 32(4): 290-300
- Bauchot, M.-L. & Randall, J.E. 1996. Catalogue des types de poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire Naturelle. (Suite). Families des Acanthuridae et des Zanclidae. Cybium 20(1): 55-74
- Bauchot, M.-L., Desoutter, M. & Castle, P.H.J. 1993. Catalogue critique des types de poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire naturelle. Cybium 17(2): 91-151
- Bauchot, M.-L., Desoutter, M. & McKay, R.J. 1983. Catalogue critique des types de Poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire naturelle (Suite) (Famille des Haemulidae et des Sillaginidae). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 4 5(A2): 27-61
- Bauchot, M.-L., Desoutter, M., Guézé, P. & Randall, J.E. 1985. Catalogue critique des types de Poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire Naturelle (Famille des Mullidae). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 4e 7(A2, suppl.): 1-25
- Bauchot, M.-L., Desoutter, M., Hoese, D.F. & Larson, H.K. 1991. Catalogue critique des types de poissons du Muséum national d'Histoire naturelle (Suite) Sous-ordre des Gobioidei. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 4 13(section A, 1–2, supplement): 1-82
- Bauchot-Boutin, M.-L. 1959. Etude des larves leptocéphales du groupe Leptocephalus lanceolatus Strömman et identification à la famille des Serrivomeridae. Dana Reports 48: 1-148 figs 1-105 pls 1-2
- Bauchot-Boutin, M.L. 1953. Révision synoptique du genre Serrivomer (Anguilliformes). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 25(4): 365-367 4 figs
- Baudinette, R.V. 1994. Locomotion in macropodoid marsupials: gaits, energetics and heat balance. Australian Journal of Zoology 42: 103-124
- Baudinette, R.V., Gannon, B.J., Runciman, W.B. & Wells, W.B. 1987. Do cardiorespiratory frequencies show entrainment with hopping in the tammar wallaby? Journal of Experimental Biology 129: 251-264
- Baudinette, R.V., Nagle, K.A. & Scott, R.A.D. 1976. Locomotory energetics in a marsupial (Antechinomys spenceri) and a rodent (Notomys alexis). Experientia (Basel) 32: 583-585
- Baudinette, R.V., Wells, R.T., Sanderson, K.J. & Clark, B. 1994. Microclimatic conditions in maternity caves of the bent-wing bat, Miniopterus schreibersii: an attempted restoration of a former maternity site. Wildlife Research 21: 607-619
- Bauer, A.M. 1990. Phylogenetic systematics and biogeography of the Carphodactylini (Reptilia: Gekkonidae). Bonner Zoologische Monographien 30: 1-220
- Bauer, A.M. & Russell, A.P. 1988. The morphology of the gekkonid cutaneous sensilla, with comments on function and phylogeny in the Carphodactylini (Reptilia: Gekkonidae). Canadian Journal of Zoology 66: 1583-1588
- Bauer, A.M., Günther, R. & Klipfel, M. 1995. The herpetological contributions of Wilhelm C. H. Peters (1815–1883). Society of Amphibians and Reptiles. 714 pp.
- Bavay, A. 1869. Catalogue des reptiles de la Nouvelle-Calédonie et description d'espèces nouvelles. Mémoires de la Société Linnéenne de Normandie 15: 1-37
- Baverstock, P., Kreig, M. & Birrell, J. 1990. Evolutionary relationships of Australian marsupials as assessed by albumin immunology. pp. 131-145 in Marshall Graves, J.A., Hope, R.M. & Cooper, D.W. (eds). Mammals from pouches and eggs. Genetics, breeding and evolution of marsupials and monotremes. Melbourne : CSIRO.
- Baverstock, P.R. 1975. Effect of variations in rate of growth on physiological parameters in the lizard Amphibolurus ornatus. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 51A: 619-632
- Baverstock, P.R. 1984. The molecular relationships of Australasian possums and gliders. pp. 1-8 in Smith, A. & Hume, I. (eds). Possums and Gliders. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons, Australian Mammal Society 598 pp.
- Baverstock, P.R. & Bradshaw, S.D. 1975. Variation in rate of growth and adrenal cortico steroidogenesis in field and laboratory populations of the lizard Amphibolurus ornatus. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 52A: 557-565
- Baverstock, P.R., Adams, M. & Archer, M. 1984. Electrophoretic resolution of species boundaries in the Sminthopsis murina complex (Dasyuridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 32: 823-832 [Dec. 1984]
- Baverstock, P.R., Adams, M., Archer, M., McKenzie, N.L. & How, R. 1983. An electrophoretic and chromosomal study of the dasyurid marsupial genus Ningaui Archer. Australian Journal of Zoology 31: 381-392
- Baverstock, P.R., Adams, M., Reardon, T. & Watts, C.H.S. 1987. Electrophoretic resolution of species boundaries in Australian Microchiroptera. III. The Nycticeiini — Scotorepens and Scoteanax (Chiroptera: Vespertilionidae). Australian Journal of Biological Sciences 40: 413-433
- Baverstock, P.R., Archer, M., Adams, M. & Richardson, B.J. 1982. Genetic relationships among 32 species of Australian dasyurid marsupials. pp. 641-650 in Archer, M. (ed.). Carnivorous Marsupials. Sydney : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Vol. 2 i-iv, 407 pp.
- Baverstock, P.R., Hogarth, J.T., Cole, S. & Covacevich, J. 1976. Biochemical and karyotypic evidence for the specific status of the rodent Leggadina lakedownensis Watts. Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 100: 109-112
- Baverstock, P.R., Kreig, M., Birrell, J. & McKay, G.N. 1990. Albumin immunologic relationships of Australian marsupials II. The Pseudocheiridae. Australian Journal of Zoology 38: 519-526
- Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S. & Hogarth, J.T. 1976. Heterochromatin variation in the Australian rodent Uromys caudimaculatus. Chromosoma (Berlin) 57: 397-403
- Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S. & Hogarth, J.T. 1977. Chromosome evolution in Australian rodents I. The Pseudomyinae, the Hydromyinae and the Uromys/Melomys Group. Chromosoma (Berlin) 61: 95-125
- Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S., Adams, M. & Cole, S.R. 1981. Genetical relationships among Australian rodents (Muridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 29: 289-303
- Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S., Adams, M. & Gelder, M. 1980. Chromosomal and electrophoretic studies of Australian Melomys (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 28: 553-574
- Baverstock, P.R., Watts, C.H.S., Hogarth, J.T., Robinson, A.C. & Robinson, J.F. 1977. Chromosome evolution in Australian rodents II. The Rattus Group. Chromosoma (Berlin) 61: 227-241
- Baxter, C. & Parker, S.A. 1981. The status of the Elegant Parrot and the Rock Parrot on Kangaroo Island. South Australian Ornithologist 28: 164-165
- Bayliss, P. 1985. The population dynamics of red and western grey kangaroos in arid New South Wales, Australia, II. The numeric response function. Journal of Animal Ecology 54: 127-135
- Bayliss, P. 1985. The population dynamics of red and western grey kangaroos in arid New South Wales, Australia. I. Population trends and rainfall. Journal of Animal Ecology 54: 111-125
- Bayliss, P. 1986. Factors affecting aerial surveys of marine fauna, and their relationship to a census of dugongs in the coastal waters of the Northern Territory. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 27-37
- Bayliss, P. & Freeland, W.J. 1989. Seasonal distribution and abundance of dugongs in the western Gulf of Carpentaria. Australian Wildlife Research 16: 141-149
- Baynes, A. 1982. Dasyurids (Marsupialia) in late Quaternary communities in Southwestern Australia. pp. 503-510 in Archer, M. (ed.). Carnivorous Marsupials. Sydney : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales Vol. 2 i-iv, 407 pp.
- Baynes, A. 1990. The mammals of Shark Bay, Western Australia. In, Berry, P.F., Bradshaw, S.D. & Wilson, B.R. (eds). Research in Shark Bay: Report of the France-Australe Bicentenary Expedition Committee. Perth : Western Australian Museum.
- Baynes, A., Chapman, A. & Lynam, A.J. 1987. The rediscovery, after 56 years, of the Heath Rat Pseudomys shortridgei (Thomas, 1907) in Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 13: 319-322
- Beal, A.M. 1986. Responsiveness of the parotid salivary gland of red kangaroos (Macropus rufus) to mineralocorticoids. Journal of Experimental Biology 120: 309-324
- Beal, A.M. 1995. Secretion of electrolytes, protein and urea by the mandibular gland of the common wombat (Vombatus ursinus). Journal of Comparative Physiology B 164: 629-635
- Bean, T.H. 1885. Description of a new species of Plectromus (P. crassiceps) taken by the United States Fish Commission. Proceedings of the United States National Museum 8(486): 73-74
- Beard, D.J. 1979. Rough-scaled snake, Tropidechis carinatus. Herpetofauna 10: 26-28
- Beard, L.A., Grigg, G.C. & Augee, M.L. 1992. Reproduction by echidnas in a cold climate. pp. 93-100 in Augee, M.L. (ed.). Platypus and Echidnas. Mosman : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 296 pp.
- Beardsell, C. 1985. The Regent Parrot. A report on the nest site survey in south-eastern Australia, September 1983 to January 1984. Australian National Parks and Wildlife Service Report Series n. 1 28 pp.
- Beardsell, C.M. & Emison, W.B. 1985. The Little Corella in the South-East of South Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 29: 206-207
- Beasley, I., Robertson, K.M. & Arnold, P. 2005. Description of a new dolphin, the Australian Snubfin Dolphin Orcaella heinsohni sp. n. (Cetacea, Delphinidae). Marine Mammal Science 21: 365-400
- Beaufort, F. de 1966. Catalogue des types des mammifères du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle, Paris. VI Monotremata. VII Marsupialia. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 2 38(5): 509-553
- Beazley, L.D. & Dunlop, S.A. 1983. The evolution of an area centralis and visual streak in the marsupial Setonix brachyurus. Journal of Comparative Neurology 216: 211-231
- Bechstein, J.M. 1789. Gemeinnützige Naturgeschichte Deutschlands nach allen drey Reichen. Ein Handbuch zur deutlichern und vollständigern Gelbstbelehrung besonders für Forstmändigern Jugendlehrer und Ockonomen. Erster Band welcher die nöthigen Vorkenntnisse und die Geschicte der Säugthiere enthält. Leipzig : S.L. Crusius xvi 842 pp. 17 pls.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1800. Herrn de la Cépède's Naturgeschichte der Amphibien, aus dem Französischen ubersetzt und mit Anmerkungen und Zusätzen versehen von J.M. Bechstein. Weimar : Landes-Industrie-Comptoir xxxii 524 pp.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1800. Thomas Pennant's allgemeine Uebersicht der vierfüssigen Thiere.Aus dem englischen übersetzt aud mit Anmerkungen und Zusätzen versehen von J.M. Bechstein. Weimar : Industrie-Comptoir's Vol. 2 xi 323-768 pls 35-54.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1803. Ornithologisches Taschenbuch von und für Deutschland; oder, Kurze Beschreibung aller Vögel Deutschlands für Liebhaber dieses Theils der Naturgeschichte. Leipzig : Carl Friedrich Enoch Richter et al. Vol. 2 550 pp.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1805. Gemein. Nat. Deutschl. Vol. 2. Peters' Check-list of the birds of the world Vol. 9: 144. 247, 302, 465 pp.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1811. Kurze Uebersicht aller bekannten Vögel: oder ihre Kennzeichen der Art nach Lathams General Synopsis of Birds und seinem Index ornithologicus. Nürnberg : A.G. Schneider & Weigel iv 536 pp. 42 pls.
- Bechstein, J.M. 1812. In Latham's Allgemeine Uebersicht der Vögel mit zwanzig gemahiten Kupfern aus dem Englischen übersezt. Nürnberg : C. Weigel und Schneider Vol. 4.
- Becker, L. 1859. On an Australian bat. No. 1. Transactions of the Philosophical Institute of Victoria 3: 38-40, pl.1
- Becker, L. 1860. Notes on an Australian bat, No. II. Transactions of the Philosophical Institute of Victoria 4: 41-43 1 pl.
- Becker, L. in Anon. 1858. A small Australian bat. The Argus [Melbourne], No. 3785, July 29th, 1858 p. 5 col. 5.
- Becker, V.E. 1963. New data on the luminous anchovy genera Electrona and Protomyctophum (Pisces, Myctophidae) of the southern hemisphere. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 3 1(26): 15-28 figs 1-5 [in Russian]
- Becker, V.E. 1964. Slendertailed myctophids (genera Loweina, Tarletonbeania, Gonichthys and Centrobranchus) of the Pacific and Indian Oceans, systematics and distribution. Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 73: 11-75 figs 1-25 [in Russian]
- Becker, V.E. 1965. Lanternfishes of the genus Hygophum (Myctophidae, Pisces), systematics and distribution. Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 73: 11-75 figs 1-11 [in Russian; Bur. Comm. Fish. Ichthyol. Lab. Transl. 45]
- Becker, V.E. 1967. The lanternfishes (Myctophidae) from the Petr Lebedev Atlantic Expeditions 1961–1964. Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 84: 84-124 figs 1-13 [in Russian]
- Becker, V.E. 1978. New species of the genus Bolinichthys (Myctophidae, Osteichthyes) from the South Pacific Ocean. Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 111: 259-264 figs 1-2 [in Russian]
- Becker, V.E. 1983. Myctophid Fishes of the World Ocean. Moscow : Science Publishers 248 pp. 102 figs. [in Russian]
- Becker, V.E. 1992. Benthopelagic fishes of the genera Idiolychnus and Diaphus (Myctophidae) from the eastern South Pacific Ocean, with the description of two new species. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 32(6): 3-10 [in Russian, English transl. in J. Ichthyol. 1993, v. 33 (no. 3):20-29]
- Becker, V.E. & Shcherbachev, Y.N. 1990. Benthopelagic species of the families Neoscopelidae and Myctophidae from the Indian Ocean, with a description of a new species of Diaphus. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 30(5): 835-855 [in Russian, English transl. in J. Ichthyol. v. 30 (7):122-134]
- Becking, J.H. 1975. New evidence for the specific affinity of Cuculus lepidus Müller. Ibis 117: 275-284
- Becking, J.H. 1981. Notes on the breeding of Indian cuckoos. Journal of the Bombay Natural History Society 78: 201-231
- Beddard, F.E. 1886. On the syrinx and other points in the anatomy of the Caprimulgidae. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1886: 147-153
- Beddard, F.E. 1888. On the classification of the Striges. Ibis 30: 335-344
- Beddard, F.E. 1890. On Photodilus badius, with remarks on its systematic position. Ibis 32: 293-304
- Beddard, F.E. 1896. Contributions to the anatomy of picarian birds-Part III. On some points on the anatomy of the kingfishers. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1896: 603-606
- Beddard, F.E. 1898. The Structure and Classification of Birds. London : Longmans, Green xx 548 pp.
- Beddard, F.E. 1905. A contribution to the anatomy of the frilled lizard (Chlamydosaurus kingi and some other agamids. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1905: 9-22
- Beddard, F.E. & Parsons, F.G. 1893. On certain points in the anatomy of parrots bearing on their classification. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 507-514
- Beebe, W. 1932. Nineteen new species and four post-larval deepsea fish. Zoologica (New York) 13: 47-107 figs 1-31
- Beebe, W. 1933. Deep-sea isospondylous fishes. Two new genera and four new species. Zoologica (New York) 13(8): 159-167 figs 39-42
- Beebe, W. 1933. Deep-sea stomiatoid fishes, one new genus and eight new species. Copeia 1933(4): 160-165 figs 1-8
- Beebe, W. & Crane, J. 1936. Deep-sea fishes of the Bermuda Oceanographic expeditions. No 3. Family Serrivomeridae. Part I. Genus Serrivomer. Zoologica (New York) 20(3): 53-102 figs 23-42
- Beecher, W.J. 1953. A phylogeny of theoscines. Auk 70: 67-73
- Beehler, B.M. & Finch, B.W. 1985. Species-Checklist of the Birds of New Guinea. Australasian Ornithological Monographs No. 1. Melbourne : Royal Australasian Ornithologists Union iii 126 pp.
- Beehler, B.M., Pratt, T.K. & Zimmerman, D.A. 1986. Birds of New Guinea. Handbook no. 9 of the Wau Ecology Institute. Princeton : Princeton University Press xiii 293 pp. 55 pls.
- Beentjes, M.P. 1990. Comparative terrestrial locomotion of the Hooker's sea lion (Phocarctos hookeri) and the New Zealand fur seal (Arctocephalus forsteri): evolutionary and ecological implications. Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 98: 307-325
- Beetham, P., Kiely, J., MacKenzie, J., Vaartjes, S. & Pennell, A.L. 1987. Diet analysis of the western grey kangaroo (Macropus fuliginosus) in Wyperfeld National Park by microscopic faecal analysis. Victorian Naturalist 104: 32-38
- Beeton, R.J. 1985. The Little Corella: a seasonally adapted species. Proceedings of the Ecological Society of Australia 13: 53-63 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]
- Begg, M., Beveridge, I., Chilton, N.B., Johnson, P.M. & Callaghan, M.G. 1995. Parasites of the Proserpine rock-wallaby, Petrogale persephone (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). Australian Mammalogy 18: 45-54
- Begg, R., Walsh, B., Woerle, F. & King, S. 1983. Ecology of Melomys burtoni, the grassland melomys (Rodentia: Muridae) at Cobourg Peninsula, N.T. Australian Wildlife Research 10: 259-267
- Begg, R.J. 1981. The small mammals of Little Nourlangie Rock, N.T. II. Ecology of Antechinus bilarni, the Sandstone Antechinus (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Australian Wildlife Research 8: 57-72
- Begg, R.J. 1981. The small mammals of Little Nourlangie Rock, N.T. III. Ecology of Dasyurus hallucatus, the Northern Quoll (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Australian Wildlife Research 8: 73-85
- Begg, R.J. 1981. The small mammals of Little Nourlangie Rock, N.T. IV. Ecology of Zyzomys woodwardi, the Large Rock-rat, and Z. argurus, the Common Rock-rat, (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Wildlife Research 8: 307-320
- Begg, R.J. & Dunlop, C.H. 1985. The diets of the large rock-rat, Zyzomys woodwardi, and the common rock-rat, Z. argurus (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Wildlife Research 12: 19-24
- Begg, R.J. & Dunlop, C.R. 1980. Security eating, and diet in the Large Rock-rat, Zyzomys woodwardi (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Wildlife Research 7: 63-70
- Begg, R.J. & McKean, J.L. 1982. Cave dwelling in the molossid bat Tadarida jobensis colonicus. Northern Territory Naturalist 5: 12
- Begle, D.P. 1991. Relationships of the osmeroid fishes and the use of reductive characters in phylogenetic analysis. Systematic Zoology 40(1): 33-53
- Begle, D.P. 1992. Monophyly and relationships of argentinoid fishes. Copeia 1992(2): 350-366
- Belcher, C.A. 1995. Diet of the tiger quoll (Dasyurus maculatus) in East Gippsland, Victoria. Wildlife Research 22: 341-357
- Belcher, C.A. 1998. Susceptibility of the tiger quoll, Dasyurus maculatus, and the eastern quoll, D. viverrinus, to 1080-poisoned baits in control programmes for vertebrate pests in eastern Australia. Wildlife Research 25: 33-40
- Belcher, C.A. & Darrant, J.P. 2004. Home range and spatial organisation of the marsupial carnivore, Dasyurus maculatus maculatus (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae) in south-eastern Australia. Journal of Zoology, London 262: 271-280
- Bell, C.H., Kemper, C.M. & Conran, J.G. 2002. Common dolphins Delphins delphis in southern Australia: a morphometric study. Australian Mammalogy 24: 1-10
- Bell, C.J., Baudinette, R.V. & Nicol, S.C. 1983. Cutaneous water loss at rest and exercise in two species of marsupials. Australian Journal of Zoology 31: 93-99
- Bell, C.M., Burton, H.R. & Hindell, M.A. 1997. Growth of southern elephant seals, Mirounga leonina, during their first foraging trip. Australian Journal of Zoology 45: 447-458
- Bell, C.M., Hindell, M.A.& Burton, H.R. 1997. Estimation of body mass in the southern elephant seal, Mirounga leonina, by photogrammetry and morphometrics. Marine Mammal Science 13: 669-682
- Bell, D.T., Moredoundt, J.C. & Loneragan, W.A. 1987. Grazing pressure by the tammar (Macropus eugenii Desm.) on the vegetation of Garden Island, Western Australia, and the potential impact on food reserves of a controlled burning regime. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 69: 89-94
- Bell, H.L. 1960. Nesting notes of the Mangrove Kingfisher. The Emu 60: 64-65
- Bell, H.L. 1962. The Green-winged Pigeon in Victoria. The Emu 61: 328-330 [Mathews, G.M. 1942. Additions to the list of Australian birds and other notes. Australian Zoologist 10(suppl.): 161–166]
- Bell, H.L. 1966. Some feeding habits of the Rainbow Lorikeet. The Emu 66: 71-22 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]
- Bell, H.L. 1981. Information on New Guinean Kingfishers, Alcedinidae. Ibis 123: 51-61
- Bell, H.L. 1984. Carrying of young in flight by Coucals Centropus spp. Australian Bird Watcher 10: 171 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]
- Bell, H.M. 1973. The ecology of three macropod marsupial species in an open forest and savannah woodland in north Queensland, Australia. Mammalia 37: 527-544
- Bell, J., Steffe, A.S. & Talbot, R.B. 1987. The oriental goby, Acanthogobius flavimanus, colonizes a third estuary in New South Wales, Australia. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 34(2): 227-230
- Bell, M.J. & Bell, T.J. 1997. Use of Lophostemon confertus as a sap-feed tree by yellow-bellied gliders, Petaurus australis, on the mid north coast of New South Wales. Australian Mammalogy 1997: 103-106
- Bell, T. 1828. Description of a new species of Phalangista. Transactions of the Linnean Society of London 16: 121-127
- Bell, T. 1828. On Hydraspis, a new genus of freshwater tortoises, of the family Emydidae. Zoological Journal London 3: 511-513
- Bell, T. 1833. Characters of two new genera of reptiles. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1: 98-99
- Bellotti, C. 1903. Di un nuovo pteraclide Giapponese. Atti della Società Italiana di Scienze Naturali e del Museo Civico di Storia Naturale di Milano 42: 136-139
- Bellwood, D.R. 1994. A phylogenetic study of the parrotfishes family Scaridae (Pisces: Labroidei), with a revision of genera. Records of the Australian Museum, Supplement 20: 1-86 [Date published 14/Jul/1994]
- Bellwood, D.R. 2001. Scaridae. pp. 3468-3492 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Bellwood, D.R. & Choat, J.H. 1989. A description of the juvenile phase colour patterns of 14 parrotfish species (family Scaridae) from the Great Barrier Reef, Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 41(1): 1-41
- Belyanina, T.N. 1974. Materials on development, taxonomy and distribution of the fishes of the family Bregmacerotidae. Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 96: 143-188 figs 1-12 [in Russian]
- Ben-Tuvia, A. 1986. Taxonomic status of Upeneichthys lineatus (Bloch) in Australian and New Zealand waters. pp. 590-594 figs 1-2 in Uyeno, T., Arai, R., Taniuchi, T. & Matsuura, K. (eds). Indo-Pacific Fish Biology. Proceedings of the Second International Conference on Indo-Pacific Fishes. Tokyo : Ichthyological Society of Japan 985 pp.
- Ben-Tuvia, A. 1993. A review of the Indo-west Pacific congrid fishes of genera Rhynchoconger and Bathycongrus with the description of three new species. Israel Journal of Zoology 39(4): 349-370
- Ben-Tuvia, A. & Kissil, G.W. 1988. Fishes of the family Mullidae in the Red Sea, with a key to the species in the Red sea and the eastern Mediterranean. Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 52: 1-16 figs 1-14
- Bengston, J.L. & Steart, B.S. 1997. Diving patterns of a Ross seal (Ommatophoca rossii) near the eastern coast of the Antarctic peninsula. Polar Biology 18: 214-218
- Benham, W.B. 1904. An apparently new species of Regalecus (R. parkeri). Transactions of the New Zealand Institute 26(23): 198-200
- Bennett, A.F. 1973. Blood physiology and oxygen transport during activity in two lizards, Varanus gouldii and Sauromalus hispidus. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 46A: 673-690
- Bennett, A.F. 1993. Microhabitat use by the long-nosed potoroo, Potorous tridactylus and other small mammals in remnant forest vegetation of south-western Victoria. Wildlife Research 20: 267-285
- Bennett, A.F. & Baxter, B.J. 1989. Diet of the long-nosed potoroo, Potorous tridactylus (Marsupialia: Potoroidae), in south-western Victoria. Australian Wildlife Research 16: 263-271
- Bennett, D.K. 1980. Stripes do not a zebra make, Part 1: a cladistic analysis of Equus. Systematic Zoology 29: 272-287
- Bennett, E.T. 1830. Catalogue of the fishes of Sumatra. pp. 686–694 in Lady Raffles (ed.) Memoir of the Life and Public Services of Sir Stanford Raffles. London. 701 pp. [not seen]
- Bennett, E.T. 1830. Catalogue of the fishes of Sumatra. pp. 686–694 in Lady Raffles (ed.) Memoir of the Life and Public Services of Sir Stanford Raffles. London 701 pp. [not seen]
- Bennett, E.T. 1831. Characters of new genera and species of fishes of the Atlantic coast of northern Africa presented by Capt. Belcher. Proceedings of the Committee of Science and Correspondence of the Zoological Society of London 1: 145-148
- Bennett, E.T. 1831. Observations on a collection of fishes from the Mauritius, with characters of new genera and species. Proceedings of the Committee of Science and Correspondence of the Zoological Society of London 1: 59-61, 126-128
- Bennett, E.T. 1832. Characters of two new species of fishes, from the Mauritius, presented by Mr Telfair. Proceedings of the Committee of Science and Correspondence of the Zoological Society of London 2: 184
- Bennett, E.T. 1832. Observations on a collection of fishes from Mauritius, presented by Mr Telfair, with characters of new genera and species, remaining portion. Proceedings of the Committee of Science and Correspondence of the Zoological Society of London 1: 165-169 [dated 1830–1831]
- Bennett, E.T. 1833. Characters of new species from the Mauritius. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1833(1): 32
- Bennett, E.T. 1835. On a new species of kangaroo. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1834: 151-152
- Bennett, F.D. 1840. Narrative of a Whaling Voyage Around the Globe from the Year 1833–1836. Comprising sketches of Polynesia, California, the Indian Archipelago, etc., with an account of southern whales, the sperm whale fishery, and the natural history of the climates visited. London : Bentley Vol. 2 395 pp. 2 pls.
- Bennett, G. 1837. A Catalogue of the Specimens of Natural History and Miscellaneous Curiosities, Deposited in the Australian Museum. Sydney : Australian Museum 71 pp.
- Bennett, J.H., Breed, W.G. Hayman, D.L. & Hope, R.M. 1990. Reproductive and genetical studies with a laboratory colony of the dasyurid marsupial Sminthopsis crassicaudata. Australian Journal of Zoology 37: 207-222
- Bennett, J.H., Smith, M.J., Hope, R.M. & Chesson, C.M. 1982. Fat-tailed dunnart Sminthopsis crassicaudata: establishment and maintenance of a laboratory colony. pp. 38-44 in Evans, D.D. (ed.). The Management of Australian Mammals in Captivity. Proceedings of the Scientific Meeting of the Australian Mammal Society, Healesville, Victoria, February 1979. Melbourne : Zoological Board of Victoria 194 pp.
- Bennett, J.W. 1828. A Selection of Rare and Curious Fishes found upon the Coast of Ceylon. London 6 Pts pls 1–10 with facing unnumbered pages.
- Bennett, J.W. 1829. A Selection of Rare and Curious Fishes found upon the Coast of Ceylon. London 6 Pts pls 11–15 with facing unnumbered pages.
- Bennett, J.W. 1830. A Selection of Rare and Curious Fishes found upon the Coast of Ceylon. London 6 Pts pls 16–30 with facing unnumbered pages. [not seen]
- Benshemesh, J. 2004. Recovery Plan for Marsupial moles Notoryctes typhlops and N. caurinus. 2003-2010. Alice Springs : Northern Territory Department of Infrastructure, Planning and Environment. pp.
- Benshemesh, J. & Johnson, K. 2003. Biology and conservation of marsupial moles (Notoryctes). pp. 464-474 in Jones, M., Dickman, C. & Archer, M. (eds). Predators with Pouches. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing.
- Bentley, A. 1978. An Introduction to the Deer of Australia with Special Reference to Victoria. Melbourne : R.A. Manning for the Koetong Trust Service Fund, Forests Comm., Vic. 350 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Chital Axis axis. pp. 739-741 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Fallow Deer Dama dama. pp. 732-733 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Hog Deer Axis porcinus. pp. 741-742 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Red Deer Cervus elaphus. pp. 734-735 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Rusa Deer Cervus timorensis. pp. 736-737 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1995. Sambar Cervus unicolor. pp. 738-739 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bentley, A. 1998. An Introduction to the Deer of Australia. Melbourne : Australian Deer Research Foundation.
- Bentley, P.J. 1959. Studies on the water and electrolyte metabolism of the lizard Trachysaurus rugosus (Gray). Journal of Physiology 145: 37-47
- Bentley, P.J. & Blumer, W.F.C. 1962. Uptake of water by the lizard, Moloch horridus. Nature (London) 194: 699-700
- Bentley, P.J. & Bradshaw, S.D. 1972. Electrical potential difference across the cloaca and colon of the Australian lizards Amphibolurus ornatus and A. inermis. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 42A: 465-471
- Beresford, Q. & Bailey, G. 1981. Search for the Tasmanian Tiger. Sandy Bay : Blubber Head Press vi 54 pp. 39 pls.
- Berg, C. 1898. Substitución de nombres genéricos. II. Comunicaciones del Museo Nacional de Buenos Aires 1(2): 41-43
- Berger, A.J. 1955. On the anatomy and relationships of Glossy Cuckoos of the genera Chrysococcyx, Lampromorpha, and Chalcites. Proceedings of the United States National Museum 103: 585-597
- Berger, A.J. 1960. Some anatomical characters of the Cuculidae and the Musophagidae. Wilson Bulletin 72: 60-104
- Bergin, T.J. (ed.) 1978. The Koala. Proceedings of the Taronga Symposium on Koala biology, management and medicine, Sydney 11th and 12th March 1976. Sydney : Zoological Parks Board of N.S.W. x 239 pp.
- Bergmans, W. 1978. On Dobsonia Palmer, 1898 from the Lesser Sunda Islands (Mammalia: Megachiroptera). Senckenbergiana Biologica 59: 1-18
- Berkenhout, J. 1769. Outlines of the Natural History of Great Britain and Ireland. Containing a systematic arrangement and concise description of all the animals, vegetables, and fossils which have hitherto been discovered in these kingdoms. Comprehending the Animal Kingdom. London : P. Elmsly 1 xiii 233 pp.
- Berlepsch, H. 1911. Die vögel der Aru-Inseln, mit besonderer berücksichtigung der sammlungen des Herrn Dr H. Merton. Abhandlungen der Senckenbergischen Naturforschenden Gesellschaft 34: 53-98
- Berlioz, J. 1927. [Title unknown]. Bulletin du Muséum d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 33: 350
- Berman, D. 1995. Brumby Equus caballus. pp. 710-711 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bernard, H.J. & Reilly, S.B. 1999. Pilot whales. pp. 245-279 in Ridgway, S.H. & Harrison, R.J. (eds). Handbook of Marine Mammals. Volume 6. The second book of dolphins and the porpoises. London : Academic Press.
- Bernard, R.T.F. 1980. Reproductive cycles of Miniopterus schreibersi natalensis (Kuhl, 1819) and Miniopterus fraterculus Thomas and Schwann, 1906. Annals of the Transvaal Museum 32: 55-64
- Bernardi, G., Bucciarelli, G., Costagliola, D., Robertson, D.R. & Heiser, J.B. 2004. Evolution of coral reef fish Thalassoma spp. (Labridae). 1. Molecular phylogeny and biogeography. Marine Biology, Berlin 144: 369-375, 405
- Berney, F.L. 1936. Gould's monitor (Varanus gouldiae). Queensland Naturalist 10: 12-14
- Berra, T. & Hutchins, J.B. 1990. A specimen of megamouth shark, Megachasma pelagios (Megachasmidae) from Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 14(4): 651-656 fig. 1
- Berra, T.M. 1982. Life history of the Australian grayling, Prototroctes maraena (Salmoniformes, Prototroctidae) in the Tambo River, Victoria. Copeia 1982(4): 795-805 figs 1-4
- Berra, T.M. 2001. Freshwater Fish Distribution. San Diego : Academic Press 604 pp.
- Berra, T.M. 2003. Nurseryfish, Kurtus gulliveri (Perciformes: Kurtidae), from northern Australia: redescription, distribution, egg mass, and comparison with K. indicus from southeast Asia. Ichthyological Explorations of Freshwater 14(4): 295-306
- Berra, T.M. 2007. Freshwater Fish Distribution. Chicago : University of Chicago 605 pp.
- Berra, T.M. & Allen, G.R. 1989. Burrowing, emergence, behaviour, and functional morphology of the Australian salamanderfish, Lepidogalaxias salamandroides. Fisheries (Bethesda) 14(5): 2-10
- Berra, T.M. & Humphrey, J.D. 2002. Gross anatomy and histology of the hook and skin of male nurseryfish, Kurtus gulliveri, from northern Australia. Environmental Biology of Fishes 65: 263-270
- Berra, T.M. & Neira, F.J. 2003. Early life history of the nurseryfish, Kurtus gulliveri, from northern Australia. Copeia 2003(2): 384-390
- Berra, T.M. & Weatherley, A.H. 1972. A systematic study of the Australian freshwater serranid fish genus Maccullochella. Copeia 1972(1): 53-64 figs 1-7
- Berra, T.M. & Wedd, D. 2001. Alimentary canal anatomy and diet of the nurseryfish, Kurtus gulliveri (Perciformes: Kurtidae) from the Northern Territory of Australia. The Beagle, Records of the Museums and Art Galleries of the Northern Territory 17: 21-25
- Berry, F.H. 1959. Boarfishes of the genus Antigonia of the western Atlantic. Bulletin of the Florida State Museum 4(7): 205-250 figs 1-11
- Berry, F.H. 1968. A new species of carangid fish (Decapterus tabl) from the western Atlantic. Contributions in Marine Science 13: 145-167 figs 1-4
- Berry, F.H. & Baldwin, W.J. 1966. Triggerfishes (Balistidae) of the eastern Pacific. Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 34(9): 429-474 figs 1-19
- Berry, F.H. & Cohen, L. 1974. Synopsis of the genus Trachurus (Pisces, Carangidae). Quarterly Journal of the Florida Academy of Science 35(4): 177-211 figs 1-4 [1972]
- Berry, P.F., Bradshaw, S.D. & Wilson, B.R. (eds) 1990. Research in Shark Bay: Report of the France-Australe Bicentenary Expedition Committee. Perth : Western Australian Museum.
- Berry, R.J. (ed.) 1981. Biology of the House Mouse. Symposium of the Zoological Society, London. No. 47. London : Academic Press xxx 715 pp.
- Bertelsen, E. 1951. The ceratioid fishes ontogeny, taxonomy, distribution and biology. Dana Reports 39: 1-276 figs 1-141 1 pl.
- Bertelsen, E. 1980. Notes on Linophrynidae V. A revision of the deepsea anglerfishes of the Linophryne arborifera-group (Pisces, Ceratioidei). Steenstrupia 6(6): 29-70 figs 1-18
- Bertelsen, E. 1982. Notes on Linophrynidae VIII. A review of the genus Linophryne, with new records and descriptions of two new species. Steenstrupia 8(3): 49-104 figs 1-18
- Bertelsen, E. 1984. Ceratioidei: development and relationships. 325-334 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Bertelsen, E. & Krefft, G. 1988. The ceratioid family Himantolophidae (Pisces, Lophiiformes). Steenstrupia 14(2): 9-89
- Bertelsen, E. & Marshall, N.B. 1956. The Miripinnati, a new order of teleost fishes. Dana Reports 42: 1-34 figs 1-15 pl. 1
- Bertelsen, E. & Marshall, N.B. 1984. Mirapinnatoidei: development and relationships. 380-383 figs 202-203 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Bertelsen, E. & Pietsch, T.W. 1983. The ceratioid anglerfishes of Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 35(2): 77-99 figs 1-18
- Bertelsen, E., Krefft, G. & Marshall, N.B. 1976. The fishes of the family Notosudidae. Dana Reports 86: 1-115 figs 1-67 pl. 1
- Bertelsen, E., Nielsen, J.G. & Smith, D.G. 1989. Suborder Saccopharyngoidei. 636-655 in Böhlke, E.B. (ed.). Orders Anguilliformes and Saccopharyngiformes. Fishes of the Western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1: 1-655
- Bertelsen, E., Pietsch, T.W. & Lavenberg, R.J. 1981. Ceratioid anglerfishes of the family Gigantactinidae: morphology, systematics and distribution. Los Angeles County Museum of Natural History Contributions in Science 332: 1-74 figs 1-69
- Berthold, A.A. 1826. Latreille's Natürliche Familien des Thierreich Aus dem Französisechen mit Anmerkungen und Zusätzen. Weimar : Landes-Industrie-Comptoirs x 606 pp. [publication dated as 1827]
- Berthold, A.A. 1827. Anmerkungen und Zusatzen. In Latreille, P.A. Natürliche Familien des Thierreichs. Weimar : Landes-Industrie-Comptoirs. 604 pp.
- Berthold, A.A. 1827. Latreille's Natürliche Familien des Thierreichs. Aus dem Franzosischen, mit Anmerkungen und Zusützen. Weimar : Verlage Landes-Industrie-Comptoirs Vol. x xiii, 606 pp.
- Bertin, L. 1934. Une nouvelle espèce de poissons abyssaux: Saccopharynx Schmidti. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 198: 1633-1634
- Bertin, L. 1940. Remaniement dans la classification des Poissons Apodes appartenant à la famille des Serrivoméridés. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 211: 76-78
- Bertin, L. 1941. Mise au point sur quelques espèces de clupéidés. Bulletin de la Société Zoologique de France 66: 18-25
- Beruldsen, G.R. 1978. The eggs of the Brush Cuckoo—Cacomantis variolosus. Australian Bird Watcher 7: 281-282
- Beruldsen, G.R. 1986. Observations on the Sooty Owl Tyto tenebricosa in south-east Queensland. Australian Bird Watcher 11: 230-236
- Best, P.B. 1977. Two allopatric forms of Bryde’s whale off South Africa. Reports of the International Whaling Commission Special Issue 1: 10-38
- Best, P.B. 1982. Seasonal abundance, feeding, reproduction, age and growth in minke whales off Durban (with incidental observations from the Antarctic). Report of the International Whaling Commission 32: 759-786
- Beumer, J.P., Pearson, R.G. & Penridge, L.K. 1981. Pacific short-finned eel Anguilla obscura Günther, 1871 in Australia: recent records of its distribution and maximum size. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Queensland 92: 85-90 figs 1-2
- Bezzobs, T. & Sanson, G. 1997. The effects of plant and tooth structure on intake and digestibility in two small mammalian herbivores. Physiological Zoology 70: 338-351
- Bianchi, V.L. 1907. Catalogue of the known species of Alaudidae, or family of larks, with a table showing the geographical distribution and a key to the genera. Bulletin of the Imperial Academy of Sciences of St Petersburg 5 25(1-2): 1-81
- Bianconi, G.G. 1846. Lettera sul Ostracion fornasini, n. sp. de pesce del Mosambico. Nuovi Annali delle Scienze Naturali. Bologna 2 5: 113-115 figs [not seen]
- Bianconi, G.G. 1855. Specimina zoologica Mosambicana quibus vel novae vel minus natae animalium species illustrantur. Fasc. 10 pp. 215–230 pls Pisc. 1–3 Bononiae. [not seen]
- Bibron, G. in Müller, J. & Henle, F.G.J. 1839. Systematische Beschreibung der Plagiostomen. Berlin : Veit & Co. pp. 29-102 pls.
- Bibron, G. in Duméril, A.H.A. 1855. Note sur un travail inédit de Bibron relatif aux poissons Plectognathes Gymnodontes (Diodons et Tétrodons). Revue et Magasin de Zoologie (Paris) 2 8: 274-282
- Bick, J.A.E. 1992. The meiotic chain of chromosomes of Monotremata. pp. 64-68 in Augee, M.L. (ed.). Platypus and Echidnas. Mosman : Royal Zoological Society of New South Wales 296 pp.
- Bigelow, H.B. 1961. A new species of the cetomimid genus Gyrinomimus from the Gulf of Mexico. Breviora 145: 1-2 fig. 1
- Bigelow, H.B. & Schroeder, W.C. 1948. Sharks. In, Parr, A.E. (ed.) Fishes of the western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1(1): 59-546 figs 6-106
- Bigelow, H.B. & Schroeder, W.C. 1953. Chimaeroids. pp. 515-588, figs 118-127 in Parr, A.E. (ed.). Fishes of the western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1(2): 1-599
- Bigelow, H.B. & Schroeder, W.C. 1953. Sawfishes, guitarfishes, skates and rays. pp. 1-514, figs 1-117 in Parr, A.E. (ed.). Fishes of the western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1(2): 1-599
- Bigelow, H.B. & Schroeder, W.C. 1962. New and little known batoid fishes from the western Atlantic. Bulletin of the Museum of Comparative Zoology, Harvard 128(4): 159-244 figs 1-23 pl. 1
- Biggins, J.G. 1984. Communication in possums: a review. pp. 35-57 in Smith, A. & Hume, I. (eds). Possums and Gliders. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons, Australian Mammal Society 598 pp.
- Billberg, G.J. 1828. Synopsis Faunae Scandinaviae. Tom. I, Pars 2. Aves. Holmiae 208 pp. [For publication date Richmond, C.W. 1900. Some necessary changes in nomenclature. Auk ns 17: 178–179 Lysaght, A. 1957. The first specimens of Dacelo novaeguineae and D. leachii in European collections. Emu 57: 209–210 Mathews, G.M. 1926. An important date. Emu 26: 148]
- Bird, C.L. 1980. Fork-tailed Swifts in Tasmania. Tasmanian Bird Report 10: 22-24
- Birds Australia 1999. Handbook of Australian New Zealand and Antartic Birds. Oxford university Press Vol. 4.
- Birdsong, R., Murdy, E.O. & Pezold, F.L. 1988. A study of the vertebral column and median fin osteology in gobioid fishes with comments on gobioid relationships. Bulletin of Marine Science 42(2): 174-214 figs 1-5
- Birt, P. 2005. Mutualistic interactions between the nectar-feeding little red flying fox Pteropus scapulatus, and flowering eucalypts: habitat utilisation and pollination. Ph.D. thesis, Brisbane : University of Queensland. pp.
- Birt, P., Hall, L.S. & Smith, G.C. 1997. Ecomorphology of the tongues of Australian Megachiroptera (Chiroptera: Pteropidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 45: 369-384
- Birt, T.P., Friesen, V.L., Green, J.M., Montevechi, W.A. & Davidson, W.S. 1992. Cytochrome b sequence variation among parrots. Hereditas (Lund) 117: 67-72
- Birtles, A., Arnold, P. & Dunstan, A. 2002. Commercial swim programs with dwarf minke whales on the northern Great Barrier Reef, Australia: some characteristics of the encounters with management implications. Australian Mammalogy 24: 23-38
- Bishop, N., Bulbert, M., Carr, S., Kroker, S.& Millikan, J. 1995. Sonographic analysis of vocalisations in captive dunnarts, Sminthopsis crassicaudata. Australian Mammalogy 18: 99-100
- Bissinger, B.E. & Simon, C.A. 1979. Comparison of tongue extrusions in representatives of six families of lizards. Journal of Herpetology 13: 133-139
- Biswas, B. 1951. On some larger spine-tailed swifts, with the description of a new subspecies from Nepal. Ardea 39: 318-321
- Bjorndal, K.A. 1979. Cellulose digestion and volatile fatty acid production in the green turtle, Chelonia mydas. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 63A: 127-133
- Bjorndal, K.A. 1979. Urine concentrations of ammonia, urea and uric acid in the green turtle, Chelonia mydas. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 63A: 509-510
- Bjorndal, K.A. 1980. Nutrition and grazing behavior of the green turtle, Chelonia mydas. Marine Biology, Berlin 56: 147-154
- Blaber, S.J.M., Brewer, D.T. & Harris, A.N. 1994. Distribution, biomass and community structure of demersal fishes of the Gulf of Carpentaria, Australia. Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 45: 375-396 figs 1-7
- Blaber, S.J.M., Salini, J.P. & Brewer, D.T. 1990. A checklist of the fishes of Albatross Bay and the Embley estuary, north-eastern Gulf of Carpentaria. CSIRO Marine Laboratory. Report 210: 1-22
- Blache, J. & Bauchot, M.-L. 1976. Contribution à la connaissance des poissons Anguilliformes de la côte occidentale d'Afrique. 16e note: les familles des Congridae et Colocongridae. Bulletin de l'Institut Français d'Afrique Noire A 38: 369-444 figs 1-30
- Blache, J., Bauchot, M.-L. & Saldanha, L. 1973. Anguillidae. pp. 220-222 in Hureau, J.-C. & Monod, T. (eds). Checklist of the Fishes of the North-Eastern Atlantic and of the Mediterranean (CLOFNAM). Paris : UNESCO Vol. 1 683 pp.
- Black, A.B., Joseph, L., Pedler, L.P. & Carpenter, G.A. 2010. A taxonomic framework for interpreting evolution within the Amytornis textilis-modestus complex of grasswrens. The Emu 110: 358-363
- Blackall, S. 1980. Diet of the Eastern Native-Cat, Dasyurus viverrinus (Shaw), in southern Tasmania. Australian Wildlife Research 7: 191-197
- Blackburn, A. 1970. Unusual records of Spine-tailed and Fork-tailed Swifts. The Emu 70: 90
- Blacket, M.J., Adams, M., Krajewski, C. & Westerman, M. 2000. Genetic variation within the dasyurid marsupial genus Planigale. Australian Journal of Zoology 48: 443-459
- Blackman, J.G. & Locke, D.K. 1978. Nocturnal flying height of a Dollarbird. The Emu 78: 163
- Blackmore, E.H. 1969. On the Australasian Chelidae (Chelodina). Victorian Naturalist 86: 280-283
- Blackwell, J.M. 1978. Intra-specific divergence in the Western Australian frog species Ranidella insignifera. 1. The evidence from gene frequencies and genetic distance. Heredity 40: 339-348
- Blackwell, J.M. & Bull, C.M. 1978. A narrow hybrid zone between two Western Australian frog species Ranidella insignifera and R. pseudinsignifera: the extent of introgression. Heredity 40: 13-25
- Bladon, R.V., Dickman, C.R. & Hume, I.D. 2002. Effects of habitat fragmentation on the demography, movements and social organisation of the eastern pygmy possum (Cercartetus nanus) in northern New South Wales. Wildlife Research 29: 105-116
- Blainville, H.D. de 1816. Prodrome d'une nouvelle distribution systématique du Règne Animal. Bulletin des Sciences pars la Société Philomathique de Paris 1816: 105-124
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1810. Note sur plusieurs espèces de Squales, confondues sous le nom de Squalus maximus de Linnée. Journal de Physique, de Chimie et d'Histoire Naturelle 71: 248-259 pl. 2
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1816. Prodrome d'une nouvelle distribution systématique du règne animal. Bulletin des Sciences pars la Société Philomathique de Paris 1816: 113-124 [July 1816]
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1816. Prodrome d'une nouvelle distribution systématique du règne animal. Bulletin des Sciences pars la Société Philomathique de Paris 8: 105(=113)-124
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1816. Sur plusieurs espèces d'animaux mammifères de l'ordre des ruminants. Bulletin des Sciences pars la Société Philomathique de Paris 1816: 73-82
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1817. in, Nouveau Dictionnaire d'Histoire Naturelle Appliquée aux Arts à l'Agriculture, à l'Economie rurale et domestique, à la Médecine, etc. par une Société de Naturalistes et d'Agriculteurs. Nouvelle édition presqu'entièrement refondue et considerablement augmentée; avec des figures tirées des trois regnes de la nature. Tome IX.
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1820. Sur quelques crânes de phoques. Journal de Physique, de Chimie et d'Histoire Naturelle et des Arts 91: 286-300
- Blainville, H.M.D. de 1838. Sur les Cachalots. Annales Françaises et Étrangères d'Anatomie et de Physiologie. Paris 2: 335-337
- Blair-West, J.R., Gibson, A., McKinley, M.J. & Nelson, J.F. 1983. Water drinking and the effect of angiotensin and renin in a dasyurid marsupial (Antechinus stuartii). General and Comparative Endocrinology 52: 388-394
- Blake, A.J.D. 1973. Taxonomy and relationships of myobatrachine frogs (Leptodactylidae): a numerical approach. Australian Journal of Zoology 21: 119-149
- Blakers, M., Davies, S.J.J.F. & Reilly, P.N. 1984. The Atlas of Australian Birds. Melbourne : Melbourne University Press/Royal Australasian Ornithologists Union xlvi 738 pp.
- Blandford, W.T. 1893. On the scientific name of a Himalayan Cuckoo. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 315-319
- Blanford, W.T. 1891. The Fauna of British India, including Ceylon and Burma. Mammalia. Part 2. London : Taylor & Francis pp. i-vi 251-617.
- Blasius, J.H. 1858. Briefliche Mitteillungen über Helgoland. Naumannia 8: 303-316
- Blasius, J.H. 1862. A List of the Birds of Europe, Reprinted from the German with the Author's Corrections. Norwich : Matchett & Stevenson 24 pp.
- Blaylock, B.J. & Horton, P. 2006. Authorship and typification of Strepera fusca. South Australian Ornithologist 34(7-8): 288-290 [Date published Mar 2006]
- Bleeker, P. 1846. Overzicht der Siluroiden welke te Batavia voorkomen. Natuur-en Geneeskundig Archief voor Neêrland's Indië 3(2): 135-184
- Bleeker, P. 1847. Pharyngognathorum Siluroideorumque species novae Javanenses. Natuur-en Geneeskundig Archief voor Neêrland's Indië 4(2): 155-169
- Bleeker, P. 1847. Labroideorum ctenoideorum bataviensium diagnoses et adumbratonis. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 21(1): 1-33
- Bleeker, P. 1848. A contribution to the knowledge of the ichthyological fauna of Sumbawa. Journal of the Indian Archipelago & Eastern Asia 2(9): 632-639
- Bleeker, P. 1849. A contribution to the knowledge of the ichthyological fauna of Celebes. Journal of the Indian Archipelago & Eastern Asia 3: 65-74
- Bleeker, P. 1849. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Blennioïden en Gobioïden van der Soenda-Molukschen Archipel, met beschrijving van 42 nieuwe soorten. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 22: 1-40
- Bleeker, P. 1849. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Percoïden van den Malayo-Molukschen Archipel, met beschrijving van 22 nieuwe soorten. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 22: 1-64
- Bleeker, P. 1849. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Scleroparei van den Soenda-Molukschen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 22: 1-10
- Bleeker, P. 1849. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Madura, met beschrijving van eenige nieuwe species. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 22: 1-16
- Bleeker, P. 1849. Overzicht der te Batavia voorkomende Gladschubbige Labroïden, met beschrijving van 11 nieuwe soorten. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 22: 1-64
- Bleeker, P. 1850. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Maenoïden van den Soenda-Molukschen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 23: 1-13
- Bleeker, P. 1850. Over eenige nieuwe soorten van Scleroparei van den Indischen Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 17-27
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Cheilinoïdes, een nieuw geslacht van gladschubbige Labroïden van Batavia. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 71-72
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Riouw. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 469-497
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Banda-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 225-261
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der Percoidei, Scleroparei, Sciaenoidei, Maenoidei, Chaetodontoidei en Scomberoidei van den Soenda-Molukschen Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 163-179
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 209-224
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der icthyolgishce fauna van Borneo met beschrijving van eenige nieuwe soorten van zoetwatervisschen. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 259-275
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Over eenige nieuwe geslachten en soorten van Makreelachtige visschen van den Indischen Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 341-372
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Over eenige nieuwe soorten van Belone en Hemiramphus van Java. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 93-95
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Over eenige nieuwe soorten van Blennioïden en Gobioïden van den Indischen Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 236-258
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Over eenige nieuwe soorten van Pleuronectoïden van der Indischen Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 1: 401-416
- Bleeker, P. 1851. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Borneo, met beschrijving van eenige nieuwe soorten van zoetwatervisschen. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 2: 415-442
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Balistini en Ostraciones van den Indischen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 24: 1-38
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Haringachtige visschen van den Soenda-Molukschen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 24: 1-52
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Makreelachtige visschen van den Soenda-Molukschen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 24: 1-93
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Plagiostomen van den Indischen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 24: 1-92
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Singapore. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 51-86
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Timor. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 159-174
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Moluksche eilanden. Visschen van Amboina en Ceram. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 229-309
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Banka. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 443-460
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 739-782
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Diagnostische beschrijvingen van nieuwe of weinig bekende vischsoorten van Sumatra. Tiental I–IV. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 569-608
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Amboina. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 545-568
- Bleeker, P. 1852. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ceram. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 3: 689-714
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Exocoetus hexazona, eene nieuwe soort van Banka. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4: 206-207
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Muraenoïden en Symbranchoïden van den Indischen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 25: 1-76
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Solor. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 5: 67-96
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Amboina. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4: 91-130
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ceram. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 5: 233-248
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Diagnostische beschrijvingen van nieuwe of weinig bekende vischsoorten van Batavia. Tiental I–VI. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4: 451-516
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Diagnostische beschrijvingen van nieuwe of weinig bekende vischsoorten van Sumatra. Tiental V–X. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4: 243-302
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Nalezingen op de ichthyologie van Japan. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 25: 1-56 pls 6-10
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Nalezingen op de ichthyologische fauna van Bengalen en Hindostan. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 25: 1-164 pls 1-6
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ternate en Halmaheira (Gilolo). Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4: 595-610
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Nieuwe tientallen diagnostische beschrijvingen van nieuwe of weinig bekende vischsoorten van Sumatra. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 5: 495-534
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Vierde Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 5: 153-174
- Bleeker, P. 1853. Vierde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Amboina. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 5: 317-352
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Bijdrage tot de kennis der Troskieuwige visschen van den Indischen Archipel. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 25: 1-30
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Halmajeira (Gilolo). Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 49-62
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Kokos-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 37-48
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Flores. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 311-338
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Banda-eilanden (1). Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 89-114
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Descriptiones specierum diagnosticae. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 239-260
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Faunae ichthyologicae japonicae species novae. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 395-426
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Ichthyologische waarnemingen gedaan op verschillende reizen in de residentie Bantam. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 309-326
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Nieuwe bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Timor. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 203-214
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Nieuwe nalezingen op de ichthyologie van Japan. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 26: 1-132 [1854–1857]
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Overzigt der ichthyologische fauna van Sumatra, met beschrijving van eenige nieuwe soorten. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 49-108
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Specierum piscium javanensium novarum vel minus cognitarum diagnoses adumbratae. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 415-448
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Species piscium batabiensium novae vel minus cognitae. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 191-202
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Amboina. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 6: 455-508
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 225-260
- Bleeker, P. 1854. Zesde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 7: 449-452
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Achtste bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 9: 281-314
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Batoe-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 305-328
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Groot-Obi. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 9: 431-438
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Batjan. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 9: 491-504
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Kokos-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 169-180
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Negende bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Borneo. Zoetwatervisschen van Pontianak en Bandjermasin. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 9: 415-430
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Over eenige visschen van Van Diemensland. Verhandelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen [Verh. Akad. Amsterdam] 2: 1-31 fig. 1
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Tweede bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Batjan. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 9: 191-202
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Vierde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Kokos-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 445-460
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ternate. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 295-304
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Zesde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Amboina. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 391-434
- Bleeker, P. 1855. Zevende bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Celebes. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 8: 435-444
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Carcharias Prionodon amblyrhynchos, eene nieuwe haaisoort, gevangen nabij het eiland Solombo. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 10: 467-468
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Achtste bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ternate. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 12: 191-210
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Beschrijvengen van nieuwe of weinig bekende vischsoorten van Menado en Makassar grootendeels verzameld op eene reis naar den Molukschen Archipel in het gevolg van den Gouverneur-Generaal Duymaer van Twist. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 1: 1-80
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Beschrijvingen van nieuwe en weinig bekende vischsoorten van Amboina, verzameld op eene reis door den Molukschen Archipel, gedaan in het gevolg van den Gouverneur-Generaal Duymaer van Twist in September en October 1855. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 1: 1-76
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Boero. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 11: 383-414
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van het eiland Boeroe. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 11: 383-414
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Verslag omtrent eenige vischsoorten gevangen aan de Zuidkust van Malang in Oost-Java. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 11: 81-92
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Banda-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 11: 93-110
- Bleeker, P. 1856. Zevende bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ternate. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 10: 357-386
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Achtste bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Ternate. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 12: 191-210
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Achtste bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Amboina. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 2: 1-102
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Nias. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 12: 211-228
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Sangi-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 13: 369-380
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Derde Bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Batoe-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 12: 229-242
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Index descriptionum specierum piscium Bleekerianarum in voluminibus I Ad XIV Diarii Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Batavae. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 14: 447-486
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Nieuwe nalezingen op de ichthyologie van Japan. Verhandelingen van het Bataviaasch Genootschap van Kunsten en Wetenschappen 26: 1-132 [date variously seen as 1854–1857]
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Opsomming der soorten van Reptiliën, tot dus verre van het eiland Java bekend geworden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4 14: 235-244
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Tweede bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Boeroe. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 13: 55-82
- Bleeker, P. 1857. Vierde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Japan. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 3: 1-46 [Date published 1858]
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van den Goram-Archipel. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 15: 197-218
- Bleeker, P. 1858. De heer Bleeker berigt omtrent de vischoorten en Reptiliën. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4 16: 45-47
- Bleeker, P. 1858. De visschen van den Indischen Archipel. Beschreven en toegelicht. Siluri. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 4: 1-370
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Der heer Bleeker doet verslag van de verzameling visschen van Amboina, der Vereeniging aangeboden door het lid den heer Schröder. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 4 16: 28-31
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Negende bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Amboina. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 3: 1-6
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Tiende bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Celebes. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 3: 1-16
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Twaalfde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Borneo. Visschen van Singawang. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 5: 1-10
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Vierde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Biliton. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 15: 219-240
- Bleeker, P. 1858. Vijfde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van de Kokos-eilanden. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 15: 457-468
- Bleeker, P. 1859. Bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Nieuw-Guinea. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 6: 1-24
- Bleeker, P. 1859. Conspectus specierum Mugilis Archipelagi indici analyticus. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 16: 275-280
- Bleeker, P. 1859. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der ichthyologische fauna van Bali. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 17: 141-175
- Bleeker, P. 1859. Enumeratio specierum piscium hucusque in Archipelago indico observatarum, adjectis habitationibus citationibusque, ubi descriptiones earum recentiores reperiuntur, nec non speciebus Musei Bleekeriani Bengalensibus, Japonicis, Capensibus Tasmanicisque. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 6: 1-276
- Bleeker, P. 1859. Over eenige vischsoorten van de Zuidkust-wateren van Java. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 19: 329-352
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Derde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Singapore. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 20: 446-456
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Dertiende bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Borneo. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 8: 1-64
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Dertiende bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Celebes. Visschen van Bonthain, Badjoa, Sindjai, Lagoesi en Pompenoea. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 8: 1-60
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Elfde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Amboina. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 8: 1-14
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Tiende bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Banka. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 21: 135-142
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Twaalfde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Amboina. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 8: 1-4
- Bleeker, P. 1860. Zesde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Japan. Acta Societatis Scientiarum Indo-Neerlandicae 8: 1-104
- Bleeker, P. 1861. Iets over de geslachten der Scaroïden en kunne Indisch-archipelagische soorten. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 12: 228-244
- Bleeker, P. 1861. Zesde bijdrage tot de kennis der vischfauna van Timor. Natuurwetenschappelijk Tijdschrift voor Nederlandsch Indie Natuurwet 22: 247-261
- Bleeker, P. 1862. Atlas Ichthyologique des Indes Orientales Néerlandaises, publié sous les auspices du Gouvernement colonial néerlandais. Tome 2. Siluroïdes, Charcoïdes et Hétérobranchoïdes. Amsterdam : Fréd. Müller 112 pp. pls 49-101.
- Bleeker, P. 1862. Conspectus generum Labroideorum analyticus. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1861: 408-418
- Bleeker, P. 1862. Notices ichthyologiques. 5. Sur une nouvelle espèce de pseudolabre (Güntheri) de la Nouvelle Hollande. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 14: 130-133
- Bleeker, P. 1862. Sixième mémoire sur la faune ichthyologique de l'île Batjan. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 14: 99-112
- Bleeker, P. 1862. Sur quelques genres de la famille des pleuronectoïdes. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 13: 422-429
- Bleeker, P. 1863. Deuxième notice sur la faune ichthyologique de l'île de Flores. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 1: 248-252
- Bleeker, P. 1863. Mémoire sur les poissons de la côte de Guinée. Natuurkundige Verhandelingen van de Bataafsche Hollandsche Maatschappye der Wetenschappen te Haarlem 2 18: 1-136
- Bleeker, P. 1863. Notice sur deux espèces inédites du genre Aphthalmichthys sp. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 1: 163-166
- Bleeker, P. 1863. Notices sur une collection de poissons de la Nouvelle Hollande faite à Port Jackson. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 15: 442-451
- Bleeker, P. 1863. Onzième notice sur la faune ichthyologique de l'île de Ternate. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 1: 228-238
- Bleeker, P. 1864. Atlas Ichthyologique des Indes Orientales Néerlandaises, publié sous les auspices du Gouvernement colonial néerlandais. Tome 4. Murènes, Symbranches, Leptocéphales. Amsterdam : Fréd. Müller 132 pp. pls 145-193.
- Bleeker, P. 1864. Notice sur le genre Paraploactis et description de son espèce type. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 168-170
- Bleeker, P. 1864. Systema Muraenorum revisum. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 113-122
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Atlas Ichthyologique des Indes Orientales Néerlandaises, publié sous les auspices du Gouvernement colonial néerlandais. Tome 5. Baudroies, Ostracions, Gymnodontes, Balistes. Amsterdam : Fréd. Müller 152 pp. pls 194-231.
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Description de quelques espèces inédites de poissons de l'Archipel des Moluques. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 177-181
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Description de quelques espèces inédites des genres Pseudorhombus et Platophrys de l'Inde archipélagique. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 3: 43-50
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Description des deux espèces inédites des genres Callechelys et Pisoodonophis. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 213-216
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Enumération des espèces de poissons actuellement connues de l'île d'Amboine. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 270-293
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Poissons inédits indo-archipélagiques de l'ordre des murènes. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 38-54
- Bleeker, P. 1865. Sixième notice sur la faune ichthyologique de Siam. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 2: 171-176
- Bleeker, P. 1866. Sur les espèces d'Exocet de l'Inde Archipélagique. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 3: 105-129
- Bleeker, P. 1866. Systema Balistidorum, Ostracionidorum, Gymnodontidorumque revisum. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 3: 8-19
- Bleeker, P. 1867. Description et figure d'une espèce inédite de Crossorhinus de l'archipel des Moluques. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 2: 400-402
- Bleeker, P. 1868. Description de deux espèces inédites d'Epinephelus rapportées de l'île de la Réunion par M.M. Pollen et van Dam. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 2: 336-341
- Bleeker, P. 1868. Description de deux espèces nouvelles de Blennioïdes de l'Inde Archipelagique. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2(2): 228-280
- Bleeker, P. 1868. Description de trois espèces inédites de poissons des îles d'Amboine et de Waigiou. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 2: 331-335
- Bleeker, P. 1869. Description d'une espèce inédite de Caesio de l'île de Nossibé. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 3: 78-79
- Bleeker, P. 1869. Description et figure d'une espèce inédite de platycèphale. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 3: 253-254
- Bleeker, P. 1871. Atlas ichthyologique des Indes Orientales Néerlandaises, publié sous les auspices du Gouvernement colonial néerlandais. Amsterdam : Fréd. Müller Vol. 7 pls 277-288. [text published 1875–1876, plates published 1871–1875 Boeseman, M. 1983. Introduction. pp. 1–12 in Bleeker, P. (ed). Atlas Ichthyologique des Indes Orientales Néerlandaises. Washington, D.C. : Smithsonian Institution 12 pp. pls 421, 423.]
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Description d'une espèce inédite de Heliases d'Amboine. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 4: 111-112
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Description et figure d'une espèce insulindienne d'Orthagoriscus. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 7: 151-153
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Faune ichthyologique de Chine. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 4: 113-154
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Mededeelingen omtrent eene herziening der Indisch-Archipelagische soorten van Epinephelus, Lutjanus, Dentex en verwante geslachten. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2.2 7: 40-46
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Révision des espèces de Dentex, Synagris, Gymnocranius, Gnathodentex et Pentapus de l'Inde archipélagique et du Japon. Verhandelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen [Verh. Akad. Amsterdam] 13: 1-64
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Révision des espèces indo-archipélagiques du genre Caesio et de quelques genres voisins. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 8: 155-182
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Révision des espèces indo-archipélaqiques ges genres Plectorhynchus et Pristipoma. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 4: 273-317 [also published as separate, 1–45]
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Révision des espèces insulindiennes du genre Therapon. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 4: 372-393
- Bleeker, P. 1873. Sur les espèces indo-archipélagiques d'Odontanthias et de Pseudopriacanthus. Nederlandsch Tijdschrift voor de Dierkunde 4: 235-240
- Bleeker, P. 1874. Esquisse d'un système naturel des gobioïdes. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 9: 289-331
- Bleeker, P. 1874. Les espéces insulindiennes de la famille des Opisthognathoides. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 9: 466-476 pl 9
- Bleeker, P. 1874. Notice sur les genres Amblyeleotris, Valenciennesia et Brachyeleotris. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 7: 372-376
- Bleeker, P. 1874. Révision des espèces d'Ambassis et de Parambassis de l'Inde archipélagique. Natuurkundige Verhandelingen van de Bataafsche Hollandsche Maatschappye der Wetenschappen te Haarlem 3 2(2): 83-106
- Bleeker, P. 1874. Typi nonnulli generici piscum neglecti. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 8: 367-371
- Bleeker, P. 1875. Recherches sur la Fauna de Madagascar et de ses Dépendances d'après les Découvertes de François P.L. Pollen et D.C. van Dam. Part 3 Poissons de Madagascar et de l'île de la Réunion. Leiden 89 pp. 33 pls. [1878]
- Bleeker, P. 1875. Gobioideorum species insulindicae novae. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 10: 113-134
- Bleeker, P. 1875. Poissons de Madagascar et de l'Île la Réunion des collections de MM. Pollen et van Dam. In, Recherches sur la fauna de Madagascar et de ses d'après les découvertes de François P.L. Pollen et D.C. van Dam. Leide. Poiss. Madagascar Part 4. 1-104 pp.
- Bleeker, P. 1875. Sur le famille des pseudochromidoïdes et révision de ses espèces insulindiennes. Verhandelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen [Verh. Akad. Amsterdam] 15: 1-32
- Bleeker, P. 1875. Sur les espèces insulindiennes de la famille des cirrhitéoïdes. Verhandelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen [Verh. Akad. Amsterdam] 15: 1-20
- Bleeker, P. 1876. Description de quelques espèces insulindiennes inédites des genre Oxyurichthys, Paroxyurichthys et Cryptocentrus. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 9: 138-148
- Bleeker, P. 1876. Genera familiae Scorpaenoideorum conspectus analyticus. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 9: 294-300
- Bleeker, P. 1876. Notice sur les genres Gymnocaesio, Pterocaesio, Paracaesio et Liocaesio. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 9: 149-154
- Bleeker, P. 1876. Notice sur les genres et les espèces des Chétodontoïdes de la sousfamille des Taurichthyiformes. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 10: 308-320
- Bleeker, P. 1876. Systema Percarum revisum Pars I et II. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 11: 247-340
- Bleeker, P. 1877. Description de quelques espéces inédites de Pomacentroïdes de l'Inde archipélagique. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 10: 384-391
- Bleeker, P. 1877. Mémoire sur les Chromides marins ou Pomacentroïdes de l'Inde archipélagique. Natuurkundige Verhandelingen van de Bataafsche Hollandsche Maatschappye der Wetenschappen te Haarlem 3 2(6): 1-166
- Bleeker, P. 1878. Quatrième mémoire sur la faune ichthyologique de la Nouvelle-Guinée. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 13: 35-66 pls 2-3
- Bleeker, P. 1878. Quatrième mémoire sur la faune ichthyologique de la Nouvelle-Guinée. Archives Néerlandaises des Sciences Naturelles 13: 35-66
- Bleeker, P. 1878. Révision des espèces insulindiennes du genre Uranoscopus L. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 13: 47-59
- Bleeker, P. 1879. Révision des espèces insulindiennes de la famille des Callionymoides. Verslagen en Mededeelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen (Afdeeling Natuurjunde). Amsterdam 2 14: 79-107
- Bleeker, P. 1879. Énumération des espèces de poissons actuellement connues du Japon et description de trois espèces inédites. Verhandelingen der Koninklijke Akademie van Wetenschappen [Verh. Akad. Amsterdam] 18: 1-33 pls 1-3
- Bleeker, P. in Steindachner, F. 1866. Zur Fischfauna von Port Jackson in Australien. Sitzungsberichte der Akademie der Wissenschaften in Wien 53(1): 424-480 figs 1-7
- Bleistein, S., Horsup, A. & Ganslosser, U. 1994. Border conflicts among territorial rock wallabies (Petrogale assimilis). Aggressive Behavior 20: 325-333
- Bliss, R. 1883. Descriptions of new species of Mauritian fishes. Transactions of the Royal Society of Arts and Sciences of Mauritius 13: 45-63 [not seen]
- Bloch, M.E. 1785. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 1 136 pp. pls 109-144.
- Bloch, M.E. 1786. Tabula Blochii Naturalem Historiam Piscum in Forma Minori Representans. Augsburg. [not seen]
- Bloch, M.E. 1786. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 2 160 pp. pls 145-180.
- Bloch, M.E. 1787. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 3 146 pp. pls 181-216.
- Bloch, M.E. 1788. Ueber zwey merwürdige Fischarten (Notacanthus chemnitzii und Silurus militaris). Abhandlungen der Böhmischen Gesellschaft der Wissenschaften 3: 278-282 2 pls [not seen dated 1787 Eschmeyer, W.N. 1998. Catalog of Fishes. San Francisco : California Academy of Sciences pp. 3 vols 2905.]
- Bloch, M.E. 1789. Charactere und Beschreibung des Geschlechts der Papageyfische Callyodon. Abhandlungen der Böhmischen Gesellschaft der Wissenschaften 4: 242-248
- Bloch, M.E. 1790. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 4 128 pp. pls 217-252.
- Bloch, M.E. 1791. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 5 152 pp. pls 253-288.
- Bloch, M.E. 1792. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 6 126 pp. pls 289-323.
- Bloch, M.E. 1793. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 7 144 pp. pls 324-360.
- Bloch, M.E. 1794. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 8 174 pp. 361-396.
- Bloch, M.E. 1795. Naturgeschichte der ausländischen Fische. Berlin : J. Morino Vol. 9 192 pp. pls 397-429.
- Bloch, M.E. 1797. Ichthyologie, ou histoire naturelle, générale et particulière des poissons. Berlin Vol. 12 142 pp. pls 397–432.
- Bloch, M.E. & Schneider, J.G. 1801. Systema Ichthyologiae Iconibus ex Illustratum. Berlin 584 pp. 110 pls.
- Block, B.A. & Stevens, E.D. (eds) 2001. Tuna: Physiology, Ecology, and Evolution. Fish Physiology. London : Academic Press Vol. 19 468 pp.
- Blum, S.D. 1989. Biogeography of the Chaetodontidae, an analysis of allopatry among closely related species. Environmental Biology of Fishes 25(1): 9-31
- Blumenbach, J.F. 1800. 41. Ornithorhynchus paradoxus. Das Schnabelthier. Abbildungen naturhistorischer Gegenstände. Blumenbach, J.F. (ed.) 5tes heft. Göttingen : J.C. Dieterich.
- Blumenbach, J.F. 1800. Physiolog. Bemerkungen über den. Ornithorhynchus paradox. Götting. Anz. Gel. Sach. 62 Stück. Den 19 April 1800. 609-612 pp.
- Blumenbach, J.F. 1800. Über das Schnabelthier (Ornithorhynchus paradoxus) ein neuentdecktes Geschlecht von Säugthieren des fünften Welttheils. Magazin für den Neuesten Zustand der Naturkunde 2: 205-214
- Blyth, E. 1840. Mammalia, Birds and Reptiles. pp. 38–288. Cuvier's Animal Kingdom, arranged according to its organization; forming the basis for a natural history of animals, and an introduction to comparative anatomy. vii 670 pp.
- Blyth, E. 1840. The first Class of Vertebrate Animals—Mammalia. pp. 38–52 in Blyth, E., Mudie, R., Johnston, G. & Westwood, J.O. Cuvier's Animal Kingdom, arranged according to its organization; forming the basis for a natural history of animals, and an introduction to comparative anatomy. London : W.S. Orr vii 670 pp.
- Blyth, E. 1842. Notes on various Indian and Malayan birds, with Descriptions of some presumed new Species. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 11: 195
- Blyth, E. 1843. [Title not located]. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 12
- Blyth, E. 1844. Appendix to Mr. Blyth's Report for December Meeting, 1842. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 13(1): 361-395
- Blyth, E. 1846. [Title unknown]. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 15
- Blyth, E. 1847. Notices and Descriptions of various New or Little Known Species of Birds. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 16(1): 117-157 [Date published Feb 1847]
- Blyth, E. 1848. [Details not found]. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal xvii(1)
- Blyth, E. 1849. Catalogue of the Birds in the Museum, Asiatic Society. Calcutta : Asiatic Society of Bengal xxxiv 403 pp.
- Blyth, E. 1851. Conspectus of the Ornithology of India, Burmah, & c. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 19: 501-517 [publication dated as 1850]
- Blyth, E. 1856. Note. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 25: 447
- Blyth, E. 1859. [Title unknown]. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 27: 276
- Blyth, E. 1859. [title]. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 28
- Blyth, E. 1860. Report of Curator, Zoological Department. Bulletin du Musée Royal d'Histoire Naturelle du Belgique 29: 107-111
- Blyth, E. 1860. Report on some fishes received chiefly from the Sitang River and its tributary streams. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 29: 138-174 [not seen]
- Blyth, E. 1864. Report of the Curator, Zoological Department. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal NS 32(4): 451-461
- Blyth, E. 1866. The Ornithology of India. A Commentary on Dr. Jerdon's 'Birds of India'. Ibis 2 2(8): 336-376 [Date published Oct 1866]
- Blyth, E. 1870. Notes relating chiefly to the birds of India. Ibis 2 6: 157-176
- Blyth, E. 1878. Hydrosaurus ocellarius, In Theobald, W. Bulletin du Musée Royal d'Histoire Naturelle du Belgique 47(extra number): 21
- Bocage, J.V.B. 1866. Lista dos reptis possessoes Portuguezas d'Africa occidental que existem no Museu de Lisboa. Jornal de Sciencias Mathematicas, Physicas e Naturaes 1: 37-56
- Bocage, J.V.B. 1873. Mélanges erpétologiques. III. Sur quelques sauriens nouveaux de la Nouvelle Calédonie et de l'Australie. Jornal de Sciences Naturais, Lisboa 14: 228-232
- Bocage, J.V.B. du & Capello, F. de B. 1864. Sur quelques espèces inédites de Squalidae de la tribu Acanthiana Gray, qui fréquentent les côtes du Portugal. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1864: 260-263 figs 1-5
- Bock, W.J. 1962. The pneumatic fossa of the humerus in the Passeres. Auk 79: 425-443
- Bock, W.J. 1963. Relationships between the birds of paradise and the bower-birds. Condor 65: 95-125
- Bock, W.J. 1985. The skeletomuscular system of the feeding apparatus of the Noisy Scrub-bird, Atrichornis clamosus (Passeriformes: Atrichornithidae). Records of the Australian Museum 37: 193-210
- Bock, W.J. 1986. Species concepts, speciation and macroevolution. pp. 31-57 in Iwatsuki, K., Raven, P.H. & Bock, W.J. (eds). Modern Aspects of Species. Tokyo : University of Tokyo Press.
- Bock, W.J. 1994. History and nomenclature of avian family-group names. Bulletin of the American Museum of Natural History 222: 1-281
- Bock, W.J. & McEvey, A. 1969. The radius and relationship of owls. Wilson Bulletin 81: 55-68
- Bock, W.J. & Morony, J.J. 1978. Relationships of the passerine finches (Passeriformes: Passeridae). Bonner Zoologische Beiträge 29: 122-147
- Bocourt, F. 1868. Description de quelques Chélonians nouveaux appartenant à la faune Mexicaine. Annales des Sciences Naturelles, Paris 5 10: 121-122
- Boddaert, P. 1772. Epistola ad Virum celeberrimum Hier. Dav. Gaubium, de Chaetodonte diacantho, Descripto atque accuratissima icone Illustrata. Amstelodami : M. Magérum 43 pp. 2 pls. [text in Dutch and Latin]
- Boddaert, P. 1781. Beschreibung zweier merkwürdiger Fische (Sparus palpebratus und Muraena colubrina). Neue Nordische Beiträge (Pallas) 1781: 55-57 pl. 2 [not seen]
- Boddaert, P. 1783. Table des Planches Enluminéez d'Histoire Naturelle, de M. d'Aubenton. Avec les denominations de M.M. de Buffon, Brisson, Edwards, Linnaeus et Latham, precédé d'une Notice des Principaux Ouvrages Zoologiques enluminées. Utrecht : Boddaert xv 58 + 9 pp. [published Dec. 1783 International Trust for Zoological Nomenclature 1985. International Code of Zoological Nomenclature. Third edition adopted by the XX General Assembly of the International Union of Biological Sciences. London : International Trust for Zoological Nomenclature xx 338 pp. [Art. 3]]
- Boddaert, P. 1785. Elenchus Animalium. Vol. I. Sistens Quadrupedia eorumque varietates. Rotterdam : C.R. Hake.
- Boehm, E.F. 1939. The Fork-tailed Swift (Micropus pacificus Latham, 1801): with special reference to its occurrence in South Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 15: 54-58
- Boehm, E.F. 1959. Parrots and cockatoos of the Mount Mary Plains, South Australia. The Emu 59: 83-87
- Boehm, E.F. 1960. Little Corella in southern South Australia. The Emu 60: 67-68 [publication date Mathews, G.M. 1920. Dates of ornithological works. Austral Avian Records 4: 1–27 Zimmer, J.T. 1926. Catalogue of the Edward E. Ayer Ornithological Library. Field Museum of Natural History Publications, Zoological Series 16: 1–364 (Pt 1, Publ. 239), 365–706 (Pt 2, Publ. 240)]
- Boehm, E.F. 1961. Indian Turtle-dove extends in range in South Australia. The Emu 61: 55
- Boehm, E.F. 1961. Pink Cockatoo in southern South Australia. The Emu 61: 138-139 [July, 1830, publication dated as 1831]
- Boehm, E.F. 1961. Some habits of the Fork-tailed Swift. The Emu 61: 281-282
- Boeseman, M. 1947. Revision of the fishes collected by Burger and van Siebold in Japan. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 28: 1-242 pls 1-5
- Boeseman, M. 1962. Triodon macropterus versus Triodon bursarius; an attempt to establish the correct name and authorship. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 38(4): 77-85
- Boeseman, M. 1964. Notes on the fishes of western New Guinea II. Lophichthys boschmai, a new genus and species from the Arafoera Sea. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 39: 12-18 pls 1-2
- Boettger, O. 1878. Studien über neue oder wenig bekannte Eidechsen. I. Offenbacher Verein für Naturkunde, Berlin 17–18: 1-12
- Boettger, O. 1888. Las tortugas Chilenas. Anales de la Universidad de Chile 104: 725-736
- Boettger, O. 1892. Katalog der Batrachier-Sammlung im Museum der Senckenbergischen Naturforschenden Gesellschaft in Frankfurt-am-Main. Frankfurt-am-Main : Knauer x 73 pp.
- Boettger, O. 1893. Katalog der Reptilien-Sammlung im Museum der Senckenbergischen Naturforschenden Gesellschaft in Frankfurt-am-Main. I. Teil (Rhynchocephalen, Schildkröten, Krokodile, Eidechsen, Chamäleons). Frankfurt-am-Main : Knauer x 140 pp.
- Boettger, O. 1894. Lurche (Batrachia). pp. 107-114 in Semon, R. (ed.). Zoologische Forschungsreisen in Australien und dem Malayischen Archipel. Jena : Gustav Fischer Vol. 5.
- Boettger, O. 1895. Liste der Reptilien und Batrachier der Insel Halmaheira nach den Sammlunge Prof. Dr. W. Kukenthal's. Zoologischer Anzeiger 18(472): 129-140
- Boetticher, H. von 1936. Rolliers et Eurystomes. Oiseau Revue Français d'Ornithologie 6: 422-434
- Boetticher, H. von 1943. Gedanken über die systematische Stellung einiger Papageien. Zoologischer Anzeiger 143: 191-200
- Boetticher, H. von 1951. La systématique des guêpiers. Oiseau Revue Français d'Ornithologie 21: 194-199
- Boetticher, H. von 1954. Die Taubengattung Columba L. Zoologischer Anzeiger 153: 49-64
- Boetticher, H. von 1959. Papageien. Wittenberg, Lutherstadt : A. Ziemsen (Die Neue Brehm-Bücherei) 228 116 pp.
- Bogdanov, M. 1879. [Transactions of the Natural History Society in Connection with the Imperial Kazan University]. [The Birds of the Caucasus]. Vol. 8(4). [in Russian]
- Bogert, C. 1937. Birds collected during the Whitney South Sea Expedition. XXXIV The distribution and the migration of the Long-tailed Cuckoo (Urodynamis taitensis Sparrman). American Museum Novitates 933: 1-12
- Boghdanov, M. 1884. Conspectus Avium Imperii Rossici. St.-Pétersbourg : Commissionaires de l'Académie Impériale des Sciences Fasc. 1 122 pp.
- Boie 1826. In, Férussac, J.B.L.A. Bull. Sci., 9: 238.
- Boie, F. 1827. Bemerkungen über Merrem's Versuch eines Systems der Amphibien. Isis von Oken, Jena 20: 508-566
- Boie, F. 1844. Auszüge aus dem "System der Ornithologie". Isis Oken 1844(III): col. 164-198
- Boie, J.F. 1822. [Title unknown]. Isis von Oken, Jena 1822: 564
- Boie, J.F. 1822. [not located]. Isis x
- Boie, J.F. 1822. [title not located]. Isis von Oken, Jena 5
- Boie, J.F. 1826. Generalüebersicht der ornithologischen Ordnungen, Familien und Gattungen. Isis von Oken, Jena 19(10): 969-982 [Date published Oct 1826]
- Boie, J.F. 1832. [Title not located]. N. Staatsburg. Mag. (Schleswik) 1(2)
- Boie, J.F. 1844. [Title not located]. Isis von Oken, Jena 1844
- Boitard, [P.] 1841. Le Jardin des Plantes. Description et Moeurs des Mammifères de la Ménagerie et du Muséum d'Histoire Naturelle Précédé d'une Introduction Historique, Descriptive et Pittoresque par M.J. Janin. Paris : J.J. Dubochet et Ce lxvi lxvi, 472 pp. [dated 1842 = August 1841; publication date established from Sherborn, C.D. 1922. Index Animalium sive index nominum quae ab A.D. MDCCLVIII generibus et speciebus animalium imposita sunt. Sectio secunda a kalendis Ianuariis, MDCCCI usque ad finem Decembris, MDCCCL. Part 1. Introduction, bibliography and index A-Aff. 1801–1850. London : British Museum cxxxi 128 pp. [xxvi]]
- Boles, W.E. 1983. A taxonomic revision of the Brown Thornbill Acanthiza pusilla (Shaw) with the description of a new subspecies. The Emu 83(2): 51-55 [Date published Jun 1983]
- Boles, W.E. 1988. Comments on the subspecies of Australian native and introduced finches. The Emu 88(1): 20-24 [Date published Mar 1988]
- Boles, W.E. 1988. The Robins and Flycatchers of Australia. Sydney : Angus and Robertson.
- Boles, W.E. 1989. Correct authorship of Pomatostomidae. Auk 106(2): 341 [Date published 26 Apr 1989]
- Boles, W.E. 1993. A Logrunner Orthonyx (Passeriformes: Orthonychidae) from the Miocene of Riversleigh, north-western Queensland. The Emu 93: 44-49
- Boles, W.E. 1993. A new cockatoo (Psittaciformes: Cacatuidae) from the Tertiary of Riversleigh, northwestern Queensland, and an evaluation of rostral characters in the systematics of parrots. Ibis 135: 8-18
- Boles, W.E. & Longmore, N.W. 1983. A new subspecies of treecreeper in the Climacteris leucophaea superspecies. The Emu 83: 272-275
- Bolin, R.L. 1939. A review of the myctophid fishes of the Pacific Coast of the United States and of lower California. Stanford Ichthyological Bulletin 1(4): 89-156 figs 1-29
- Bolin, R.L. 1952. Description of a new genus and species of cottid fish from the Tasman sea, with a discussion of its derivation, from the Danish Galathea Expedition 1950–52. Videnskabelige Meddelelser fra Dansk Naturhistorisk Forening 114: 431-441 figs 1-2
- Bolin, R.L. 1959. Iniomi Myctophidae from the Michael Sars North Atlantic deep sea expedition 1910. Report on the Scientific Results of the Michael Sars North Atlantic Deep Sea Expedition 4(2): 1-45 figs 1-7
- Bolin, R.L. & Wisner, R.L. in Bolin, R.L. 1959. Iniomi Myctophidae from the Michael Sars North Atlantic deep sea expedition 1910. Report on the Scientific Results of the Michael Sars North Atlantic Deep Sea Expedition 4(2): 1-45 figs 1-7
- Bolin, R.L. in Andriashev, A.P. 1962. Bathypelagic fishes of the Antarctic. 1. Family Myctophidae. Akademii Nauk SSSR, Issledovaniya Fauny Morei 1(9): 216-294 figs 1-36 [in Russian; Bur. Comm. Fish. Ichthyol. Lab. Transl. 29]
- Bolton, B.L. & Latz, P.K. 1978. The western hare-wallaby, Lagorchestes hirsutus (Gould) (Macropodidae), in the Tanami Desert. Australian Wildlife Research 5: 285-293
- Bolton, B.L., Newsome, A.E. & Merchant, J.C. 1982. Reproduction in the agile wallaby Macropus agilis (Gould) in the tropical lowlands of the Northern Territory: opportunism in a seasonal environment. Australian Journal of Ecology 7: 261-277
- Bolton, B.L., Newsome, A.E. & Merchant, J.C. 1985. Reproduction in the agile wallaby: opportunistic breeding in a seasonal environment. Proceedings of the Ecological Society of Australia 13: 73-79
- Bomford, M. 1987. Food and reproduction of wild house mice I. Diet and breeding seasons in various habitats on irrigated cereal farms in New South Wales. Australian Wildlife Research 14: 183-196
- Bomford, M. 1987. Food and reproduction of wild house mice II. A field experiment to examine the effect of food availability and food quality on breeding in spring. Australian Wildlife Research 14: 197-206
- Bomford, M. 1987. Food and reproduction of wild house mice III. Experiments on the breeding performance of caged house mice fed rice based diets. Australian Wildlife Research 14: 207-218
- Bomford, M. & Redhead, T. 1987. A field experiment to examine the effects of food quality and population density on reproduction of wild house mice. Oikos 48: 304-311
- Bonaccorso, F.J. 1998. Bats of Papua New Guinea. Washington D.C. : Conservation International.
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1836. Cheloniorum Tabula Analytica. Rome. 9 pp.
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1837. Iconografia della Fauna Italica: per le quattro classi degli animali vertebrati. Tomo 1 Mammiferi e Uccelli. Fasc. XXI (1832–1841). Roma : Tipografia Salviucci. [publication date established from Salvadori, T. 1888. Le date della pubblicazione della 'Iconografia della Fauna Italicien' del Bonaparte ed Indice delle species illustrata in detta opera. Bollettino dei Musei di Zoologia ed Anatomia Comparata della Reale Università di Torino 3(48): 1–25 [9]; first page (unnumbered) of text entitled Vespertilio ursinii]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1850. Conspectus Generum Avium. Tom. I. Lugduni, Batavorum : E.J. Brill 543 pp. [Date published 24 Jun 1850]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1850. Nouvelles espèces ornithologiques. Première partie: Perroquets. Lugduni. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 30: 131-139 [published Feb.]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1853. Classification ornithologique par series. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1853. Notes ornithologique sur les collections rapportées en 1853, par, M.A. Delattre, et classification parallélique des Passereaux chanteurs. Ces Notes, qui ont ete lues et inserées par extrait les Comptes Rendus de l'Academie, offrent dans cette nouvelle publication plusiers additions à ce qui avait ete précédemment communique. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 37: 827-835
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Conspectus Volucrum Anisodactylorum. Ateneo Italiano 2(11): 311-321
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Conspectus Volucrum Anisodactylorum. Ateneo Italiano 2(11): 311-321 [Date published Aug 1854]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Conspectus Volucrum Zygodactylorum. Ateneo Italiano 2: 116-129
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Conspectus systematis ornithologiae. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 38
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Coup d'oeil sur l'ordre des pigeons. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 39: 1072-1078 [Publication date established from Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Coup d'oeil sur l'ordre des pigeons. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 39: 1102-1112
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Coup d'oeil sur l'ordre des pigeons. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 39: 869-880
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Notes Ornithologiques sur les Collections Rapportées en 1853, par M.A. Delattre, de son Voyage en Californie et dans le Nicaragua [et Classification Parallélique des Passereaux Chanteurs]. Paris : Mallet-Bachelier Vol. 37.
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Tableau des oiseaux de proie. Revue et Magasin de Zoologie (Paris) 2 6: 530-544
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. Tableau des perroquets. Revue et Magasin de Zoologie (Paris) 2 6: 145-158
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1854. [Title not located]. Annales des Sciences Naturelles, Zoologie 4 1(2)
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1855. Coup d'oeil sur l'ordre des pigeons. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 40: 15-24 [published 3 Jan.]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1855. Coup d'oeil sur l'ordre des pigeons. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 40: 205-221 [published 29 Jan.]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1856. Beilage Nr .1. Tabellarische Uebersicht der Papageien. Naumannia 1856: Beilage 1a
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1856. Excursions dans les divers Musees d'Allemagne, de Hollande et de Belgique, et Tableaux paralleliques de l'orde des Palmipedes. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 43: 410-421
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1856. [Title]. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles xlii
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1857. Conspectus Generum Avium. Lugduni, Batavorum : E.J. Brill Vol. 2 232 pp. [published 1855]
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1857. Remarques à Propos des Observations de M. Émile Blanchard sur les Caractères Ostéologiques chez les Oiseaux de la Famille des Psittacides, et Tableau des Genres de Perroquets. Disposés en Séries Parallèles. Paris : C.L. Bonaparte 9 pp.
- Bonaparte, C.L. 1857. Remarques à propos des observations de M. Émile Blanchard sur les caractères ostéologiques chez les oiseaux de la famille des Psittacides, et Tableau des genres de Perroquets disposés en séries parallèles. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 44: 534-539
- Bonaparte, C.L. in Parzudaki, É. 1856. Catalogue des oiseaux d'Europe offerts en 1856 aux ornithologistes. Paris : É. Parzudaki 25 pp.
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L 1830. Osservazioni sulla seconda edizione del Regno Animale del Barone Cuvier. Annali del Museo Civico di Storia Naturale Bologna 4: 303-464
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L. 1831. Saggio d'una distribuzione metodica degli animali Vertebrati, a sangue freddo. Giornale Arcadico de Scienze Roma 52(4): 129-209
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L. 1838. A Geographical and Comparative List of the Birds of Europe and North America. London : John Van Voorst vii, 67 pp.
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L. 1854. [Title unknown]. Naumannia
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L. 1856. [Title]. Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles xliii
- Bonaparte, C.L.J.L. 1857. [title]. Revue et Magasin de Zoologie (Paris)
- Bonaparte, C.L.P. 1832. Iconografia della Fauna Italica, per le quattro Classi degli Animali Vertebrati. Pesci. Vol. 3 30 fasc. Roma : Salviucci 78 pls. [not seen, 1832-4]
- Bonaparte, C.L.P. 1834. Iconografia della Fauna Italica, per le quattro Classi degli Animali Vertebrati. Pesci. Vol. 3 Fasc. 7. Roma : Salviucci 35-39 pls. [not seen]
- Bonaparte, C.L.P. 1840. Iconografia della Fauna Italica, per le quattro Classi degli Animali Vertebrati. Pesci. Vol 3 Fasc. 27–29. Roma : Salviucci 135-154 pp., 18 pls. [not seen for publication date Salvatori, T. 1888. Le date della publicazione della "Iconographia della Fauna Italica" del Bonaparte ed Indice delle specie illustrate in detta opera. Bollettino dei Musei di Zoologia ed Anatomia Comparata della Reale Università di Torino 3(48): 1–25 [13]]
- Bonaparte, C.L.P. 1846. Catalogo metodico dei pesci europei. Napoli : Stamperia E Cartiere del Fibreno 95 pp.
- Bonaparte, L.C. 1826. Further Additions to the Ornithology of the United States; and Observations on the Nomenclature of Certain Species. Annals of the Lyceum of Natural History New York 2: 154 -161
- Bond, C.E. & Uyeno, T. 1981. Remarkable changes in the vertebrae of perciform fish Scombrolabrax with notes on its anatomy and systematics. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 28(3): 259-262
- Bonde, C. von 1922. The Heterosomata (flat fishes) collected by the S.S. 'Pickle'. Report. Fisheries & Marine Biological Survey, Union of South Africa 2(1): 1-29
- Bonelli, F.A. 1820. Description d'une nouvelle espèce de poisson de la Méditerranée appartenant au genre Trachyptère (T. cristatus) avec des observations sur les caractères de ce même genre. Mémoires de l'Académie des Sciences, Turin 24: 485-494
- Bonnaterre (L'Abbé) 1789. Tableau Encyclopédique et Méthodique des trois règnes de la nature. Erpétologie. Paris : Panckoucke xxviii, 70 pp.
- Bonnaterre, (l'Abbé) 1791. Tableau Encyclopédique et Méthodique des Trois Règnes de la Nature. Ornithologie. Paris : Agasse Vol. 1.
- Bonnaterre, J.P. 1788. Tableau Encyclopédique et Méthodique des trois Règnes de la Nature. Ichthyologie. Paris. pp. 1-215, 102 pls
- Bonnaterre, J.P. 1788. Tableau Encyclopédique et Méthodique des trois Règnes de la Nature. Ichthyologie. Paris. pp. 1-215, 102 pls
- Bonner, W.N. 1981. Southern fur seals Arctocephalus (Geoffroy Saint-Hilaire and Cuvier, 1826). pp. 161-208 in Ridgway, S.H. & Harrison, R.J. (eds). Handbook of Marine Mammals. Volume 1. The Walrus, Sea Lions, Fur Seals and Sea Otter. London : Academic Press.
- Boonstra, R. & Redhead, T.D. 1994. Population dynamics of an outbreak population of house mice (Mus domesticus) in the irrigated rice-growing area of Australia. Wildlife Research 21: 583-598
- Boontheung, P., Gao, Ch.-W.. Brinkworth, C.S., Bowie, J.H. & Tyler, M.J. 2006. Is the Australian Striped Burrowing Frog Litoria alboguttata a member of Litoria or Cyclorana? A profiling study using skin peptides as a probe. Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 130(1): 1-9
- Borden, W.C. 1998. Phylogeny of the unicornfishes (Naso, Acanthuridae) based on soft anatomy. Copeia 1998(1): 104-113
- Borden, W.C. 1999. Comparative myology of the unicornfishes, Naso (Acanthuridae, Percomorpha), with implications for phylogenetic analysis. Journal of Morphology 239: 191-224
- Borkhausen, M.B. 1797. Deutsche Fauna, oder kurzgefasste Naturgeschichte der Thiere Deutschlands. Erster Theil. Säugthiere und Vögel. Frankfurt am. Mayn : Varrentr & Wenner xxiv 620 pp.
- Borodin, N.A. 1928. Scientific results of the yacht Ara expedition during the years 1926 to 1928, while in command of William K. Vanderbilt. Fishes. Bulletin of the Vanderbilt Oceanographic Museum 1(1): 1-37 pls 1-5
- Borodin, N.A. 1929. Some new deep sea fishes. Proceedings of the New England Zoological Club 10: 109-111
- Borodin, N.A. 1932. Scientific results of the yacht Alva world cruise, July 1931 to March 1932 in command of William K. Vanderbilt. Bulletin of the Vanderbilt Marine Museum 1(3): 65-101 pls 1-2
- Borodin, N.A. 1933. A new Australian fish. Copeia 1933(3): 141-143
- Borodulina, O.D. 1977. A new species of hatchetfish, Sternoptyx pseudodiaphana (Sternoptychidae, Osteichthyes) from the waters of the southern hemisphere. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 17(5): 938-941 figs 1-2 [in Russian; English translation J. Ichthyol. 17(5): 791–794 figs 1–2]
- Borodulina, O.D. 1978. Materials on the systematics and distribution of the oceanic hatchet-fishes genera Argyropelecus and Sternoptyx (Sternoptychidae, Osteichthyes). Trudy Instituta Okeanologii. Akademiya Nauk SSSR. Moskva 111: 28-60 figs 1-16 [in Russian]
- Borodulina, O.D. 1979. Composition of the "Polyipnus spinosus species complex" (Sternoptychidae, Osteichthyes) with a description of three new species of this group. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 19(2): 198-208 figs 1-5 [in Russian; English translation J. Ichthyol. 19(2): 1–10 figs 1–5]
- Borowski, G.H. 1781. Gemeinnüzzige Naturgeschichte des Thierreichs, darinnen die merkwurdigsten und nützlichsten Thiere in systemat..... Berlin & Stralsund : Lange Vol. 2.
- Borsboom, A. 1982. Agonistic interactions between bats and arboreal marsupials. Australian Mammalogy 5: 281-282
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1822. Dictionnarie Classique d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris : Rey et Gravier Vol. 2 621 pp. [articles on fishes]
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1823. Dictionnaire Classique d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris : Rey et Gravier Vol. 3 592 pp. [articles on fishes]
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1823. Dictionnaire Classique d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris : Rey et Gravier Vol. 4 628 pp. [articles on fishes]
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1825. p. 183 in, Dictionnaire Classique d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris : Rey et Gravier Vol. 7.
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1831. Dictionnaire Classique d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris : Rey et Gravier Vol. 17 141 pp. 160 pls. [articles on fishes]
- Bory de Saint-Vincent, J.B.G.M. 1833. Expédition scientifique en Morée, entérise et publée par ordre du gouvernement français. Travaux de la section des sciences physiques, sous la direction de M. le colonel Bory de Saint-Vincent. Paris : P. Bertrand Vol. 3(1) 209 pp.
- Bos, D.G. & Carthew, S.M. 2001. Population ecology of Ningaui yvonneae (Dasyuridae: Marsupialia) in the Middleback Ranges, Eyre Peninsula, South Australia. Wildlife Research 28: 507-515
- Bos, D.G. & Carthew, S.M. 2003. The influence of behaviour and season on habitat selection by a small mammal. Ecography 26: 810-820
- Bosc, L.A.G. 1817. Poissons. In, Nouveau Dictionnaire d'Histoire Naturelle. Appliquée aux arts à l'Agriculture, à l'Economie rurale et domestique, à la Médecine, etc. Paris : Deterville Vol. 7 586 pp.
- Bosc, L.A.G. 1818. Poissons. (Miscellaneous). In, Nouveau Dictionnaire d'Histoire Naturelle. Appliquée aux arts, à l'Agriculture, à l'Economie rurale et domestique, à la Médecine, etc. Paris : Deterville Vol. 27 586 pp. 4 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1882. Catalogue of the Batrachia Gradentia s. Caudata in the collection of the British Museum. London : British Museum xvi + 503 pp.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1882. Catalogue of the Batrachia Gradientia s. Caudata and Batrachia Apoda in the collection of the British Museum. London : British Museum viii 127 pp.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1882. Catalogue of the Chelonians, Rhynchocephalians, and Crocodiles in the British Museum (Natural History). London : British Museum x 311 pp.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1883. Remarks on the lizards of the genus Lophognathus. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 5 12: 225-226
- Boulenger, G.A. 1885. Catalogue of the Lizards in the British Museum (Natural History). 1. London : British Museum xii 436 pp. 32 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1885. Catalogue of the Lizards in the British Museum (Natural History). 2. London : British Museum xiii 497 pp. 24 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1885. Descriptions of three new species of geckos. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 5 16: 473-475
- Boulenger, G.A. 1885. Remarks on Mr. C.W. De Vis's recent contributions to the herpetology of Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 5 16: 386-387
- Boulenger, G.A. 1886. Description of the new gecko of the genus Nephrurus. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 5 18: 91
- Boulenger, G.A. 1887. An account of the scincoid lizards collected in Burma, for the Genoa Civic Museum, by Mrs G.B. Comotti and L. Sea. Annali del Museo Civico di Storia Naturale 'Giacomo Doria' 2 4: 618-624
- Boulenger, G.A. 1887. Catalogue of the Lizards in the British Museum (Natural History). 3. London : British Museum xii 575 pp. 40 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1887. Reptiles. In Günther, A. Report on a zoological collection made by the officers of H.M.S. Flying Fish at Christmas Island, Indian Ocean. Proc. Zool. Soc. Lond. 1887: 516–517. 516-517 pp.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1888. Descriptions of two new Australian frogs. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 2: 142-143
- Boulenger, G.A. 1888. On the Chelydoid Chelonians of New Guinea. Annali del Museo Civico di Storia Naturale Genova 2 6: 449-452
- Boulenger, G.A. 1889. Catalogue of the Chelonians, Rhynchocephalians, and Crocodiles in the British Museum (Natural History). London : British Museum.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1889. Description of new Typhlopidae in the British Museum. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 4: 360-363
- Boulenger, G.A. 1889. On the reptiles of Christmas Island. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1888: 534-536
- Boulenger, G.A. 1889. Second account of the fishes obtained by Surgeon Major A.S.G. Jayakar at Muscat, east coast of Arabia. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1889(2): 236-246 pls 25-28
- Boulenger, G.A. 1890. Description of a new genus of cystignathoid frogs from New South Wales. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 2 5: 593-594
- Boulenger, G.A. 1890. The Fauna of British India; including Ceylon and Burma. Reptilia and Batrachia. London : Taylor & Francis xviii 541 pp.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1891. Description of a new scincoid lizard from north Western Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 8: 405
- Boulenger, G.A. 1893. Description of a new tree frog from New South Wales. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 2 7: 403
- Boulenger, G.A. 1894. Catalogue of Snakes in the British Museum (Natural History). 2. London : British Museum xi 382 pp. 20 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1895. A new Typhlops previously confounded with Typhlops unguirostris. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 2 9: 718-719
- Boulenger, G.A. 1895. Catalogue of the Fishes in the British Museum. Catalogue of the perciform fishes. London : British Museum Vol. 1 394 pp. 15 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1895. Descriptions of two new reptiles obtained by Mr A.S. Meek in the Trobriand Islands, British New Guinea. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 14: 408-409
- Boulenger, G.A. 1895. On a collection of reptiles and batrachians from Ferguson Island, D'Entrecasteaux group British New Guinea. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 16: 28-32
- Boulenger, G.A. 1896. Erratum (Annals, Sept. 1896, p. 233) for Lygosoma ocellatum read Lygosoma ocelliferum. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 18: 342
- Boulenger, G.A. 1896. Catalogue of Snakes in the British Museum (Natural History). 3. London : British Museum xiv 727 pp. 25 pls.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1896. Description of four new lizards from Roebuck Bay, north Western Australia obtained by Dr. Dahl, for the Christiania Museum. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 18: 232-235
- Boulenger, G.A. 1896. Descriptions of a new snake and a new frog from north Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1895: 867
- Boulenger, G.A. 1897. Reptilia and Batrachia. Geckonidae. Zoological Records 33: 19-20
- Boulenger, G.A. 1898. Description of a new death adder (Acanthophis) from central Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 2: 75
- Boulenger, G.A. 1898. Description of two new snakes from Queensland. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 2: 414
- Boulenger, G.A. 1898. Third report on additions to the collection of lizards in the British Museum. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1898: 912-923
- Boulenger, G.A. 1899. A revision of the African and Syrian fishes of the family Cichlidae. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1899: 98-143
- Boulenger, G.A. 1901. On some deep-sea fishes collected by Mr. F.W. Townsend in the sea of Oman. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 7: 261-263
- Boulenger, G.A. 1902. Description of a new snake of the genus. Pseudechis from Queensland. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 10: 494-495
- Boulenger, G.A. 1902. Description of new deep-sea gadid fish from South Africa. (Tripterophysis gilchristi n. g. et sp.). Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 9(55): 335-336 1 fig.
- Boulenger, G.A. 1902. Notes on the classification of teleostean fishes. 2. On the Berycidae. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 9(33): 197-204
- Boulenger, G.A. 1904. Description of a new lizard from Western Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 14: 414-415
- Boulenger, G.A. 1906. Description of a new lizard and a new snake from Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 18: 440-441
- Boulenger, G.A. 1908. Description of a new Elapine snake from Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 1: 333-334
- Boulenger, G.A. 1912. On some tree frogs allied to Hyla caerulea, with remarks on noteworthy secondary sexual characteristics in the family Hylidae. Zoologische Jahrbücher 15 1: 211-218
- Boulenger, G.A. 1913. Description of new lizards in the collection of the British Museum. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 12: 563-566
- Boulenger, G.A. 1914. Descriptions of new species of snakes in the collection of the British Museum. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 14: 482-485
- Boulenger, G.A. 1915. Descriptions of two new lizards from Australia. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 8 16: 64-66
- Bourchier, M.J.B. 1978. A Victorian record of the Forest Kingfisher. Australian Bird Watcher 7: 160-161
- Bourjot Saint-Hilaire, A. 1838. Histoire Naturelle des Perroquets, troisième volume (Supplémentaire), pour faire suite aux deux volumes de Levaillant, contenant les espèces laissées inédites par cet auteur ou récemment découvertes. Paris : F.G. Levrault xl 110 pp. 111 pls. [publication dated as 1837–1838]
- Bourke, P.A. 1951. Nesting notes of the Red-backed Parrot. The Emu 51: 31-32
- Bourke, P.A. 1960. The Purple-crowned Lorikeet in New South Wales. The Emu 60: 134
- Bourke, P.A. & Austin, A.F. 1947. Notes on the Red-browed Lorilet. The Emu 46: 286-294
- Bourne, A.R. 1981. Progesterone-like activity in the plasma of the viviparous skink Trachydosaurus rugosus (stump-tailed lizard). pp. 14-16 in Banks, C.B. & Martin, A.A. (eds). Proceedings of the Melbourne Herpetological Symposium, 1980. Melbourne : Zoological Board of Victoria pp. 44-54.
- Bourne, A.R. & Seamark, R.F. 1978. Seasonal variation in steroid biosynthesis by the testis of the lizard Tiliqua rugosa. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 59B: 363-367
- Boursot, P., Auffray, J.-C., Britton-Davidian, J. & Bonhomme, F. 1993. The evolution of the house mouse. Annual Review of Ecology and Systematics 24: 119-152
- Bowen, M. & Goldingay, R.L. 2000. Distribution and status of the eastern pygmy possum (Cercartetus nanus) in New South Wales. Australian Mammalogy 21: 153-164
- Bowen, Z. & Read, J.L. 1998. Population and demographic pattern of rabbits (Oryctolagus cuniculus) at Roxbury Downs in arid South Australia and the influence of rabbit haemorrhagic disease. Wildlife Research 25: 655-662
- Bower, J.C., Newell, G.R. & Eldridge, M.D.B. 2002. Genetic effects of habitat contraction on Lumholt’s tree kangaroo (Dendrolagus lumholtzi) in the Australian Wet Tropics. 3: 61-69
- Bowman, D.M.J.S. & McDonough, L. 1993. Feral pig (Sus scrofa) rooting in a monsoon forest - wetland transition, northern Australia. Wildlife Research 18: 761-765
- Bowman, D.M.J.S. & Panton, W.J. 1991. Sign and habitat impact of Banteng (Bos javanicus) and pig (Sus scrofa), Cobourg Peninsula, northern Australia. Australian Journal of Ecology 16: 15-17
- Bowman, M.J.S. & Robinson, C.J. 2002. The getting of the Nganabbarru: observations and reflections of Aboriginal buffalo hunting in northern Australia. Australian Geographer 33(2): 191-206
- Braby, M.F. & Rantzan, C. 1988. Observations on feeding flocks of the Red-rumped Parrot Psephotus haematonotus in parklands near Melbourne, Victoria. Australian Bird Watcher 12: 150-153
- Bradbury, M.G. 1967. The genera of batfishes (family Ogcocephalidae). Copeia 1967(2): 399-422 figs 1-9
- Bradbury, M.G. 1999. A review of the fish genus Dibranchus with descriptions of new species and a new genus Solocisquama (Lophiiformes, Ogcocephalidae). Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 51(5): 259-310
- Bradbury, M.G. 1999. Family Ogcocephalidae. pp. 2023-2025 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Bradley, A.J 2003. Stress, hormones and mortality in small dasyurid marsupials. pp. 250-263 in Jones, M., Dickman, C. & Archer, M. (eds). Predators with Pouches. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing.
- Bradley, A.J. 1987. Stress and mortality in the red-tailed phascogale, Phascogale calura (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). General and Comparative Endocrinology 67: 85-100
- Bradley, A.J. 1990. Seasonal effects on the haematology and blood chemistry in the red-tailed phascogale, Phascogale calura (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 37: 533-543
- Bradley, A.J. 1995. Red-tailed Phascogale Phascogale calura. pp. 102-103 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bradley, A.J. 1997. Reproduction and life history in the red-tailed phascogale, Phascogale calura (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae): The adaptive-stress senescence hypothesis. Journal of Zoology, London 241: 739-755
- Bradley, A.J. & Monamy, V. 1991. A physiological profile of male Dusky Antechinuses, Antechinus swainsonii (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae) surviving post-mating mortality. Australian Mammalogy 14: 25-27
- Bradley, A.J. & Stoddart, D.M. 1993. The dorsal paracloacal gland and its relationship with seasonal changes in cutaneous scent gland morphology and plasma androgen in the marsupial sugar glider (Petaurus breviceps: Marsupialia: Petauridae). Journal of Zoology, London 229: 331-346
- Bradley, A.J., Kemper, C.M., Kitchener, D.J., Humphreys, W.F., How, R.A. & Schmitt, L.H. 1988. Population ecology and physiology of the common rock rat, Zyzomys argurus (Rodentia, Muridae) in tropical northwestern Australia. Journal of Mammalogy 69: 749-764
- Bradley, A.J., McDonald, I.R. & Lee, A.K. 1980. Stress and mortality in a small marsupial (Antechinus stuartii Macleay). General and Comparative Endocrinology 40: 188-200
- Bradshaw, S.D. 1970. Seasonal changes in the water and electrolyte metabolism of Amphibolurus lizards in the field. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 36: 689-718 [Sherborn, C.D. 1925. Index Animalium. London : British Museum Vol. 2 1773–2880 pp.]
- Bradshaw, S.D. 1971. Growth and mortality in a field population of Amphibolurus lizards exposed to seasonal cold and aridity. Journal of Zoology, London 165: 1-25
- Bradshaw, S.D. 1975. Osmoregulation and pituitary-adrenal function in desert reptiles. General and Comparative Endocrinology 25: 230-248
- Bradshaw, S.D. 1981. Ecophysiology of Australian desert lizards: studies on the genus Amphibolurus. pp. 1393-1434 in Keast, A. (ed.). Ecological Biogeography of Australia. The Hague : Dr. W. Junk.
- Bradshaw, S.D. 1983. Recent endocrinological research on the Rottnest Island quokka (Setonix brachyurus). Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 66: 55-61
- Bradshaw, S.D. & Main, A.R. 1968. Behavioural attitudes and regulation of temperature in Amphibolurus lizards. Journal of Zoology, London 154: 193-221
- Bradshaw, S.D. & Shoemaker, V.H. 1967. Aspects of water and electrolyte changes in a field population of Amphibolurus lizards. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 20: 855-865
- Bradshaw, S.D., Gans, C. & Saint Girons, H. 1980. Behavioural thermoregulation in a pygopodid lizard, Lialis burtonis. Copeia 1980: 738-743
- Bradshaw, S.D., Morris, K.D. & Bradshaw, F.J. 2001. Water and electrolyte homeostasis and kidney function of desert-dwelling marsupial wallabies in Western Australia. Journal of Comparative Physiology B 171: 23-32
- Bradshaw, S.D., Morris, K.D., Dickman, C.R., Withers, P.C. & Murphey, D. 1994. Field metabolism and turnover in the golden bandicoot (Isoodon auratus) and other small mammals from Barrow Island, Western Australia. Australian Journal of Zoology 42: 29-41
- Braithwaite, L.W., Binns, D.L. & Nowlan, R.D. 1988. The distribution of arboreal marsupials in relation to eucalypt forest types in the Eden (NSW) Woodchip Concession Area. Australian Wildlife Research 15: 363-373
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1974. Behavioural changes associated with the population cycle of Antechinus stuartii (Marsupialia). Australian Journal of Zoology 22: 45-62
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1980. The ecology of Rattus lutreolus II. Reproductive tactics. Australian Wildlife Research 7: 53-62
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1980. The ecology of Rattus lutreolus III. The rise and fall of a commensal population. Australian Wildlife Research 7: 199-215
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1982. Small marginal groups of Rattus lutreolus in good and poor habitat. Journal of Zoology, London 198: 529-532
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1989. Shelter selection by a small mammal community in the wet-dry tropics of Australia. Australian Mammalogy 12: 55-59
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1995. Brown Antechinus Antechinus stuartii. pp. 94-97 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Braithwaite, R.W. 1995. Southern Brown Bandicoot Isoodon obesulus. pp. 176-177 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Baverstock, P.R. 1995. Pale Field-rat Rattus tunneyi. pp. 662-664 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Begg, R.J. 1995. Northern Quoll Dasyurus hallucatus. pp. 65-66 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Brady, P. 1993. The delicate mouse, Pseudomys delicatulus: a continuous breeder waiting for the good times. Australian Mammalogy 16: 93-96
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Covacevich, J. 1995. Delicate Mouse Pseudomys delicatulus. pp. 592-593 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Griffiths, A.D. 1994. Demographic variation and range contraction in the northern quoll, Dasyurus hallucatus (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Wildlife Research 21: 203-217
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Griffiths, A.D. 1996. The paradox of Rattus tunneyi: the endangerment of a native pest. Wildlife Research 23: 1-22
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Lee, A.K. 1979. The ecology of Rattus lutreolus I. A Victorian heathland population. Australian Wildlife Research 6: 173-189
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Lonsdale, W.M. 1987. The rarity of Sminthopsis virginiae (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae) in relation to natural and unnatural habitats. Conservation Biology 1: 341-343
- Braithwaite, R.W. & Muller, W.J. 1997. Rainfall, groundwater and refuges: predicting extinctions of Australian tropical mammal species. Australian Journal of Ecology 22: 57-67
- Brandle, R. & Moseby, K.E. 1999. Comparative ecology of two populations of Pseudomys australis in northern South Australia. Wildlife Research 26: 541-564
- Brandle, R., Moseby, K.E. & Adams, M. 1999. The distribution, habitat requirements and conservation status of the plains rat, Pseudomys australis (Rodentia: Muridae). Wildlife Research 26: 463-477
- Brandt, J.F. 1836. [Title not located]. Icon. Anim. ross. nov. Aves (Fasc. 1): 5
- Brandt, J.F. 1841. [title]. Bulletin of the Imperial Academy of Sciences of St Petersburg 8(12)
- Brandt, J.F. 1845. Tchihatcheff's Voy. scient. Altai orient. Vol. 2.
- Brandt, S.B. 1981. Effects of a warm-core eddy on fish distribution in the Tasman Sea off east Australia. Marine Ecology Progress Series 6: 19-33 figs 1-7
- Brandt, S.B. 1983. Temporal and spatial patterns of lanternfish (family Myctophidae) communities associated with a warm-core eddy. Marine Biology, Berlin 74: 231-244 figs 1-8
- Brattstrom, B.H. 1970. Thermal acclimation in Australian amphibians. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 35: 69-103
- Brattstrom, B.H. 1971. Social and thermoregulatory behaviour of the bearded dragon, Amphibolurus barbatus. Copeia 1971: 484-497
- Brauer, A. 1901. Über einige von der Valdivia-Expedition gesammelten Tiefseefische und ihre Augen. Sitzungsberichte der Gesellschaft zur Beförderung der Gesamten Naturwissenschaften du Marburg 8: 115-130 figs 1-3
- Brauer, A. 1902. Diagnosen von neuen Tiefseefischen, welche von der Valdivia-Expedition gesammelt sind. Zoologischer Anzeiger 25(668): 277-298
- Brauer, A. 1904. Die Gattung Myctophum. Zoologischer Anzeiger 28(10): 377-404 figs 1-9
- Brauer, A. 1906. Die Tiefsee-Fische. 1. Systematischer Teil. Wissenschaftliche Ergebnisse der Deutschen Tiefsee-Expedition auf dem Dampfer "Valdivia" 1898–1899 15(1): 1-432 figs 1-176 pls 1-18
- Bravery, J.A. 1967. Field notes on the Oriental Cuckoo, Cuculus saturatus. The Emu 66: 267-271
- Bravery, J.A. 1971. Sight-record of Uniform Swiftlet at Atherton, Q. The Emu 71: 182
- Bravery, J.A. & Schodde, R. 1973. Sight-records of swiftlets. The Emu 73: 29-30
- Bray, D.J. 1983. Revision of the fish family Zeidae. Unpublished MSc Thesis, Macquarie University, Sydney. 160 pp. 27 figs
- Bray, D.J. 1994. Families Zeidae, Oreosomatidae. pp. 416-427 figs 373-381 in Gomon, M.F., Glover, C.J.M. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). The Fishes of Australia's South Coast. Adelaide : State Printer 992 pp. 810 figs.
- Bray, D.J. 2008. Family Lamprididae. pp. 297 in Gomon. M.F., Bray, D.J. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). Fishes of Australia's Southern Coast. Sydney : Reed New Holland 928 pp.
- Bray, D.J. 2008. Family Lophotidae. pp. 298 in Gomon. M.F., Bray, D.J. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). Fishes of Australia's Southern Coast. Sydney : Reed New Holland 928 pp.
- Bray, D.J. 2008. Family Regalecidae. pp. 200 in Gomon. M.F., Bray, D.J. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). Fishes of Australia's Southern Coast. Sydney : Reed New Holland 928 pp.
- Bray, D.J. 2008. Family Veliferidae. pp. 534 in Gomon. M.F., Bray, D.J. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). Fishes of Australia's Southern Coast. Sydney : Reed New Holland 928 pp.
- Bray, D.J. and Hoese, D.F. 2006. Sphyraenidae and Gempylidae. pp. 1748-1760 in Beesley, P.L. & Wells, A. (eds). Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Volume 35 Australia : ABRS & CSIRO Publishing Parts 1-3 2178 pp.
- Braysher, M.L. 1971. The structure and function of the nasal salt gland from the sleepy lizard Trachydosaurus (formerly Tiliqua) rugosus: family Scincidae. Physiological Zoology 44: 129-136
- Braysher, M.L. 1976. The excretion of hyperosmotic urine and other aspects of the electrolyte balance of the lizard Amphibolurus maculosus. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 54A: 341-345
- Brazenor, C.W. 1934. A new species of mouse, Pseudomys (Gyomys), and a record of the broad-toothed rat, Mastacomys, from Victoria. Memoirs of the National Museum of Victoria, Melbourne 8: 158-161 pl. 18 (in part)
- Brazenor, C.W. 1934. A revision of the Australian jerboa mice. Memoirs of the National Museum of Victoria, Melbourne 8: 74-89 pls 5-7
- Brazenor, C.W. 1936. Muridae recorded from Victoria. Memoirs of the National Museum of Victoria, Melbourne 10: 62-85 pls 13-16
- Brazenor, C.W. 1936. Two new rats from Central Australia. Memoirs of the National Museum of Victoria, Melbourne 9: 5-8 pl. 1
- Brazenor, C.W. 1951. On the Victorian species of tuberculate, Diplodactylus. Memoirs of the National Museum of Victoria, Melbourne 17: 215-222
- Breder, C.M. 1928. Scientific results of the second oceanographic expedition of the "Pawnee", 1926: Nematognathi, Apodes, Isospondyli, Synentognathi and Thoracostraci from Panama to Lower California. Bulletin of the Bingham Oceanographic Collection 2(2): 1-25 figs 1-10
- Breed, W. & Ford, F. 2007. Native Mice and Rats. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing 200 pp.
- Breed, W.B. 1992. Breeding systems of spinifex hopping mice (Notomys alexis) and plains rats (Pseudomys australis): a test for multiple paternity within the laboratory. Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 13-20
- Breed, W.B. 1992. Reproduction of the spinifex hopping mouse (Notomys alexis) in the natural environment. Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 57-71
- Breed, W.G. 1980. Further observations on spermatozoal morphology and male reproductive tract anatomy of Pseudomys and Notomys species (Mammalia: Rodentia). Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 104: 51-55
- Breed, W.G. 1981. Early embryonic development and ovarian activity during concurrent pregnancy and lactation in the hopping-mouse Notomys alexis. Australian Journal of Zoology 29: 589-604
- Breed, W.G. 1983. Sexual dimorphism in the Australian hopping mouse, Notomys alexis. Journal of Mammalogy 64: 536-539
- Breed, W.G. 1989. Comparative studies on the reproductive biology of three species of laboratory bred Australian conilurine rodents (Muridae: Hydromyinae). Journal of Zoology, London 217: 683-699
- Breed, W.G. 1990. Comparative studies on the timing of reproduction and foetal number in six species of Australian conilurine rodents (Muridae: Hydromyinae). Journal of Zoology (London) 221: 1-10
- Breed, W.G. 1990. Copulatory behaviour and coagulum formation in the female reproductive tract of the Australian hopping mouse, Notomys alexis. Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 88: 17-24
- Breed, W.G. 1990. Reproductive anatomy and sperm morphology of the long-tailed hopping mouse, Notomys longicaudatus (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Mammalogy 13: 201-204
- Breed, W.G. 1995. Sandy Inland Mouse Pseudomys hermannsburgensis. pp. 604-605 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Breed, W.G. 1995. Spinifex Hopping-mouse Notomys alexis. pp. 568-570 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Breed, W.G. 1997. Interspecific variation of testis size and epididymal sperm numbers in Australasian rodents with special reference to the genus Notomys. Australian Journal of Zoology 45: 651-669
- Breed, W.G. & Head, W. 1991. Conservation status of the plains rat Pseudomys australis (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Mammalogy 14: 125-128
- Breed, W.G. & Leigh, C.M. 1990. Morphological changes in the oocyte and its surrounding vestments during in vivo fertilization in the dasyurid marsupial Sminthopsis crassicaudata. Journal of Morphology 204: 177-196
- Breed, W.G. & Safaris, V. 1983. Variation in sperm head morphology in the Australian rodent Notomys alexis. Australian Journal of Zoology 31: 313-316
- Breed, W.G. & Washington, J.M. 1991. Mating behaviour and insemination in the hopping mouse (Notomys alexis). Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 93: 187-194
- Breed, W.G., Taggart, D.A., Bradtke, V., Leigh, C.M., Gameau, L. & Carroll, J. 1994. Effect of cryopreservation on development and ultrastructure of preimplantation embryos from the dasyurid marsupial Sminthopsis crassicaudata. Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 100: 429-438
- Breed, W.J. & Sarafis, V. 1979. On the phylogenetic significance of spermatozoal morphology and male reproductive tract anatomy in Australian rodents. Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 103: 127-135
- Brehm, C.L. 1830. Handbuch der Naturgeschichte aller Vögel Deutschlands, worin nach den sorgfältigsten Intersuchungen und den genauesten Beobachtungen mehr als 900 einheimische Vögel-Gattungen zur Begründung ihrer Naturgeschichte vollständig beschrieben sind. Ilmenau, Bernh. Friedr. : Voigt xxic 1085 pp. [for details on publication]
- Brehm, C.L. 1831. Handbuch der Naturgeschichte aller Vögel Deutschlands, worin nach den sorgfältigsten Untersuchungen und den genauesten Beobachtungen mehr als 900 einheimische Vögel-Gattungen zur Begrüngung einer ganz neuen Ansicht und Behandlung ihrer Naturgeschichte vollständig beschrieben sind. Ilmenau : Bernh. Friedh. Voigt xxiv 1085 pp.
- Brehm, C.L. 1845. Das Stiftungsfest der naturforschenden Gesellschaft Osterlandes in Altenburg, am 5 Julius 1843, und etwas die Voegel Griechenlands und Australiens. Isis 5: 323-358 [Date published May 1845]
- Brereton, J. Le G. 1963. Evolution within the Psittaciformes. Proceedings of the XIII International Ornithological Congress 1: 499-517
- Brereton, J. Le G. 1963. The life cycles of three Australian parrots: some comparative and population aspects. Living Bird 2: 21-29 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B]
- Brereton, J. Le G. & Immelmann, K. 1962. Head-scratching in the Psittaciformes. Ibis 104: 169-174
- Brereton, J. Le G. & Pidgeon, R. 1966. The language of the Eastern Rosella. Australian Natural History 15: 225-229
- Brereton, J. Le G. & Sourry, C. 1959. Some observations on the distribution and abundance of closely-related parrots of the New England district of New South Wales. The Emu 59: 93-100
- Bridge, G. 1979. The small-eyed snake (Cryptophis nigrescens). Victorian Herpetological Society Newsletter 13: 17-18
- Bridgewater, A.E. 1934. The food of Platycercus eximius and P. elegans. The Emu 33: 175-186
- Bridie, A., Hume, I.D. & Hill, D.M. 1994. Digestive-tract function and energy requirements of the rufous hare-wallaby, Lagorchestes hirsutus. Australian Journal of Zoology 42: 761-764
- Briggs, J.C. 1955. A monograph of the clingfishes (order Xenopterygii). Stanford Ichthyological Bulletin 6: 1-224 figs 1-114
- Briggs, J.C. 1969. A new species of Lepadichthys (Gobiesocidae) from the Seychelles, Indian Ocean. Copeia 1969(3): 464-466 fig. 1
- Briggs, J.C. 1974. Marine Zoogeography. New York : McGraw-Hill 475 pp.
- Briggs, J.C. 1976. A new genus and species of clingfish from the western Pacific. Copeia 1976(2): 339-341 figs 1-4
- Briggs, J.C. 1993. New genus and species of clingfish (Gobiesocidae) from southern Australia. Copeia 1993(1): 196-199 figs 1-2
- Briggs, SV. 1996. Native small mammals and reptiles in cropped and uncropped parts of lakebeds in semiarid Australia. Wildlife Research 23: 629-636
- Brigham, E.M., Francis, R.L. & Hamdorf, S. 1997. Microhabitat use by two species of Nyctophilus bats: a test of ecomorphology theory. Australian Journal of Zoology 45: 553-560
- Brigham, R.M. & Geiser, F. 1998. Seasonal activity patterns of two species of Nyctophilus bats based on mist net captures. Australian Mammalogy 20: 349-352
- Bright, M. 1999. The Private Life of Sharks. London : Robson Books 285 pp.
- Brind, W. L. 1918. A new subspecies of Thorichthys helleri. Aquatic Life 3: 119-120
- Brinklow, B.R. & Loudon, A.S.I. 1993. Evidence for a circannual rhythm of reproduction and prolactin secretion in a seasonally breeding macropodid marsupial, the Bennett's wallaby (Macropus rufogriseus rufogriseus). Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 98: 625-630
- Briscoe, D.A., Calaby, J.H., Close, R.L., Maynes, G.M., Murtagh, C.E. & Sharman, G.B. 1982. Isolation, introgression and genetic variation in rock-wallabies. pp. 73-87 in Groves, R.H. & Ride, W.D.L (eds). Species at Risk: Research in Australia. Proceedings of a symposium on the biology of rare and endangered species in Australia, sponsored by the Australian Academy of Science and held in Canberra, 25 and 26 November 1981. Canberra : Australian Academy of Science.
- Briscoe, D.A., Fox, B.J. & Ingleby, S. 1981. Genetic differentiation between Pseudomys pilligaensis and related Pseudomys (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Mammalogy 4: 89-92
- Brisout de Barneville, C.N.F. 1846. Note sur les diodoniens. Revue et Magasin de Zoologie (Paris) 9: 136-143
- Brisson, M.-J. 1760. Ornithologia sive Synopsis methodica sistens avium divisionem in ordines, sectiones, genera, species, ipsarumque varietates. Paris : J.-B. Bauche.
- Brisson, M.-J. 1760. Ornithologie ou méthode contenant la Division des oiseaux en Ordres, Sectiones, Genres, Espèces & leurs Variétés. Paris : J.-B. Bauche Vol. I xxiv 526 lxxiii pp. XXXVII pls.
- Brisson, M.-J. 1760. Ornithologie ou méthode contenant la Division des oiseaux en Ordres, Sectiones, Genres, Espèces & leurs Variétés. Paris : J.-B. Bauche Vol. IV 576 liv pp. XLVI pls.
- Brisson, M.-J. 1760. Ornithologie ou méthode contenant la Division des oiseaux en Ordres, Sectiones, Genres, Espèces & leurs Variétés. Paris : J.-B. Bauche Vol. V pp. 298-310.
- Brisson, M.J. 1762. Regnum Animale in classes ix. Distributum, sive synopsis methodica sistens generalem animalium distributionem in classes ix, & duarum primarum classium, quadrupedum scilicet & cetaceorum, particularem divisionem in ordines, sectiones, genera & species. Cum brevi cujusque specie descriptione, cicationibus auctorum de iis tractantium. Nominibus eis ab ipsis & nationibus impositis, nominibusque vulgaribus. Lugduni. Batavorum : Theodorum Haak 296 pp.
- Broad, A.J., Sutherland, S.K., Tanner, C. & Covacevich, J. 1979. Electrophoretic, enzyme, and preliminary toxicity studies of the venom of the small-scaled snake, Parademansia microlepidota (Serpentes: Elapidae), with additional data on its distribution. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 19: 319-329
- Brockie, R.E. 1982. Effect of commercial hunters on the number of possums, Trichosurus vulpecula, in the Orongorongo Valley, Wellington. New Zealand Journal of Ecology 5: 21-28
- Brockie, R.E., Herritty, P.J., Ward, G.D. & Fairweather, A.A.C. 1989. A population study of Hawkes Bay farmland possums, Trichosurus vulpecula. DSIR Ecology Division Report No. 26. 43 pp.
- Brockway, B.F. 1962. The effects of nest-entrance positions and male vocalizations on reproduction in Budgerigars. Living Bird 1: 93-101 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B [Appendix B]]
- Brockway, B.F. 1964. Ethological studies of the Budgerigar: non-reproductive behaviour. Behaviour 22: 193-222 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]
- Brockway, B.F. 1964. Ethological studies of the Budgerigar: reproductive behaviour. Behaviour 23: 294-324
- Brockway, B.F. 1964. Social influences on reproductive physiology and ethology of Budgerigars (Melopsittacus undulatus). Animal Behaviour 12: 493-501 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B]
- Brockway, B.F. 1965. Stimulation of ovarian development and egg laying by male courtship vocalisation in Budgerigars (Melopsittacus undulatus). Animal Behaviour 13: 575-578 [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]
- Brockway, B.F. 1968. Influences of sex hormones on the loud and soft warbles of male Budgerigars. Animal Behaviour 16: 5-12
- Brongersma, L.D. 1934. Contributions to Indo-Australian herpetology. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 17: 161-251
- Brongersma, L.D. 1936. Herpetological note. XIII. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 19: 136
- Brongersma, L.D. 1948. A new subspecies of Natrix mairii (Gray) from Dutch New Guinea. Proceedings of the Koninklijke Nederlandse Akademie Wetenschappen 51: 372-381
- Brongersma, L.D. 1956. Notes on New Guinea reptiles and amphibians. IV. Proceedings of the Koninklijke Nederlandse Akademie Wetenschappen 59C: 447-453
- Brongersma, L.D. 1956. Notes on New Guinean reptiles and amphibians. V. Proceedings of the Koninklijke Nederlandse Akademie Wetenschappen 59C: 599-610
- Brongersma, L.D. 1961. Notes upon some sea turtles. Zoologische Verhandelingen (Leiden) 51: 1-46
- Brongersma, L.D. & Knaap-van Meeuwen, M.S. 1964. On a new species of Denisonia (Reptilia, Serpentes) from New Guinea. Zoologische Mededelingen (Leiden) 39: 550-554
- Brongniart, A. 1800. Essai d'une classification naturelle des Reptiles. Bulletin de la Société Philomathique de Paris 2: 89-91
- Brongniart, A. 1805. Essai d'une classification naturelle des Reptiles. Mémoires de l’Académie des Sciences, St. Petersburg, Mémoires des Savans Étrangers 1: 587-637 [publication date established from Wermuth, H. & Mertens, R. 1977. Liste der rezenten Amphibien und Reptilien; Testudines, Crocodylia, Rhynchocephalia. Das Tierreich 100: i–xxvii, 1–174 but Smith, H.M. & Smith, R.B. 1979. Synopsis of the Herpetofauna of Mexico. Vol. 6. Guide to Mexican Turtles. Bibliographic Addendum 3. North Bennington, Vermont : John Johnson 1044 pp. cite 1806 as publication date]
- Brook, B.W., Griffiths, A.D. & Puckey, H.L. 2002. Modelling strategies for the management of the critically endangered Carpentarian rock-rat (Zyzomys palatalis) of northern Australia. Journal of Environmental Management 65: 355-368
- Brooke, R.K. 1970. Taxonomic and evolutionary notes on the subfamilies, tribes, genera and subgenera of the swifts (Aves: Apodidae). Durban Museum Novitates 9: 13-24
- Brooke, R.K. 1971. Geographical variation in the Little Swift Apus affinis (Aves: Apodidae). Durban Museum Novitates 9: 93-103
- Brooke, R.K. 1972. Generic limits in old world Apodidae and Hirundinidae. Bulletin of the British Ornithologists' Club 92: 53-57
- Brooker, B.M., O'Shea, J.E. & Stewart, T. 1995. Renal vasculature of two dasyurid marsupials, Sminthopsis dolichura and S. crassicaudata. Australian Journal of Zoology 43: 259-270
- Brooker, L.C., Brooker, M.G. & Brooker, A.M.H. 1990. An alternative population-genetics model for the evolution of egg mimesis and egg crypsis in cuckoos. Journal of Theoretical Biology 146: 123-143
- Brooker, M. 1973. Port Lincoln Parrots feeding on moth larvae. The Emu 73: 27-28
- Brooker, M. & Brooker, L. 1986. Identification and development of the nestling cuckoos, Chrysococcyx basalis and C. lucidus plagosus, in Western Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 197-202 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp. (cf. Zimmer, J.T. 1926. Catalogue of the Edward E. Ayer Ornithological Library. Field Museum of Natural History Publications, Zoological Series 16: 1–364 (Pt 1, Publ. 239), 365–706 (Pt 2, Publ. 240))]
- Brooker, M. & Estbergs, A.J. 1976. A survey of terrestrial vertebrates in the Carnarvon region, West Australia. Western Australian Naturalist 13: 160-170
- Brooker, M., Ridpath, M.G., Estbergs, A.J., Bywater, J., Hart, D.S. & Jones, M.S. 1979. Bird observations on the northwestern Nullabor Plain and neighbouring regions, 1967–1978. The Emu 79: 176-190
- Brooker, M.G. & Brooker, L.C. 1989. Cuckoo hosts in Australia. Australian Zoological Reviews 2: 1-67
- Brooker, M.G. & Brooker, L.C. 1989. The comparative breeding behaviour of two sympatric cuckoos, Horsfield's Bronze-Cuckoo Chrysococcyx basalis and the Shining Bronze-Cuckoo C. lucidus, in Western Australia: a new model for the evolution of egg morphology and host specificity in avian brood parasites. Ibis 131: 528-547 [Duncan, F.M. 1937. On the dates of publication of the Society's 'Proceedings', 1859–1926. With an appendix containing the dates of publication of 'Proceedings', 1830–1858, compiled by the late F.H. Waterhouse, and of the 'Transactions', 1833–1869, by the late Henry Peavot, originally published in P.Z.S. 1893, 1913. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 107: 71–84]
- Brooker, M.G., Brooker, L.C. & Rowley, I. 1988. Egg deposition by the bronze-cuckoos Chrysococcyx basalis and Ch. lucidus. The Emu 88: 107-109
- Brookes, J. 1830. A Descriptive and Historical Catalogue of the remainder of the Anatomical and Zoological Museum of Joshua Brookes, Esq., F.R.S. London : J. Brookes Pt II pp.
- Broom, R. 1896. On a small fossil marsupial with large grooved premolars. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 2 10: 563-567 [31 Jan.1896]
- Broom, R. 1896. On two new species of Ablepharus from north Queensland. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 6 18: 342-343
- Broom, R. 1898. On the lizards of the Chillagoe District, N. Queensland. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 22: 639-645
- Broome, L.S. 1995. Mountain Pygmy-possum Burramys parvus. pp. 208-210 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Broome, L.S. & Geiser, F. 1995. Hibernation in free-living mountain pygmy-possums, Burramys parvus (Marsupialia, Burramyidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 43: 373-379
- Broome, L.S. & Mansergh, I.M. 1989. The mountain pygmy possum Burramys parvus (Broom) an alpine endemic. pp. 241-264 in Good, R. (ed.). The scientific significance of the Australian Alps. Canberra : Australian Alps National Parks Liaison Committee.
- Brothers, N. & Pemberton, D. 1990. Status of Australian and New Zealand fur seals at Maatsuyker Island, southwestern Tasmania. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 563-569
- Brothers, N.P., Skira, I.S. & Copson, G.R. 1985. Biology of the feral cat, Felis catus (L.), on Macquarie Island. Australian Wildlife Research 12: 425-436
- Broughton, S.K. & Dickman, C.R. 1991. The effect of supplementary food on home range of the southern brown bandicoot, Isoodon obesulus (Marsupialia: Peramelidae). Australian Journal of Ecology 16: 71-78
- Broughton, W.C. & Sabath, M.D. 1980. The distribution records of the marine toad Bufo marinus. Part 1: Australia. Griffith University, Brisbane, A.E.S. Working Papers 2/80: 1-81
- Broussonet, P.M.A. 1782. Ichthyologia Sistens Piscium Descriptiones et Icones. London : Elmsly 42 pp. 11 pls.
- Brown, G. & Young, G. 1982. Wombats - amiable lawnmowers. Australian Natural History 20: 279-283
- Brown, G.D. & Taylor, L.S. 1984. Radio-telemetry transmitters for use in studies of thermoregulation of unrestrained common wombats, Vombatus ursinus. Australian Wildlife Research 11: 289-298
- Brown, G.W. & Triggs, B.E. 1990. Diets of wild canids and foxes in East Gippsland 1983-1987, using scat analysis. Australian Mammalogy 13: 209-213
- Brown, M. & Corkeron, P. 1995. Pod characteristics of migrating humpback whales (Megaptera novaeangliae) off the east Australian coast. Behaviour 132: 163-180
- Brown, M.R., Corkeron, P.J., Hale, P.T., Schultz, K.W. & Bryden, M.M. 1995. Evidence for a sex-segregated migration in the humpback whale (Megaptera novaeangliae). Proceedings of the Royal Society of London B 259: 229
- Brown, P. 1776. Nouvelles Illustrations de Zoologie, contenant cinquante planches enluminées d'Oiseaux curieux, et qui non etés jamais descrits, et quelques de Quadrupeds, de Reptiles et d'Insects, avec de courtes Descriptions systematiques. London : B. White 136 pp. 50 pls. [Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]
- Brown, P. 1977. The Green Rosella Platycercus caledonicus. Aviculture Magazine 83: 142-145
- Brown, P.B. 1979. The status of parrot species in western Tasmania. Tasmanian Bird Report 9: 4-12
- Brown, P.B. & Wilson, R.I. 1980. A survey of the Orange-bellied Parrot Neophema chrysogaster in Tasmania, Victoria & South Australia. A Report for World Wildlife Fund (Australia). Hobart : National Parks and Wildlife Service Tasmania 65 pp.
- Brown, P.R. & Seebeck, J.H. 1982. 8. The Eastern Barred Bandicoot (Perameles gunnii) - a vanishing Victorian. 207 in Groves, R.H. & Ride, W.D.L (eds). Species at Risk: Research in Australia. Proceedings of a symposium on the biology of rare and endangered species in Australia, sponsored by the Australian Academy of Science and held in Canberra, 25 and 26 November 1981. Canberra : Australian Academy of Science.
- Brown, P.R., Davies, M.J., Croft, J.D. & Singleton, G.R. 2004. Can farm-management practices reduce the impact of house mouse populations on crops in an irrigated farming system? Wildlife Research 31: 597-604
- Brown, P.R., Singleton, G.R., Kearns, B. & Griffiths, J. 1997. Evaluation and cost effectiveness of strychnine for control of populations of wild house mice (Mus domesticus) in Victoria. Wildlife Research 24: 159-172
- Brown, W.C. 1954. Notes on several lizards of the genus Emoia, with descriptions of new species from the Solomon Islands. Fieldiana Zoology 34: 263-276
- Brown, W.C. 1991. The lizards of the genus Emoia (Scincidae) with observations on their evolution and biogeography. Memoirs of the California Academy of Sciences No. 15: i-vi 1-94
- Brown, W.C. & Parker, F. 1973. A new species of Cyrtodactylus (Gekkonidae) from New Guinea with a key to species from the island. Breviora 417: 1-7
- Brown, W.C. & Parker, F. 1977. Lizards of the genus Lepidodactylusus (Gekkonidae) from the Indo-Australian Archipelago and the islands of the Pacific, with descriptions of new species. Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 4 41: 253-265
- Brownell, R.L. 1975. Phocoena dioptrica. Mammalian Species 66: 1-3
- Brownell, R.L. Jr & Cipriano, F. 1999. Dusky dolphin, Lagenorhynchus obscurus. pp. 85-104 in Ridgway, S.H. & Harrison, R.J. (eds). Handbook of Marine Mammals. Volume 6. The second book of dolphins and the porpoises. London : Academic Press.
- Brownell, R.L., Heyning, J.E. & Perrin, W.F. 1989. A porpoise Austalophoecoena dioptrica previously identified as Phocoena spinipinnis from Heard Island. Marine Mammal Science 5: 193-195 [publication date established from Duncan, F.M. 1937. On the dates of publication of the Society's 'Proceedings', 1859–1926. With an appendix containing the dates of publication of 'Proceedings', 1830–1858, compiled by the late F.H. Waterhouse, and of the 'Transactions', 1853–1869, by the late Henry Peavot, originally published in P.Z.S. 1893, 1913. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 107: 71–84]
- Bruce, B.D., Green, M.A. & Last, P.R. 1999. Aspects of the biology of the endangered spotted handfish, Brachionichthys hirsutus (Lophiiformes: Brachionichthyidae) off southern Australia. pp. 369-380 in Séret B. & Sire, J.-Y. (eds). Proceedings of the 5th Indo-Pacific Fish Conference, Nouméa, 3-8 November 1997. Paris : Société Française d'Ichtyologie 888 pp.
- Bruce, M.D. 1976. Earliest record of the Torres Strait Pigeon Ducula spilorrhoa from Lord Howe Island, with comments on the subspecies melvillensis. Bulletin of the British Ornithologists' Club 96: 97-99
- Bruce, M.D. 1989. A reappraisal of species limits in the Pied Imperial Pigeon Ducula bicolor (Scopoli, 1786) superspecies. Rivista Italiana Ornitologia, Milano 59: 217-222
- Bruch, C.F. 1853. Monographische uebersicht der Gattung Larus Lin. Journal of Ornithology 2: 96-108
- Bruch, C.F. 1855. [Title unknown]. Journal of Ornithology
- Brunner, H. & Coman, B. 1974. The Identification of Mammalian Hair. Melbourne : Inkata Press ix 176 pp.
- Brunner, H., Stevens, P.L. & Backholer, J.R. 1981. Introduced mammals in Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 98: 5-17
- Brunner, S. 1998. Cranial morphometrics of the southern fur seals Arctocephalus forsteri and A. pusillus (Carnivora: Otariidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 46: 67-108
- Brunner, S. 1998. Skull development and growth in the southern fur seals Arctocephalus forsteri and A. pusillus doriferus (Carnivora; Otariidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 46: 43-66
- Brush, A.H. & Witt, H.H. 1983. Intraordinal relationships of the Pelecaniformes and Cuculiformes: electrophoresis of feather keratins. Ibis 125: 181-199
- Bruun, A.F. 1934. Notes on the Linnean type-specimens of flying fishes (Exocoetidae). Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 39(263): 133-135
- Bryan, W.A. & Herre, A.W.C.T. 1903. Annotated list of the Marcus Island Fishes. Occasional Papers of the Bernice P. Bishop Museum 2(1): 126-139
- Bryant, S.L. 1986. Seasonal variation of plasma testosterone in a wild population of male eastern quoll, Dasyurus viverrinus (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae), from Tasmania. General and Comparative Endocrinology 64: 75-79
- Bryant, S.L. 1989. Growth, development and breeding pattern of the long-nosed potoroo, Potorous tridactylus (Kerr, 1792) in Tasmania. pp. 449-456 in Grigg, G., Jarman, P. & Hume, I. (eds). Kangaroos, Wallabies and Rat-Kangaroos. Sydney : Australian Mammal Society and Surrey Beatty 835 pp.
- Bryant, S.L. & Rose, R.W. 1986. Growth and role of the corpus luteum throughout delayed gestation in the potoroo, Potorous tridactylus. Journal of Reproduction and Fertility 76: 409-414
- Bryden M.M., Dawbin, W.H., Heinsohn, G.E. & Brown, D.H. 1977. Melon-headed whale, Peponocephala electra, on the east coast of Australia. Journal of Mammalogy 58: 180-187
- Bryden, M., Marsh, H. & Shaughnessy, P. 1998. Dugong, Whales, Dolphins and Seals: A Guide to Sea Mammals of Australasia. Sydney : Allen & Unwin.
- Bryden, M.M. 1976. Observations on a pygmy killer whale, Feresa attenuata, stranded on the east coast of Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 3: 21-28
- Bryden, M.M. 1978. Whales and whaling in Queensland waters. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Queensland 89: v-xviii
- Bryden, M.M. 1988. Southern elephant seals as subjects for physiological research. Papers and Proceedings of the Royal Society of Tasmania 122: 153-157
- Bryden, M.M. 1989. Delphinidae. pp. 970-978 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1B 827 pp.
- Bryden, M.M. 1989. Phocoenidae. pp. 979-981 in Walton, D.W. & Richardson, B.J. (eds). Fauna of Australia. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1B 827 pp.
- Bryden, M.M. 1995. Southern Elephant Seal Mirounga leonina. pp. 686-688 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Bryden, M.M., Harrison, R.J. & Lear, R.J. 1978. Some aspects of the biology of Peponocephala electra (Cetacea: Delphinidae) 1. General and reproductive biology. Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 28: 703-715
- Bryden, M.M., Kirkwood, G.P. & Slade, R.W. 1990. Humpback whales, Area V. An increase in numbers off Australia's east coast. pp. 271-277 in Kerry, K.R. & Hempel, G. (eds). Antarctic Ecosystems. Ecological change and conservation. Berlin : Springer Verlag.
- Brünnich, M.T. 1788. Om en ny fiskeart, den draabeplettede pladefisk, fanget ved Helsingoer i Nordsoen 1786. Kongelige Danske Videnskabernes. Selskabs Skrifter. Kjøbenhavn ns 3: 398-406 fig. A
- Bubela, T., Bartell, R. & Muller, W. 1998. Factors affecting thetrappability of red foxes in Kosciusko National Park. Wildlife Research 25: 199-208
- Bubela, T.M. & Happold, D.C.D. 1993. The social organisation and mating system of an Australian subalpine rodent, the broad-toothed rat, Mastacomys fuscus Thomas. Wildlife Research 20: 405-417
- Bubela, T.M., Dickman, C.R. & Newsome, A.E. 1998. Diet and winter foraging behaviour of the red fox (Vulpes vulpes) in alpine and subalpine New South Wales. Australian Mammalogy 20: 321-330
- Bubela, T.M., Happold, D.C.D. & Broome, L.S. 1991. Home range and activity of the broad-toothed rat, Mastacomys fuscus, in subalpine heathland. Wildlife Research 18: 39-48
- Bueler, L.E. 1974. Wild Dogs of the World. London : Constable 274 pp.
- Buffon, G.L. 1783. Histoire Naturelle des Oiseaux. Paris : l'Imprimerie Royale Vol. VII xii 435 pp. 142 pls.
- Buffon, G.L. 1786. Histoire Naturelle des Oiseaux. Paris : l'Imprimerie Royale Vol. I–X. [published between 1770–1786]
- Bulinski, J., Goldney, D. & Bauer, J. 1997. The habitat utilisation and social behaviour of captive rock-wallabies: implications for management. Australian Mammalogy 19: 191-198
- Bull, C.M. 1979. A narrow hybrid zone between two Western Australian frog species. Ranidella insignifera and R. pseudinsignifera: the fitness of hybrids. Heredity 42: 381-389
- Bull, C.M. & Satrawaha, R. 1981. Dispersal and social organisation in Trachydosaurus rugosus. 24 in Banks, C.B. & Martin, A.A. (eds). Proceedings of the Melbourne Herpetological Symposium, 1980. Melbourne : Zoological Board of Victoria pp. 44-54.
- Bullen, R.D. & McKenzie, N.L. 2004. Bat flight-muscle mass: implications for foraging strategy. Australian Journal of Zoology 52: 605-622
- Buller, W. 1869. On some new species of New Zealand birds. Ibis 1869: 37-43
- Buller, W.L. 1882. Manual of the Birds of New Zealand. Wellington : Govt. Printer xii 107 pp. 38 pls.
- Buller, W.L. 1896. [title]. Transactions and Proceedings of the New Zealand Institute 28
- Buller, W.L. 1905. A history of the birds of New Zealand. Supplement. London : W.L. Buller Vol. i.
- Bullis, H.R. & Carpenter, J.S. 1966. Neoharriotta carri — a new species of Rhinochimaeridae from the southern Caribbean Sea. Copeia 1966(3): 443-450 figs 1-5
- Bunn, T.J. & Craig, T.J. 1989. Population cycles of Rattus exulans: population changes, diet, and food availability. New Zealand Journal of Ecology 16: 409-418
- Burbidge, A. 1985. The Regent Parrot. A report on the breeding distribution and habitat requirements along the Murray River in south-eastern Australia. Australian National Parks and Wildlife Service Report Series n. 4 xii 36 pp.
- Burbidge, A.A. 1981. The ecology of the western swamp tortoise Pseudemydura umbrina (Testudines: Chelidae). Australian Wildlife Research 8: 203-223
- Burbidge, A.A. 1995. Burrowing Bettong Bettongia lesueur. pp. 289-291 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Burbidge, A.A. 1995. Crescent Nailtail Wallaby Onychogalea lunata. pp. 359-360 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Burbidge, A.A. 1995. Scaly-tailed Possum Wyulda squamicaudata. pp. 276-277 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Burbidge, A.A. & Fuller, P.J. 1990. On the vernacular name of Petrogale burbidgei. Records of the Western Australian Museum 14: 645-646
- Burbidge, A.A. & Johnson, P.M. 1995. Spectacled Hare-wallaby Lagorchestes conspicillatus. pp. 313-315 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Burbidge, A.A. & McKenzie, N.L. 1976. A further record of Sminthopsis longicaudata (Marsupialia, Dasyuridae). Western Australian Naturalist 13: 144-145
- Burbidge, A.A., Johnson, K.A., Fuller, P.J. & Southgate, R. 1988. Aboriginal knowledge of the mammals of the central deserts of Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 15: 9-39
- Burbidge, A.A., McKenzie, N.L. & Fuller, P.J. 1995. Long-tailed Dunnart Sminthopsis longicaudata. pp. 146-147 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Burbidge, A.H., Rolfe, J.K., McKenzie, N.L. & Roberts, J.D. 2004. Biogeographic patterns in small ground-dwelling vertebrates of the Western Australian wheatbelt. Records of the Western Australian Museum, Supplement 67: 109-138
- Burger, W.L. & Natsuno, T. 1974. A new genus for the Arafura smooth sea snake and redefinitions of other sea snake genera. The Snake 6: 61-75
- Burgess, W.E. 1978. Butterflyfishes of the World. New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications Inc. 832 pp. figs.
- Burgess, W.E. 1989. An Atlas of Freshwater and Marine Catfishes — a preliminary survey of the Siluriformes. Neptune City, New Jersey : T.F.H. Publications 783 pp.
- Burgess, W.E. 1991. Two new genera of angelfishes, Family Pomacanthidae. Tropical Fish Hobbyist 1991(March): 68-70
- Burhanuddin, A.I. & Iwatsuki, Y. 2003. Trichiurus nickolensis, a new hairtail from Australia belonging to the Trichiurus russelli complex (Perciformes: Trichiuridae). Ichthyological Research 50: 270-275
- Burke, C.V. 1930. Revision of the fishes of the family Liparidae. Bulletin of the United States National Museum 150: 1-204 figs 1-110
- Burmeister, C.H.C. 1837. Handbuch der Naturgeschichte zum Gebrauch bei Vorlesungen. II. Zoologie. Berlin 858 pp.
- Burmeister, H. 1854. Systematische Uebersicht der Thiere Brasiliens, welche während einer Reise durch die Provinzen von Rio de Janeiro und Minas Geraës gesammelt oder beobachtet wurden. Erster theil, Säugethiere (Mammalia). Berlin : G. Reimer x 342 pp.
- Burmeister, H. 1867. Preliminary description of a new species of Finner Whale. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1867: 707-713
- Burmeister, H. 1871. Sobre Balaenoptera intermedia, B. patachonica y B. bonaerensis y sus caracteres distintivos. Boletin do Museu Público Buenos Aires 2: 11-14
- Burmeister, H.K. 1807. Handbuch der Naturgeschichte. Zum Gebrauch bei Vorlesungen entworfen von Herman Burmeister. Berlin : T.C.F. Enslin viii xxvi xxi 858 pp.
- Burnell, A.F., Burnell, S.R. & Tago, M. 1991. Observations on an apparent mating sequence in three southern right whales, Eubalaena australis (Cetacea: Balaenidae). Australian Mammalogy 14: 33-34
- Burnell, S.R. 2001. Aspects of the reproductive biology, movments and site fidelity of right whales off Australia. Journal of Cetacean Research and Management Special Issue 2: 89-102
- Burnell, S.R. & Bryden, M.M. 1997. Coastal residence periods and reproductive timing in southern right whales, Eubalaena australis. Journal of Zoology, London 241: 613-621
- Burnett, G.T. 1830. Illustrations of the Quadrupeda, or Quadrupeds; being the arrangement of the true four-footed beasts indicated in outline. Quarterly Journal of Science II 1829: 336-353
- Burnstock, G. & Wood, M. 1967. Innervation of the urinary bladder of the sleepy lizard (Trachysaurus rugosus). II. Physiology and pharmacology. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 20: 675-690
- Burrell, H. 1914. Owlet-nightjar nestlings. The Emu 13: 216-217
- Burrell, H. 1927. The Platypus its discovery, zoological position, form and characteristics, habits, life history, etc. Sydney : Angus & Robertson xiv 227 pp. 35 pls.
- Burridge, C.P. 2000. Molecular phylogeny of the Aplodactylidae (Perciformes: Cirrhitoidea), a group of Southern Hemisphere marine fishes. Journal of Natural History 34: 2173-2185
- Burridge, C.P. 2004. Cheilodactylus (Goniistius) francisi, a new species of Morwong (Perciformes: Cirrhitoidea) from the southwest Pacific. Records of the Australian Museum 56: 231-234
- Burton, C.L.K. 1991. Sighting analysis and photo-identification of humpback whales off Western Australia, 1989. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 30: 259-270
- Burton, E. 1838. Catalogue of the Collection of Mammals and Birds at Fort Pitt, Chatham. Chatham.
- Burton, H. 1986. A substantial decline in numbers of the southern elephant seal at Heard Island. Tasmanian Naturalist 86: 4-8
- Burton, H.R. 1985. Tagging studies of male southern elephant seals (Mirounga leonina) in the Vestfold Hills area, Antarctica, and some aspects of their behaviour. pp. 19-30 in Ling, J.K. & Bryden, M.M. (eds). Studies of sea mammals in south latitudes. Adelaide : South Australian Museum 132 pp.
- Burton, J.A. (ed.) 1973. Owls of the World. Their evolution, structure and ecology. London : Peter Lowe (Eurobook Ltd) 216 pp.
- Burton, M. 1934. Pisces section for 1933. Zoological Records 70: 1-63
- Burton, P.J.K. 1978. The basisphenoid notch of kingfishers. Bulletin of the British Ornithologists' Club 98: 68-74
- Burton, P.J.K. 1984. Anatomy and evolution of the feeding apparatus in the avian orders Coraciiformes and Piciformes. Bulletin of the British Museum (Natural History) Zoology 47: 331-443
- Burwell, C.J., Geiser, F., Barritt, M., May, K., & Pavey, C.R. 2005. Additional records of prey of the fat-tailed false antechinus Pseudantechinus macdonnellensis from central Australia. Australian Mammalogy 27: 227-229
- Busakhin, S.V. 1982. Systematics and distribution of the family Berycidae (Osteichthyes) in the world ocean. Voprosy Ikhtiologii 22(6): 904-921 figs 1-12 [in Russian, English translation J. Ichthyol. 22(6): 1–21]
- Bush, M. Graves, J.A.M., O'Brien, S.J. & Wilde, D.E. 1990. Dissociative anaesthesia in free ranging male koalas and selected marsupials in captivity. Australian Veterinary Journal 67: 449-451
- Bustard, H.R. 1964. Defensive behaviour shown by Australian geckos, genus Diplodactylus. Herpetologica 20: 198-200
- Bustard, H.R. 1964. Reproduction in the Australian rain forest skinks, Siaphos equalis and Sphenomorphus tryoni. Copeia 1964: 715-716
- Bustard, H.R. 1965. Observations on Australian geckos. Herpetologica 21: 294-302
- Bustard, H.R. 1965. The systematic status of the Australian geckos Gehyra variegata (Duméril and Bibron, 1836) and Gehyra australis Gray, 1845. Herpetologica 20: 259-272
- Bustard, H.R. 1966. The Oedura tryoni complex: east Australian rock dwelling geckos (Reptilia: Gekkonidae). Bulletin of the British Museum (Natural History) 14: 1-14
- Bustard, H.R. 1967. Activity cycle and thermoregulation in the Australian gecko Gehyra variegata. Copeia 1967: 753-758
- Bustard, H.R. 1967. Defensive display behaviour of the Australian gecko Nephrurus asper. Herpetologica 23: 126-129
- Bustard, H.R. 1967. The status of the gekkonid lizard name Oedurad ocellata Boulenger, 1885. Herpetologica 23: 312-313
- Bustard, H.R. 1968. Temperature dependent activity in the Australian gecko Diplodactylus vittatus. Copeia 1968: 606-612
- Bustard, H.R. 1968. The ecology of the Australian gecko Gehyra variegata, in northern New South Wales. Journal of Zoology, London 154: 113-138
- Bustard, H.R. 1968. The ecology of the Australian gecko Heteronotia binoei, in northern New South Wales. Journal of Zoology, London 156: 483-497
- Bustard, H.R. 1968. The reptiles of Merriwindi State Forest, Pilliga West, northern New South Wales. Herpetologica 24: 131-140
- Bustard, H.R. 1969. Oedura reticulata, a new velvet gecko from south-west Western Australia. Western Australian Naturalist 11: 82-86
- Bustard, H.R. 1969. Defensive display behaviour in the bandy-bandy Vermicella annulata (Serpentes: Elapidae). Herpetologica 25: 319-320
- Bustard, H.R. 1969. Population ecology of the gekkonid lizard (Gehyra variegata (Duméril and Bibron)) in exploited forests in northern New South Wales. Journal of Animal Ecology 38: 35-51
- Bustard, H.R. 1969. The ecology of the Australian geckoes Diplodactylusn williamsi and Gehyra australis in northern New South Wales. Proceedings of the Koninklijke Nederlandse Akademie Wetenschappen 72C: 451-477
- Bustard, H.R. 1970. Oedura marmorata: a complex of Australian geckos (Reptilia: Gekkonidae). Senckenbergiana Biologica 51: 21-40
- Bustard, H.R. 1970. A population study of the scincid lizard Egernia striolata in northern New South Wales. Proceedings of the Koninklijke Nederlandse Akademie Wetenschappen 73C: 186-213
- Bustard, H.R. 1970. Activity cycle of the tropical house gecko, Hemidactylus frenatus. Copeia 1970: 173-176
- Bustard, H.R. 1970. Australian Lizards. Sydney : Collins 162 pp.
- Bustard, H.R. 1970. The population ecology of the Australian gekkonid lizard Heteronotia binoei in an exploited forest. Journal of Zoology, London 162: 31-42
- Bustard, H.R. 1979. Defensive mechanisms and predation in gekkonids and lizards. British Journal of Herpetology 6: 9-11
- Bustard, H.R. & Greenham, P.M. 1969. Nesting behaviour of the green sea turtle on a Great Barrier Reef island. Herpetologica 25: 93-102
- Butler, J.L. 1979. The nomeid genus Cubiceps (Pisces) with a description of a new species. Bulletin of Marine Science 29(2): 226-241 figs 1-12
- Butler, W.H. 1975. Additions to the fauna of Barrow Island, W.A. Western Australian Naturalist 13: 78-80
- Butler, W.H. & Merrilees, D. 1971. Remains of Potorous platyops (Marsupialia, Macropodidae) and other mammals from Bremer Bay, Western Australia. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 54: 53-58
- Buturlin, S.A. 1934. Polnyi Opredelitel Ptits S.S.S.R. Leningrad : Moskva Vol. 1 255 pp.
- Böhlke, E.B. 1997. Gymnothorax robinsi (Anguilliformes, Muraenidae), a new dwarf moray with sexually dimorphic dentition from the Indo-Pacific. Bulletin of Marine Science 60(3): 648-655
- Böhlke, E.B. 2000. Notes on the identity of small, brown, unpatterned Indo-Pacific moray eels, with descriptions of three new species (Anguilliformes: Muraenidae). Pacific Science 54(4): 395-416
- Böhlke, E.B. & McCosker, J.E. 2001. The moray eels of Australia and New Zealand, with the description of two new species (Anguilliformes: Muraenidae). Records of the Australian Museum 53: 71-102 figs 1-10
- Böhlke, E.B. & Randall, J.E. 1999. Gymnothorax castlei, a new species of Indo-Pacific moray eel (Anguilliformes: Muraenidae). Bulletin of the Raffles Museum 47(2): 549-554
- Böhlke, E.B. & Randall, J.E. 2000. A review of the moray eels (Anguilliformes: Muraenidae) of the Hawaiian Islands, with descriptions of two new species. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 150: 203-278
- Böhlke, E.B. & Smith, D.G. 2002. Type catalogue of Indo-Pacific Muraenidae. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 152: 89-172
- Böhlke, E.B. (ed.) 1989. Fishes of the Western North Atlantic. Volume One: Orders Anguilliformes and Saccopharyngiformes. Volume Two: Leptocephali. Yale University : The Sears Foundation for Marine Research Part 9, 1055 pp.
- Böhlke, E.B., McCosker, J.E. & Böhlke, J.E. 1989. Family Muraenidae. 104-206 in Böhlke, E.B. (ed.). Orders Anguilliformes and Saccopharyngiformes. Fishes of the Western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1(9): 1-655
- Böhlke, E.B., McCosker, J.E. & Smith, D.G. 1999. Family Muraenidae. pp. 1643-1657 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Böhlke, J.E. 1956. A synopsis of the eels of the family Xenocongridae (including the Chlopsidae and Chilorhinidae). Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 108: 61-95 figs 1-8 pl. 1
- Böhlke, J.E. 1966. Order Lyomeri. In, Olsen, Y.H. (ed.) Fishes of the western North Atlantic. Mem. Sears Fndn Mar. Res. 1(5): 603–628 figs 219–220.
- Böhlke, J.E. & Mead, G.W. 1951. Physiculus jordani, a new gadoid fish from deep water off Japan. Stanford Ichthyological Bulletin 4(1): 27-29
- Böhlke, J.E. & Randall, J.R. 1981. Four new garden eels (Congridae, Heterocongrinae) from the Pacific and Indian Oceans. Bulletin of Marine Science 31(2): 366-382 figs 1-8
- Böhlke, J.E. & Smith, D.G. 1968. A new xenocongrid eel from the Bahamas, with notes on other species in the family. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 120(2): 25-43 figs 1-3
- Börner, A.-R. & Schüttler, B 1983. An Additional Note on the Australian Geckos of the Genus Gehyra. Miscellaneous Articles in Saurology 12: 1-6
- Börner, A.-R. & Schüttler, B. 1981. Über die australischen Skinke des Cryptoblepharus boutonii - Komplexes. Miscellaneous Articles in Saurology 8: 1-10
- Bühler, P. 1970. Schädelmorphologie und kiefermechanik der Caprimulgidae (Aves). Zeitschrift für Morphologie der Tiere 66: 337-399
- CAVS 2006. Census of Australian Vertebrate Species. Australian Biological Resources Study.
- CAVS Listing, this work
- Cabanac, H.P. & Hammel, H.T. 1971. Peripheral sensitivity and temperature regulation in Tiliqua scincoides. International Journal of Biometeorology 15: 239-243
- Cabanac, M., Hammel, T. & Hardy, J.D. 1967. Tiliqua scincoides: temperature-sensitive units in lizard brain. Science (Washington, D.C.) 158: 1050-1051
- Cabanis, J. 1847. Ornithologische Notizen. Archiv für Naturgeschichte 13
- Cabanis, J. & Heine, F. 1851. Museum Heineanum. Verzeichniss der ornithologischen Sammlung des Oberamtmann Ferdinand Heine auf Gut St. Burchard vor Halberstadt. Halberstadt : R. Frantz Vol. 1. [dated 1850]
- Cabanis, J. & Heine, F. 1860. Museum Heineanum. Verzeichniss der ornithologischen Sammlung des Oberamtmann Ferdinand Heine auf Gut St. Burchard vor Halberstadt. Halberstadt : R. Frantz Part 2 175 pp. [publication dated 1859-1860 Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]
- Cabanis, J. & Heine, F. 1863. Museum Heineanum. Verzeichniss der ornithologischen Sammlung des Oberamtmann Ferdinand Heine auf Gut St. Burchard vor Halberstadt. Halberstadt : R. Frantz Part 4 (1) 229 pp. [publication dated as 1862–1863]
- Cabanis, J.L. 1850. Museum Heineanum / Verzeichniss der Ornithologischen Sammlung des ... F. Heine ; Systematisch bearbeitet von ... J. Cabanis (and F. Heine). Halberstadt Vol. 1.
- Cabanis, J.L. 1857. [Title] No. 24. Journal of Ornithology 4
- Cabrera, A. 1919. Genera Mammalium Monotremata Marsupialia. Madrid : Museo Nacional de Ciencias Naturales 179 pp.
- Cade, T.J. & Dybas, J.A. 1962. Water economy of the Budgerygah. Auk 79: 345-364
- Cadenat, J. 1963. Notes d'ichtyologie ouest-africaine. XXXIX. — Notes sur les requins de la famille des Carchariidae et formes apparentées de l'Atlantique ouest-africain (avec la description d'une espèce nouvelle: Pseudocarcharias pelagicus, classée dans un sous-genre nouveau). Bulletin de l'Institut Français d'Afrique Noire A 25(2): 526-543
- Cadow, G. 1933. Magen und darm der Fruchttauben. Journal of Ornithology 81: 236-252
- Cadwallader, P.L. & Backhouse, G.N. 1983. A Guide to the Freshwater Fish of Victoria. Melbourne : F.D. Atkinson Government Printer 249 pp. figs.
- Cadzow, B. & Carthew, S.M. 2004. The importance of two species of Banksia in the diet of the western pygmy-possum Cercartetus concinnus and the little pygmy-possum Cercartetus lepidus in South Australia. pp. 246-253 in Goldingay, R.L. & Jackson, S.M. (eds). The Biology of Australian Possums and Gliders. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons.
- Cahn, P. 1906. Eine neue Form des Roten Riesenkänguruh (Macropus occidentalis). Zoologischer Beobachter 47: 381
- Cahn, P. 1907. Zoologische Beobachter der Zoologische Garten. 48. pp. 3-4
- Cain, A.J. 1954. Subdivisions of the genus Ptilinopus (Aves: Columbae). Bulletin of the British Museum (Natural History) Zool. 2: 267-284
- Cain, A.J. 1955. A revision of Trichoglossus haematodus and of the Australian platycercine parrots. Ibis 97: 432-479
- Cairn, E.J. & Grant, R. 1890. Report of a collecting trip to north-eastern Queensland during April to September, 1889. Records of the Australian Museum 1: 27-31
- Cairns, S.C. & Grigg, G.C. 1993. Population dynamics of red kangaroos (Macropus rufus) in relation to rainfall in the South Australian pastoral zone. Journal of Applied Ecology 30: 444-458
- Cairns, S.C., Grigg, G.C., Beard, L.A., Pople, A.R. & Alexander, P. 2000. Western grey kangaroos, Macropus fuliginosus, in the South Australian pastoral zone: populations at the edge of their range. Wildlife Research 27: 309-318
- Cairns, S.C., Pople, A.R. & Grigg, G.C. 1991. Density, distributions and habitat associations of red kangaroos, Macropus rufus, and western grey kangaroos, M. fuliginosus in South Australian pastoral zone. Wildlife Research 18: 377-402
- Calabresi, E. 1915. Contributo alla conoscenza dei rettili della Somalia. Monitore Zoologico Italiano 26: 234-247
- Calaby, J. & Richardson, B.J. in Walton, D.W. (ed.) 1988. Zoological Catalogue of Australia Volume 5. Mammalia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service x 274 pp. [Date published 13-Apr-88]
- Calaby, J.H. 1954. Comments on Gilbert's note-book on marsupials. Western Australian Naturalist 4: 147-148
- Calaby, J.H. 1956. The food habits of the frog, Myobatrachus gouldii (Gray). Western Australian Naturalist 5: 93-96
- Calaby, J.H. 1958. Recent observations on the Naretha Parrot. Western Australian Naturalist 6: 153-154 [Mathews, G.M. 1927. Systema Avium Australasianarum. A systematic list of the birds of the Australasian region. London : British Ornithologists' Union Pt 1 iv 426 pp. (cf. Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.)]
- Calaby, J.H. 1960. Observations on the banded ant-eater Myrmecobius f. fasciatus Waterhouse (Marsupialia), with particular reference to its food habits. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 135: 183-207
- Calaby, J.H. 1995. Antilopine Wallaroo Macropus antilopinus. pp. 324-325 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Calaby, J.H. 1995. Black Wallaroo Macropus bernardus. pp. 326-327 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia. The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Calaby, J.H. 1995. Fawn Antechinus Antechinus bellus. pp. 85-86 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Calaby, J.H. 1995. Red-necked Wallaby Macropus rufogriseus. pp. 350-352 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Calaby, J.H. & Keith, K. 1974. Mammals. pp. 179–208 in Frith, H.J. & Calaby, J.H. (eds) Fauna survey of the Port Essington district, Cobourg Peninsula, Northern Territory of Australia. CSIRO Austustralia Division of Wildlife Research, Technical Papers No. 28. 208 pp.
- Calaby, J.H. & Taylor, J.M. 1974. Type locality of Rattus villosissimus. Australian Mammalogy 1: 267-268
- Calaby, J.H. & Taylor, J.M. 1981. Reproduction in two marsupial-mice, Antechinus bellus and Antechinus bilarni (Dasyuridae), of tropical Australia. Journal of Mammalogy 62: 329-341
- Calaby, J.H. & Taylor, J.M. 1983. Breeding in wild populations of the Australian rock rats, Zyzomys argurus and Z. woodwardi. Journal of Mammalogy 64: 610-616
- Calaby, J.H. & Wimbush, D.J. 1964. Observations on the broad-toothed rat Mastacomys fuscus Thomas. CSIRO Wildlife Research 9: 123-133
- Calaby, J.H., Corbett, L.K., Sharman, G.B. & Johnson, P.G. 1974. The chromosomes and systematic position of the marsupial mole, Notoryctes typhlops. Australian Journal of Biological Sciences 27: 529-532
- Calambokidis, J. & Steiger, G. 1997. Blue Whales. Stillwater, MN : Voyagueur Press.
- Caldwell, D.K. 1962. Sea turtles in Baja Californian waters (with special reference to those of the Gulf of California), and the description of a new subspecies of north-eastern Pacific green turtle. Los Angeles County Museum of Natural History Contributions in Science 61: 1-31
- Caldwell, D.K. 1962. Western Atlantic fishes of the family Priacanthidae. Copeia 1962(2): 417-424 figs 1-4
- Caldwell, H.S. 1977. The Water Buffalo. Rome : FAO/UN xvi 283 pp.
- Caley, P. 1993. Population dynamics of feral pigs (Sus scrofa) in a tropical riverine habitat complex. Wildlife Research 20: 625-636
- Caley, P. 1994. Factors affecting the success rate of traps for catching feral pigs in a tropical habitat. Wildlife Research 21: 287-292
- Caley, P. 1997. Movements, activity patterns and habitat use of feral pigs (Sus scrofa) in a tropical habitat. Wildlife Research 24: 77-88
- Caley, P., Spencer, N.J., Cloe, R.A. & Efford, M.G. 1998. The effect of manipulating population density on the probability of den sharing among common brushtail possums, and implications for transmission of bovine tuberculosis. Wildlife Research 25: 383-392
- Calford, M.B., Wise, L.Z. & Pettigrew, J.D. 1985. Audiogram of the grey-headed flying-fox, Pteropus poliocephalus (Megachiroptera: Pteropidae). Australian Mammalogy 8: 309-312
- Calhoun, J.B. 1963. The Ecology and Sociology of the Norway Rat. Public Health Service Publication No. 1008. Bethesda : U.S. Dept. Health, Education & Welfare viii 288 pp.
- Call, R.N. & Janssens, P.A. 1984. Hypertrophied adrenocortical tissue of the Australian brush-tailed possum (Trichosurus vulpecula): uniformity during reproduction. Journal of Endocrinology 101: 263-267
- Callaghan, D. & Harshman, J. 2005. Chapter 2. Taxonomy and systematics. 14-26 pp. in Kear, J. (ed.). Ducks, Geese and Swans. Oxford : Oxford University Press Edn 1, 908 pp.
- Callister, D.J. 1991. A review of the Tasmanian brushtail possum industry. Traffic Bulletin 161: 611-619
- Calver, M.C., King, D.R., Gardner, J.L. & Martin, G.R. 1991. Total food consumption of some native Australian small mammals in the laboratory. Australian Mammalogy 14: 139-141
- Calver, M.C., Saunders, D.A. & Porter, B.D. 1987. The diet of nesting Rainbow Bee-eaters, Merops ornatus, on Rottnest Island, Western Australia, and observations on a non-destructive method of diet analysis. Australian Wildlife Research 14: 541-550
- Cameron, A.C. 1968. Feeding habits of the Spine-tailed Swift. The Emu 68: 217-219
- Campbell, A. 1907. Mus musculus var. M. nudo-plicatus. The Zoologist 4 4: 1-3 pl. 1
- Campbell, A.G. 1906. Report on the birds of Kangaroo Island: a comparison with mainland forms. The Emu 5(3): 139-145 [Date published Jan 1906]
- Campbell, A.G. 1922. New sub-species of Tit-Warblers (Acanthizae). The Emu 22(1): 63-66 [Date published 1 Jul 1922]
- Campbell, A.G. 1925. Thornbills of the Genus Geobasileus. The Emu 25(2): 57-68 [Date published Oct 1925]
- Campbell, A.J. 1895. Notes on a new species of Arses or Flycatcher. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Victoria 2 7: 25-26 [Date published Jan 1895]
- Campbell, A.J. 1895. The Gymnorhinae or Australian Magpies, with a description of a New Species. Proceedings of the Royal Society of Victoria 2 7: 202-213 [Date published Jan 1895]
- Campbell, A.J. 1898. Notes on the Fan-tailed Cuckoo. Victorian Naturalist 14: 100-104
- Campbell, A.J. 1898. Notes on the Narrow-billed Bronze Cuckoo. Victorian Naturalist 14: 151-153 [Zimmer, J.T. 1926. Catalogue of the Edward E. Ayer Ornithological Library. Field Museum of Natural History Publications, Zoological Series 16: 1–364 (Pt 1, Publ. 239), 365–706 (Pt 2, Publ. 240)]
- Campbell, A.J. 1898. Notes on the Pallid Cuckoo. Victorian Naturalist 14: 58-62
- Campbell, A.J. 1898. Notes on the Square-tailed Cuckoo. Victorian Naturalist 15: 18-20
- Campbell, A.J. 1899. Descriptions of three new Australian birds. Victorian Naturalist 16(1): 3-4 [Date published May 1899]
- Campbell, A.J. 1899. Provisional description of a new Emu-Wren. Victorian Naturalist 15(9): 116 [Date published Jan 1899]
- Campbell, A.J. 1901. Description of a new Wren or Malurus. Victorian Naturalist 17(12): 203-204 [Date published 4 Apr 1901]
- Campbell, A.J. 1901. Nests and Eggs of Australian Birds including the geographical distribution of the species and popular observations thereon. Sheffield : A.J. Campbell Vol. 2 525-1102 pp.
- Campbell, A.J. 1901. Nests and Eggs of Australian Birds including the geographical distribution of the species and popular observations thereon. Sheffield : A.J. Campbell Vol. 1 xl + 1-548 pp.
- Campbell, A.J. 1901. On a new species of Blue Wren from King Island, Bass Strait. Ibis 8 1: 10-11 [Date published Jan 1901]
- Campbell, A.J. 1901. Stray feathers. The Emu 1: 25-26
- Campbell, A.J. 1902. Description of a new Microeca from Northern Australia. The Emu 2(2): 85 [Date published 1 Oct 1902]
- Campbell, A.J. 1902. Notes on certain Maluri, with a description of a new species. The Emu 1(2): 65-67 [Date published Jan 1902]
- Campbell, A.J. 1903. Description of a new Acanthiza. The Emu 2(4): 202-203 [Date published Apr 1903: Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B [publication dated as from preface, 12 June 1919 given in Appendix B] (Appendix B) Sherborn, C.D. & Woodward, B.B. 1901. Notes on the dates of publication of the natural history portions of some French voyages - Part 1. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 7 7: 388–392 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]]
- Campbell, A.J. 1904. Remarks on certain Melithrepti. The Emu 4: 70-71 [Date published 1 Oct 1904]
- Campbell, A.J. 1906. New fruit-pigeon. The Emu 5: 155
- Campbell, A.J. 1908. Description of a New Emu-Wren. The Emu 8: 34-35 [Date published 1 Jul 1908]
- Campbell, A.J. 1909. Annotations. The Emu 8: 142-148 [Date published 1 Jan 1909]
- Campbell, A.J. 1910. Exhibits — New Species. The Emu 10: 167-169 [Date published 1 Dec 1910]
- Campbell, A.J. 1910. Western Australian Birds. The Emu 9(3): 165-166 [Date published Jan 1910]
- Campbell, A.J. 1911. Annotations. The Emu 10: 337-339
- Campbell, A.J. 1912. Annotations. The Emu 11: 245-248 [Date published 1 Apr 1912]
- Campbell, A.J. 1912. New birds for Australia. Royal Australasian Ornithologists' Union Bulletin 3: 1-2 [Date published 21 May 1912]
- Campbell, A.J. 1912. Western Emu-Wren. The Emu 11(3): 222 [Date published 1 Jan 1912]
- Campbell, A.J. 1913. New Yellow Robin. The Emu 12: 191 [Date published 1 Jan 1913]
- Campbell, A.J. 1919. Notes on birds from the Gouldian-Gilbert Type-locality, North Australia. The Emu 18(3): 172-188 [Date published 1 Jan 1919]
- Campbell, A.J. 1922. Clinclosoma alisteri (Mathews) Black-throated Ground-Bird. The Emu 21(3): 161-162 [Date published 1 Jan 1922]
- Campbell, A.J. & Campbell, A.G. 1927. New species of Field-Wren. The Emu 27: 80 [Date published 1 Oct 1927]
- Campbell, A.J. & Campbell, A.G. 1928. Discovery of the Winiam Field-Wren (Calamanthus Winiam). The Emu 27(4): 223-224 [Date published 1 Apr 1928]
- Campbell, A.J. & Kershaw, J.A. 1913. Notes on a small collection of bird-skins from the Northern Territory. The Emu 12: 274-276 [Date published 1 Apr 1913]
- Campbell, A.J. & White, S.A. 1910. Birds identified on the Capricorn Group during expedition of R.A.O.U., 8th to 17th October, 1910. The Emu 10(3): 195-204 [Date published 1 Dec 1910]
- Campbell, A.J., Milligan, A.W., Legg, W.V., Mellor, J.W., Basset Hull, A.F. & Hall, R. 1913. Official Check-list of the Birds of Australia. The Emu 12(Suppl.): 1-116 [Date published Jan 1913]
- Campbell, C.H. 1966. The death adder. Effect of the bite and its treatment. Medical Journal of Australia 11: 922-925
- Campbell, S., Lumsden, L.F., Kirkwood, R. & Coulson, G. 2005. Day roost selection by female little forest bats (Vespadelus vulturnus) within remnant woodland on Phillip Island, Victoria. Wildlife Research 32: 183-191
- Campeau-Péloquin, A., Kirsch, J.A.W., Eldridge, M.D.B. & Lapointe, F-J. 2001. Phylogeny of the rock-wallabies, Petrogale (Marsupialia: Macropodidae) based on DNA/DNA hybridisation. Australian Journal of Zoology 49: 463-486
- Canestrini, G. 1869. Sopra alcuni pesci dell' Australia. Archivio per la Zoologia, l'Anatomia e la Fisiologia (Genova) 2 1: 151-155 pl.
- Canfield, P.J., Gee, D.R. & Wigney, D.I. 1989. Urinalysis in captive koalas. Australian Veterinary Journal 66: 376-377
- Canfield, P.M., O'Neill, M.E. & Smith, E.F. 1989. Haemotological and biochemical reference values for the koala (Phascolarctos cinereus). Australian Veterinary Journal 66: 324-326
- Cann, J. 1978. Tortoises of Australia. Sydney : Angus & Robertson 79 pp.
- Cann, J. 1997. Georges Short-necked Turtle: A new species of short-necked turtle from N.S.W. Monitor (Journal of the Victorian Herpetological Society) 9(1): 18-23
- Cann, J. 1997. Irwin's Turtle: A new species of short-necked turtle from Western Australia. Monitor (Journal of the Victorian Herpetological Society) 9(1): 36-40
- Cann, J. 1997. Kuchlings Long-necked Turtle: A new species of long-necked turtle from Western Australia. Monitor (Journal of the Victorian Herpetological Society) 9(1): 41-44
- Cann, J. 1997. The Northern Yellow-faced Turtle: A new species of short-necked turtle from the N.T. Australia. Monitor (Journal of the Victorian Herpetological Society) 9(1): 24-29, 34-35
- Cann, J. 1998. Australian Freshwater Turtles. Sydney & Singapore : John Cann & Beaumont Publishing 292 pp.
- Cann, J. 2008. Wild Australia Guide. Freshwater Turtles. Archerfield, Queensland : Steve Parish.
- Cann, J. & Legler, J.M. 1994. The Mary River Tortoise: A New Genus and Species of Short-necked Chelid from Queensland, Australia (Testudines: Pleurodira). Chelonian Conservation and Biology 1(2): 81-96
- Cannon, C.E. 1979. Observations on the food and energy requirements of Rainbow Lorikeets, Trichoglossus haematodus (Aves: Psittacidae). Australian Wildlife Research 6: 337-346
- Cannon, C.E. 1981. The diet of Eastern and Pale-headed Rosellas. The Emu 81: 101-110
- Cannon, C.E. 1983. Descriptions of foraging behaviour of Eastern and Pale-headed Rosellas. Bird Behaviour 4: 63-70
- Cannon, C.E. 1984. Flock size of feeding Eastern and Pale-headed Rosellas (Aves: Psittaciformes). Australian Wildlife Research 11: 349-355
- Cannon, C.E. 1984. Movements of lorikeets with an artificially supplemented diet. Australian Wildlife Research 11: 173-179
- Cannon, C.E. 1984. Rosellas, Platycercus spp., and their hybrids in the eastern Queensland - New South Wales border region. The Australian Zoologist 21: 175-183
- Cannon, C.E. 1984. The diet of lorikeets Trichoglossus spp. in the Queensland - New South Wales border region. The Emu 84: 16-22
- Cantor, T.E. 1842. General features of Chusan, with remarks on the flora and fauna of that island. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 1 9(53): 481-493
- Cantor, T.E. 1850. Catalogue of Malayan fishes. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal 18(2): 983-1443 pls 1-14 [dated 1849]
- Cantwell, G.E. 1964. A revision of the genus Parapercis, family Mugiloididae. Pacific Science 18(3): 239-280
- Capello, F. de B. 1868. Descripção de dois peixes novos provenientes dos mares de Portugal. Journal de Sciencias Mathematicas, Physicas e Naturaes, Lisboa 1(4): 314-317
- Cardinal, B.R. & Christidis, L. 2000. Mitochondrial DNA and morphology reveal three geographically distinct lineages of the large bentwing bat (Miniopterus schreibersii) in Australia. Australian Journal of Zoology 48: 1-19
- Carey, P.W. 1992. Agonistic behaviour in female New Zealand fur seals, Arctocephalus forsteri. Ethology 92: 70-80
- Carlsson, A. 1915. Zur Morphologie des Hypsiprymnodon moschatus. Kongliga Svenska Vetenskaps Academiens Nya Handlingar, Stockholm 52(6): 1-48
- Carmichael, D. 1818. Description of four species of fish found on the coast of Tristan da Cunha. Transactions of the Linnean Society of London 12(29): 500-513 pls 24-27
- Carnaby, I.C. 1948. Variation in the White-tailed Black Cockatoo. Western Australian Naturalist 1: 136-138 [For publication date Sclater, P.L. 1893. List of the dates of delivery of the sheets of the "Proceedings" of the Zoological Society of London, from the commencement in 1830 to 1859 inclusive. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 435–440]
- Carpenter, C.C., Badham, J.A. & Kimble, B. 1970. Behavior patterns of three species of Amphibolurus (Agamidae). Copeia 1970: 497-505
- Carpenter, C.C., Murphy, J.B. & Carpenter, G.C. 1978. Tail luring in the death adder, Acanthophis antarcticuster, (Reptilia, Serpentes, Elapidae). Journal of Herpetology 12: 574-577
- Carpenter, K. 1999. Family Acropomatidae. pp. 2436-2437 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 1987. Revision of the Indo-Pacific fish family Caesionidae (Lutjanoidea), with descriptions of five new species. Indo-Pacific Fishes 15: 1-56 figs 1-10 pls 1-7
- Carpenter, K.E. 1988. FAO Species Catalogue. Fusilier fishes of the World. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of caesionid species known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125, Vol. 8. Rome : FAO 75 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 1999. Family Ostracoberycidae. pp. 2551-2552 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 2001. Caesionidae. pp. 2919-2941 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 2001. Girellidae, Scorpididae, Microcanthidae. pp. 3297-3303 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 2001. Lobotidae. pp. 2942-2945 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. 2001. Sparidae, Lethrinidae. pp. 2990-3050 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Allen, G.R. 1989. FAO Species Catalogue. Emperor fishes and large-eye breams of the world (family Lethrinidae). An annotated and illustrated catalogue of lethrinid species known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis. No. 125, Vol. 9. Rome : FAO 118 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds) 1999. The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds) 2001. The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds) 1999. The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds) 2001. The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 5 2791-3379 pp.
- Carpenter, K.E. & Randall,J.E. 2003. Lethrinus ravus, a new species of emperor fish (Perciformes: Lethrinidae) from the western Pacific and eastern Indian Oceans. Zootaxa 240: 1-8
- Carr, S.G. &Robinson, A.C. 1997. The present status and distribution of the desert rat-kangaroo Caloprymnus campestris (Marsupialia: Potoroidae). South Australian Naturalist 72(1-2): 4-27
- Carrick, F.N. 1995. Platypus Ornithorhynchus anatinus. pp. 36-38 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Carron, P.L., Happold, D.C.D. & Bubela, T.M. 1990. Diet of two sympatric Australian subalpine rodents, Mastacomys fuscus and Rattus fuscipes. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 479-489
- Carruthers, R.K. 1975. Banding and observations of Rainbow Bee-eaters. Australian Bird Bander 13: 71-74
- Carstairs, J.L. 1974. The distribution of Rattus villosissimus (Waite) during plague and non-plague years. Australian Wildlife Research 1: 95-106
- Carstairs, J.L. 1976. Population dynamics and movements of Rattus villosissimus (Waite) during the 1966–69 plague at Brunette Downs, N.T. Australian Wildlife Research 3: 1-9
- Carstairs, J.L. 1979. The effect of captivity on fighting by Rattus villosissimus (Rodentia: Muridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 27: 537-545
- Carter, M. 2006. Canada Goose Branta canadensis: First Australian mainland occurence. Australian Field Ornithology 23: 15-19
- Carter, M.J. 1969. Dusk ascent of Fork-tailed Swifts. Australian Bird Watcher 3: 168-171
- Carter, T 1917. The birds of Dirk Hartog Island and Peron Peninsula, Shark Bay, Western Australia 1916–17. With Nomenclature and Remarks by Gregory M. Mathews, M.B.O.U. Ibis 10 5(4): 564-611 [Date published Oct 1917]
- Carter, T. 1908. Description of a supposed new Grass-Wren. Victorian Naturalist 25(5): 86-87 [Date published 10 Sep 1908]
- Carter, T. 1912. Notes on Licmetis pastinator (Western Long-billed Cockatoo). Ibis 9 6: 627-634
- Carter, T. 1916. Untitled. Bulletin of the British Ornithologists' Club 37: 6-7
- Carter, T. & Mathews, G.M. 1920. On a new species of Bower-bird. Ibis 11 2: 499 [Date published 9 Apr 1920]
- Carthew, S.M. 1994. Foraging behaviour of marsupial pollinators in a population of Banksia spinulosa. Oikos 69: 133-139
- Caruso, J.H. 1981. The systematics and distribution of the lophiid anglerfishes : 1. A revision of the genus Lophiodes with the description of two new species. Copeia 1981(3): 522-549 figs 1-21
- Caruso, J.H. 1983. The systematics and distribution of the lophiid anglerfishes : 2. Revisions of the genera Lophiomus and Lophius. Copeia 1983(1): 11-30 figs 1-8
- Caruso, J.H. 1985. The systematics and distribution of the lophiid anglerfishes: III. Intergeneric relationships. Copeia 1985(4): 870-875
- Caruso, J.H. 1989. A review of the Indo-Pacific members of the deep-water chaunacid anglerfish genus Bathychaunax, with the description of a new species from the eastern Indian Ocean (Pisces: Lophiiformes). Bulletin of Marine Science 45(3): 574-579
- Caruso, J.H. 1989. Systematics and distribution of Atlantic chaunacid anglerfishes (Pisces: Lophiiformes). Copeia 1989(1): 153-165
- Caruso, J.H. 1999. Family Chaunacidae. pp. 2020-2021 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Caruso, J.H. 1999. Family Lophiidae. pp. 2004-2012 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Caruso, J.H. & Bullis, H.R. 1976. A review of the lophiid angler fish genus Sladenia with description of a new species from the Caribbean Sea. Bulletin of Marine Science 26(1): 59-64 figs 1-2
- Carvalho, M.R. de 1996. Higher-level elasmobranch phylogeny, basal squaleans, and paraphyly. pp. 35-62 in Stiassny, M.L.J., Parenti, L.R. & Johnson, G.D. (eds). Interrelationships of Fishes. San Diego : Academic Press 496 pp.
- Carvalho, M.R. de 2008. New species of numbfishes from Australia, with a key to Australian electric rays of the genus Narcine Henle, 1834 (Chondrichthyes: Torpediniformes: Narcinidae). 241-260 in Last, P.R., White, W.T. & Pogonoski, J.J. (eds). Descriptions of new Australian chondrichthyans. CSIRO Marine and Atmospheric Research Paper No. 022: 1-358
- Carvalho, M.R. de & Séret, B. 2002. Narcine lasti, a new species of numbfish from western Australia and Indonesia (Chondrichthyes: Torpediniformes: Narcinidae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 20: 393-408
- Carvalho, M.R. de, Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Family Narcinidae. pp. 1433-1446 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Castelnau, F. 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 7. Fishes of New Caledonia. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 110-122
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1872. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 1. The Melbourne fish market. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 1: 29-242 1 pl.
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1872. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 2. Note on some South Australian fishes. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 1: 243-248
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 3. Supplement to the fishes of Victoria. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 37-58
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 4. Fishes of South Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 59-82
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 5. Notes on fishes from north Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 83-97
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 6. Notes on fishes from Knob Island. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 98-109
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 8. Fishes of Western Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 123-149
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Contribution to the ichthyology of Australia. 9. New sorts for the Victorian fauna. Proceedings of the Zoological and Acclimatisation Society of Victoria 2: 150-153
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1873. Intercolonial Exhibition Essays, 1872–3. No 5. Notes on the edible fishes of Victoria. pp. 1–17 in, London International Exhibition of 1873 : Official Record. Melbourne.
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1875. Researches on the fishes of Australia. Intercolonial Exhibition Essays. 2. pp. 1–52 in, Philadelphia Centennial Exhibition of 1876 : Official Record. Melbourne.
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1876. Mémoire sur les poissons appelés barramundi par les Aborigènes du nord-est de l'Australie. Journal de Zoologie (Gervais) 5: 129-136
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1878. Australian fishes, new or little known species. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1 2(3): 225-248 pls 1-2
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1878. Notes on the fishes of the Norman River. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1 3(1): 41-51
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1878. On some new Australian (chiefly) freshwater fishes. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1 3(2): 140-144
- Castelnau, F.L. de 1879. Essay on the ichthyology of Port Jackson. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1 3(4): 347-402
- Castelnau, Le Comte de & Ramsay, E.P. 1877. Notes of a Collection of Birds from the Norman River, Gulf of Carpentaria, with descriptions of some new species. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 1: 379-386 [Date published Mar 1877]
- Castle, P. & Smith, D. in Smith, D.G., Böhlke, J.E. & Castle, P.H.J. 1981. A revision of the nettastomatid eel genera Nettastoma and Nettenchelys (Pisces : Anguilliformes) with descriptions of six new species. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 94(2): 535-560 figs 1-12
- Castle, P.H.J. 1960. Two eels of the genus Pseudoxenomystax from New Zealand waters. Transactions of the Royal Society of New Zealand 88(3): 463-472 figs 1-2
- Castle, P.H.J. 1963. The systematics, development and distribution of two eels of the genus Gnathophis (Congridae) in Australasian waters. Zoological Publications of the Victoria University, Wellington (34): 15-47 figs 1-10
- Castle, P.H.J. 1964. Congrid leptocephali in Australasian waters with descriptions of Conger wilsoni (Bl. and Schn.) and C. verreauxi Kaup. Zoological Publications of the Victoria University, Wellington (37): 1-44 figs 1-10
- Castle, P.H.J. 1964. Deep-sea eels: family Synaphobranchidae. Galathea Report 7: 29-42 figs 1-2
- Castle, P.H.J. 1965. Leptocephali of the Nemichthyidae, Serrivomeridae, Synaphobranchidae and Nettastomatidae in Australasian waters. Transactions of the Royal Society of New Zealand, Zoology 5(11): 131-146 figs 1-2
- Castle, P.H.J. 1965. Moringuid leptocephali in Australasian waters. Transactions of the Royal Society of New Zealand, Zoology 7(7): 125-133 fig. 1
- Castle, P.H.J. 1965. Ophichthid leptocephali in Australasian waters. Transactions of the Royal Society of New Zealand, Zoology 7(6): 97-123 figs 1-3
- Castle, P.H.J. 1968. A contribution to a revision of the moringuid eels. Special Publication of the J.L.B. Smith Institute of Ichthyology Rhodes University 3: 1-29 figs 1-3
- Castle, P.H.J. 1968. Synaphobranch eels from the Southern Ocean. Deep-Sea Research 15: 393-396 fig. 1
- Castle, P.H.J. 1968. The congrid eels of the western Indian Ocean and the Red Sea. Ichthyological Bulletin of the J.L.B. Smith Institute, Grahamstown 33: 685-726 fig. 1 pls 105-108
- Castle, P.H.J. 1977. Results of the research cruises of the FRV Walther Herwig to South America. 50. A new genus and species of bobtail eel (Anguilliformes, Cyemidae) from the South Atlantic. Archiv für Fischerei Wissenschaft 28: 69-76 figs 1-9
- Castle, P.H.J. 1977. The congrid genus Fimbriceps, a synonym of Gnathophis. Copeia 1977(3): 581-582
- Castle, P.H.J. 1984. Notacanthiformes and Anguilliformes: development. 62-93 figs 29-43 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Castle, P.H.J. 1990. Two new species of the previously monotypic congrid eel genera Poeciloconger and Macrocephenchelys from eastern Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 42(2): 119-126 [dated 1988]
- Castle, P.H.J. 1991. Synaphobranch eels from the Southern Ocean. Deep-Sea Research 15: 393-396
- Castle, P.H.J. 1994. Families Serrivomeridae, Muraenidae, Nemichthyidae, Congridae. pp. 205-215 figs 182-191 in Gomon, M.F., Glover, C.J.M. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). The Fishes of Australia's South Coast. Adelaide : State Printer 992 pp. 810 figs.
- Castle, P.H.J. 1994. Families Synaphobranchidae, Nettastomatidae, Ophichthidae. pp. 195-203 figs 172-179 in Gomon, M.F., Glover, C.J.M. & Kuiter, R.H (eds). The Fishes of Australia's South Coast. Adelaide : State Printer 992 pp. 810 figs.
- Castle, P.H.J. 1995. Alcock's congrid eels from the "Investigator" collections in Indian seas 1888-1894. Copeia 1995(3): 706-718
- Castle, P.H.J. & Paxton, J.R. 1984. A new genus and species of luminescent eel (Pisces : Congridae) from the Arafura Sea, Northern Australia. Copeia 1984(1): 72-81 figs 1-6
- Castle, P.H.J. & Randall, J.E. 1999. Revision of Indo-Pacific garden eels (Congridae: Heterocongrinae), with descriptions of five new species. Indo-Pacific Fishes 30: 1-52 pls I-III
- Castle, P.H.J. & Robertson, D.A. 1974. Early life history of the congrid eels Gnathophis incognitus in New Zealand waters. New Zealand Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 8(1): 95-110 figs 1-7
- Castle, P.H.J. & Smith, D.G. 1999. A reassessment of the eels of the genus Bathycongrus in the Indo-west Pacific. Journal of Fish Biology 54(5): 973-995
- Castle, P.H.J. & Williamson, G.R. 1975. Systematics and distribution of eels of the Muraenesox group (Anguilliformes, Muraenesocidae). A preliminary report and key. Special Publication of the J.L.B. Smith Institute of Ichthyology Rhodes University 15: 1-9 figs 1-4
- Castle, P.J. & McCosker, J.E. 1999. A new genus and two new species of Myrophine worm-eels, with comments on Muraenichthys and Scolecenchelys (Anguilliformes: Ophichthidae). Records of the Australian Museum 51(2, 3): 113-122
- Catesby, M. 1771. The Natural History of Carolina, Florida and the Bahama Islands. (Revised by G. Edwards). To which is now added a Linnaean index of the animals and plants. London : B. White 100 pp.
- Catling, P.C. 1979. Seasonal variation in plasma testosterone and the testis in captive male dingoes, Canis familiaris dingo. Australian Journal of Zoology 27: 939-944
- Catling, P.C. 1986. Rattus lutreolus, colonizer of heathland after fire in the absence of Pseudomys species. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 127-139
- Catling, P.C. 1988. Similarities and contrasts in the diets of foxes, Vulpes vulpes, and cats, Felis catus, relative to fluctuating prey populations and drought. Australian Wildlife Research 15: 307-317
- Catling, P.C. & Burt, R.J. 1995. Why are red foxes absent from some eucalypt forests in eastern New South Wales? Wildlife Research 22: 535-546
- Catling, P.C., Corbett, L.K. & Newsome, A.E. 1992. Reproduction in captive and wild dingoes (Canis familiaris dingo) in temperate and arid environments of Australia. Wildlife Research 19: 195-209
- Catling, P.C., Corbett, L.K. & Westcott, M. 1991. Age determination in the dingo and crossbreeds. Wildlife Research 18: 75-83
- Catling, P.C., Green, B. & Newgrain, K. 1989. The water fluxes of Rattus fuscipes and Antechinus stuartii before and after a prescribed fire. Australian Wildlife Research 16: 685-687
- Cato, D.H. 1991. Songs of humpback whales: the Australian perspective. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 30: 277-290
- Caughley, G. & Grigg, G.C. 1982. Numbers and distribution of kangaroos in the Queensland pastoral zone. Australian Wildlife Research 9: 365-371
- Caughley, G., Brown, B. & Noble, J. 1985. Movement of kangaroos after a fire in mallee woodland. Australian Wildlife Research 12: 349-353
- Caughley, G., Brown, B., Dostine, P. & Grice, D. 1984. The grey kangaroo overlap zone. Australian Wildlife Research 11: 1-10
- Caughley, G., Shepherd, N. & Short, J. (eds) 1987. Kangaroos: Their ecology and management in the sheep rangelands of Australia. Cambridge : Cambridge University Press 253 pp.
- Caughley, J. 1986. Distribution and abundance of the mountain pygmy-possum, Burramys parvus Broom, in the Kosciusko National Park. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 507-516
- Caughley, J. 1986. Distribution and abundance of the pygmy-possum, Burramys parvus Broom, in Kosciusko National Park. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 507-516
- Cayley, N.W. 1926. A new Australian Finch. The Scaly-chested Finch, Donacola lepidothorax. The Emu 25(3): 133 [Date published 11 Feb 1926]
- Cayley, N.W. 1929. The status of certain species of the genus Ninox, and a description of two new species of that genus. The Emu 28: 161-164 [publication date Mathews, G.M. 1920. Dates of ornithological works. Austral Avian Records 4: 1–27 Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp.]
- Cayley, N.W. 1931. What Bird is That? A Guide to the Birds of Australia. Sydney : Angus & Robertson xix 315 pp. XXXVI pls.
- Census of Australian Vertebrate Species 2000. CAVS List. ABRS, ABIF Fauna.
- Chabanaud, P. 1917. Énumeration des Reptiles non encore ‚tudi‚s de l'Afrique occidentale, appartenant aux collections du Muséum, avec la description des espèces nouvelles. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 23: 83-105
- Chabanaud, P. 1929. Remarques sur divers poissons de la famille des Syngnathidae et description de deux espèces nouvelles de l'Inde Archipélagique. Bulletin de la Société Zoologique de France 54: 165-172 figs 1-5
- Chabanaud, P. 1930. Description d'un nouvel Aseraggodes (Pisces, Soleidae) du Queensland. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 10 5: 241-243
- Chabanaud, P. 1930. Les genres de Poissons Hétérosomates [Pisces, Heterostomata] appartenant à la sous-famille des Soleinae. Bulletin de l'Institut Océanographique Monaco 555: 1-21
- Chabanaud, P. 1931. Beschreibung eines neuen Achirus Lac. (Pisces Soleidae, Soleinae) von Nordaustralien. Zoologischer Anzeiger 93: 95-102
- Chabanaud, P. 1934. Les soléidés du groupe Zebrias, définition d'un sous-genre nouveau et description d'une sous-espèce nouvelle. Bulletin de la Société Zoologique de France 59: 420-436
- Chabanaud, P. 1943. Notules Ichthyologiques (Sixième series 20–22). Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 2 15: 289-293
- Chabanaud, P. 1948. Description de quatres espèces inédites du genre Symphurus. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 2 20(6): 508-511
- Chabanaud, P. 1950. Description d'un nouveau Soléidé originaire de la côte orientals du Queensland. Bulletin du Muséum National d'Histoire Naturelle. Paris 2e 22(5): 563-567
- Chabanaud, P. 1955. Revision des Symphurus du Siboga. Australian Fisheries 46(5): 43-45
- Chabot, D. 1994. Relationship between mass and body length in Australian fur seals. Marine Mammal Science 10: 250
- Chaffer, N. & Miller, G. 1946. The Turquoise Parrot near Sydney. The Emu 46: 161-167
- Chakraborty, A., Burhanuddin, A.I. & Iwatsuki, Y. 2005. A new species, Trichiurus australis (Perciformes: Trichiuridae) from Australia. Ichthyological Research 52(2): 165-170
- Chambers, L.K. & Dickman, C.R. 2002. Habitat selection of the long-nosed bandicoot, Perameles nasuta (Mammalia: Peramelidae), in a patchy urban environment. Austral Ecology 27: 334-342
- Chambers, L.K., Singleton, G.R. & van Wensveen, M. 1996. Spatial heterogeneity in wild populations of house mice (Mus domesticus) on the Darling Downs, south-eastern Queensland. Wildlife Research 23: 23-38
- Chan, W.L. 1966. Neocentropogon trimaculatus, a new scorpaenid fish from the South China Sea. Annals and Magazine of Natural History 13 8(95/96): 635-639
- Chan, W.L. 1966. A new genus and species of deep-sea brotulid from the South China Sea. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 14(1/3): 4-8 figs 1-2
- Chan, W.L. 1966. New sharks from South China Sea. Journal of Zoology, London 148: 218-237 figs 1-8 pls 1-3
- Chan, W.L. 1967. A new species of congrid eel from the South China Sea. Journal of Natural History 1: 97-112 figs 1-14
- Chan, W.L. 1970. A new genus and two new species of commercial snappers from Hong Kong. Hong Kong Fisheries Bulletin 1: 19-38
- Chan, W.L. & Chilvers, R.M. 1974. A revision of the Indo-Pacific spariform percoids of the Monotaxinae, with the description of a new genus Wattsia. Hong Kong Fisheries Bulletin 4: 85-95
- Chaparro, J.C., Pramuk, J.B. & Gluesenkamp, A.G. 2007. A new species of arboreal Rhinella (Anura: Bufonidae) from cloud forest of southeastern Peru. Herpetologica 63(2): 203-212
- Chapleau, F. 1988. Comparative osteology and intergeneric relationships of the tongue soles (Pisces; Pleuronectiformes; Cynoglossidae). Canadian Journal of Zoology 66: 1214-1232
- Chapleau, F. 1993. Pleuronectiform relationships: a cladistic reassessment. Bulletin of Marine Science 52(1): 516-540 figs 1-7
- Chapleau, F. & Keast, A. 1988. A phylogenetic reassessment of the monophyletic status of the Family Soleidae, with comments on the suborder Soleoidei (Pisces: Pleuronectiformes). Canadian Journal of Zoology 66: 2797-2810 figs 1-19
- Chapleau, F. & Renaud, C.B. 1993. Paraplagusia sinerama (Pleuronectiformes: Cynoglossidae), a new Indo-Pacific tongue sole with a revised key to species of the genus. Copeia 1993(3): 798-807 figs 1-2
- Chapleau, F. & Renaud, C.B. 1993. Paraplagusia sinerama (Pleuronectiformes: Cynoglossidae), a new Indo-Pacific tongue sole with a revised key to species of the genus. Copeia 1993(3): 798-807 figs 1-4
- Chapleau, F., Renaud, C.B. & Kailola, P.J. 1991. Paraplagusia longirostris, a new flatfish (Cynoglossidae) from Australia and Papua New Guinea. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 38(3): 239-244 figs 1-3
- Chapman, A. 1981. Habitat preference and reproduction of feral house mice, Mus musculus, during plague and non-plague situations in Western Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 8: 567-579
- Chapman, A. & Newbey, K.R. 1995. A vertebrate fauna survey and some notes on the vegetation of the Ravensthorpe Range, Western Australia. CALMScience 1: 465-508
- Chapman, D. & Chapman, N. 1975. Fallow Deer: their history, distribution and biology. Lavenham : Terence Dalton 271 pp.
- Chapman, D. & Chapman, N. 1997. Fallow Deer. Machynlleth, Powys : Coch-Y-Bonddu Books.
- Chapman, F.M. 1894. On the birds of the island of Trinidad. Auk 1(1): 1-86
- Chapman, N.G. & Chapman, D.I. 1980. The distribution of fallow deer: a worldwide review. Mammal Review 10: 61-138
- Chapman, W.M. & Schultz, L.P. 1952. Review of the fishes of the blennioid genus Ecsenius, with descriptions of five new species. Proceedings of the United States National Museum 102(3310): 507-528 figs 90-96
- Charles, N., Whitaker, P. & Shine, R. 1980. Oviparity and captive breeding in the spotted black snake, Pseudechis guttatus (Serpentes: Elapidae). The Australian Zoologist 20: 361-364
- Charlton-Robb, K., Gershwin, L., Thompson, R., Austin, J., Owen, K. & McKechnie, S. 2011. A new dolphin species, the Burrunan Dolphin Tursiops australis sp. nov., endemic to southern Australian coastal waters. 6(9): 1-17
- Chase, J. & Graydon, M.L. 1990. The eye of the northern brown bandicoot, Isoodon macroura. pp. 117-122 in Seebeck, J.H., Brown, P.R., Wallis, R.L. & Kemper, C.M. (eds). Bandicoots and Bilbies. Chipping Norton : Surrey Beatty & Sons 392 pp.
- Chasen, F.N. 1933. Notes on the Birds of Christmas Island, Indian Ocean. Bulletin of the Raffles Museum 8: 58-61
- Chaudhuri, B.L. 1910. Triacanthus weberi, sp. nov. Journal and Proceedings of the Asiatic Society of Bengal ns 6(9): 497-501 pl. 32
- Chauvet, M.T., Coline, T., Hurpet, D. Chauvet, J. & Acher, R. 1983. Marsupial neurohypophysial hormones: identification of mesotocin, lysine vasopressin, and phenypressin in the quokka wallaby. General and Comparative Endocrinology 51: 309-315
- Cheal, A.J. & Gales, N.J. 1991. Growth, sexual maturity and food intake of Australian Indian Ocean bottlenose dolphins, Tursiops truncatus, in captivity. Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 215-223
- Cheal, D.C. 1987. The diets and dietary preferences of Rattus fuscipes and Rattus lutreolus at Walkerville in Victoria. Australian Wildlife Research 14: 35-44
- Checklist Committee, Ornithological Society of New Zealand, Inc. 1990. Checklist of the Birds of New Zealand and the Ross Dependency, Antarctica. Auckland : Random Century xv 247 pp.
- Chen, I.-S. & Shao, K.-T. 1997. Fusigobius aureus, a new species of gobiid fish (Perciformes, Gobiidae) from Flores Island, Indonesia. Acta Zoologica Taiwanica 8(2): 87-92
- Chen, J.T.F. & Weng, H.T.C. 1965. A review of the flatfishes of Taiwan. Biological Bulletin. Tunghai University (Ichthyology) 25, 27(5): 1-103 figs 1-72
- Chen, J.T.F. & Weng, H.T.C. 1967. A review of the Apodal fishes of Taiwan. Biological Bulletin. Tunghai University (Ichthyology) 6 32: 1-86
- Chen, L.C. 1981. Scorpaenid fishes of Taiwan. Quarterly Journal of the Taiwan Museum 34(1/2): 1-60 figs 1-51
- Chen, X., Dickman, C.R. & Thompson, M.B. 1998. Diet of the mulgara, Dasycercus cristicauda (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae), in the Simpson Desert, central Australia. Wildlife Research 25: 233-242
- Chenu, J.C. & Des Murs, O. 1853. Oiseaux. Encyclopédie d'Historie Naturelle. Paris : Marescq & Compagnie.
- Chernova, N.V., Stein, D.L. & Andriashev, A.P. 2004. Family Liparidae Scopoli 1777 — snailfishes. Calif. Acad. Sci. Annotated Checklists of Fishes No. 31.. 1-72 pp.
- Chilcott, M. & Hume, I.D. 1984. Digestion of Eucalyptus andrewsii foliage by the common ringtail possum, Pseudocheirus peregrinus. Australian Journal of Zoology 32: 605-613
- Chilcott, M. & Hume, I.D. 1984. Nitrogen and ures metabolism and nitrogen requirements of the common ringtail possum Pseudocheirus peregrinus, fed Eucalyptus andrewsii foliage. Australian Journal of Zoology 32: 615-622
- Chilcott, M.J. 1984. Coprophagy in the common Ringtail Possum, Pseudocheirus peregrinus (Marsupialia: Petauridae). Australian Mammalogy 7: 107-110
- Chilcott, M.J. & Hume, I.D. 1985. Coprophagy and selective retention of fluid digesta: their role in the nutrition of the common ringtail possum, Pseudocheirus peregrinus. Australian Journal of Zoology 33: 1-15
- Chilcott, M.J., Moore, S.A. & Hume, I.D. 1985. Effects of water restriction on nitrogen metabolism and urea recycling in the macropodid marsupials Macropus eugenii (tammar wallaby) and Thylogale thetis (red-necked pademelon). Journal of Comparative Physiology B 155: 759-767
- Chilcott, S. J. & Humphries, P. 1996. Freshwater fish of northeast Tasmania with notes on the dwarf galaxias. Records of the Queen Victoria Museum, Launceston 103: 145-149
- Chimimba, C.T. & Kitchener, D.J. 1987. Breeding in the Australian Yellow-bellied Sheath-tailed Bat, Saccolaimus flaviventris (Peters, 1867) (Chiroptera: Emballonuridae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 13: 241-248
- Chimimba, C.T. & Kitchener, D.J. 1991. A systematic revision of Australian Emballonuridae (Mammalia: Chiroptera). Records of the Western Australian Museum 15: 203-265
- Chisholm, A.H. 1921. A new Menura: Prince Edward's Lyre-bird. The Emu 20: 221-223 [Date published 1 Apr 1921]
- Chisholm, A.H. 1922. The 'Lost' Paradise Parrot. The Emu 22: 4-17
- Chisholm, A.H. 1924. Seeking Rare Parrots. The Emu 24: 25-32
- Chisholm, A.H. 1932. The White-tailed Kingfisher. The Emu 32: 81-83 pl. 13
- Chisholm, A.H. 1945. Birds of the Gilbert diary, Part 2. The Emu 44: 183-200
- Chisolm, E.C. 1929. Further additional fauna of the Comboyne Plateau (Reptilia and Amphibia). The Australian Zoologist 5: 333-336
- Chittleborough, R.G. 1965. Dynamics of two populations of the Humpback Whale, Megaptera novaeangliae (Borowski). Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 16: 33-128
- Choat, J.H. & Randall, J.E. 1986. A review of the parrotfishes (Family Scaridae) of the Great Barrier Reef of Australia with description of a new species. Records of the Australian Museum 38: 175-228
- Chong, G., Heatwole, H. & Firth, B.T. 1973. Panting thresholds of lizards. II. Diel variation in the panting threshold of Amphibolurus muricatus. Comparative Biochemistry and Physiology 46A: 827-829
- Choquenet, D. 1991. Density-dependent growth, body condition and demography in feral donkeys: testing the food hypothesis. Ecology 72: 805-813
- Choquenet, D., McIlroy, J. & Korn, T. 1996. Managing Vertebrate Pests: Feral Pigs. Canberra : Bureau of Resource Sciences, Australian Government Publishing Service.
- Choquenot, D. 1993. Growth, body condition and demography of wild banteng (Bos javanicus) on Cobourg Peninsula, northern Australia. Journal of Zoology, London 231: 533-542
- Choquenot, D. 1995. Assessing visibility bias associated with helocopter counts of feral pigs in Australia's semi-arid rangelands. Wildlife Research 22: 569-578
- Choquenot, D. 1995. Donkey Equus asinus. pp. 712-713 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Choquenot, D. 1998. Testing the relative influence of intrinsic and extrinsic variation in food availability on feral pig populations in Australia's rangelands. Journal of Animal Ecology 67: 887-907
- Choquenot, D. & Saunders, G. 1993. A comparison of three aging techniques for feral pigs from subalpine and semi-arid habitats. Wildlife Research 20: 163-171
- Chrapliwy, P.S., Smith, H.M. & Grant, C. 1961. Systematic status of the geckonid lizard genera Gehyra, Peropus, Hoplodactyluss and Naultinus. Herpetologica 17: 5-12
- Christensen, P. 1971. The Purple-crowned Lorikeet and eucalypt pollination. Australian Forestry 35: 263-270
- Christensen, P. 1995. Brush-tailed Bettong Bettongia penicillata. pp. 292-293 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Christensen, P. 1995. Western Brush Wallaby Macropus irma. pp. 341-342 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Christensen, P. & Burrows, N. 1995. Project Desert dreaming: the reintroduction of mammals to the Gibson Desert. pp. 199-207 in Serena, M. (ed.). Reintroduction biology of Australian and New Zealand fauna. Chipping Norton : Surrey Beatty.
- Christensen, P., Maisey, K. & Perry, D.H. 1984. Radiotracking the numbat, Myrmecobius fasciatus, in the Perup Forest of Western Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 11: 275-288
- Christensen, P.E. & Kimber, P.C. 1975. Effect of prescribed burning on the flora and fauna of S.W. Australian forests. Proceedings of the Ecological Society of Australia 9: 85-106
- Christensen, P.E.S. 1980. The biology of Bettongia penicillata Gray, 1837, and Macropus eugenii (Desmarest, 1817) in relation to fire. Forests Dept. West. Aust. Bull. No. 91 . ix 90 pp.
- Christensen, P.E.S. & Leftwich, T. 1980. Observations on the nest-building behaviour of the brush-tailed rat-kangaroo or woylie (Bettongia penicillata). Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 63: 33-38
- Christensen, V. 1954. Dates of arrival of three bird species. The Emu 54: 72-73
- Christian, P.D., Christidis, L. & Schodde, R. 1992. [title]. Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 225-233
- Christian, T. 1977. Notes on centralian bluetongues (Tiliqua multifasciata). Victorian Herpetological Society Newsletter 1: 8-9
- Christian, T. 1979. Notes on Spencer's monitor (Varanus spenceri). Victorian Herpetological Society Newsletter 14: 13-14
- Christian, T. 1981. Varanus tristis a variable monitor. Herpetofauna 12: 7-12
- Christidis, L. 1990. Chordata 3B. Aves. Animal Cytogenetics 4. Berlin : Gebrüder Borntraeger 116 pp.
- Christidis, L. & Boles, W.E. 1994. The Taxonomy and Species of Birds of Australia and its Territories. Monograph 2. Melbourne : Royal Australasian Ornithologists Union iv 112 pp.
- Christidis, L. & Boles, W.E. 2008. Systematics and Taxonomy of Australian Birds. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing 288 pp.
- Christidis, L. & Schodde, R. 1991. Relationships of Australo-Papuan songbirds-protein evidence. Ibis 133: 277-285
- Christidis, L., Horton, P. & Norman, J.A. 2008. Subspeciation in the Short-tailed Grasswren (Amytornis merrotsyi, Maluridae). The Emu 108: 275-282
- Christidis, L., Schodde, R., Shaw, D.D. & Maynes, S.F. 1991. Relationships among the Australo-Papuan parrots, lorikeets, and cockatoos (Aves: Psittaciformes): protein evidence. Condor 93: 302-317
- Christidis, L., Shaw, D.D. & Schodde, R. 1991b. Chromosomal evolution in parrots, lorikeets and cockatoos (Aves: Psittaciformes). Hereditas (Lund) 114: 47-56
- Chruszcz, B. & Barclay, R.M.R. 2002. Chalinolobus gouldii. Mammalian Species 690: 1-4
- Chu, Y.-T & Hu, A.-S. in Chu, Y.-T., Meng, Q.-W., Hu, A.-S & Li, S. 1981. Description of four new species, a new genus and a new family of elasmobranchiate fishes from deep sea of the South China Sea. Oceanologia et Limnologia Sinica 12(2): 103-116
- Chu, Y.-T., Lo, Y.-L. & Wu, H.-L. 1963. A Study on the Classification of the Sciaenoid Fishes of China, with description of new genera and species. Shanghai : Sci. Tech. Press 100 pp. 40 pls. [in Chinese with English summary. Monographs of Fishes of China. Publ. Shanghai Fish. Inst.]
- Churchill, D.M. & Christensen, P. 1970. Observations on pollen harvesting by brush-tongued lorikeets. Australian Journal of Zoology 18: 427-437
- Churchill, G. 1971. Notes on water pythons (Liasis fuscus). Herpetofauna 3: 8
- Churchill, S. 1996. Distribution, habitat and status of the Carpentarian rock-rat, Zyzomys palatalis. Wildlife Research 23: 77-91
- Churchill, S. 1997. Habitat use, distribution and conservation status of the nabarlek, P. concinna, and sympatric rock-dwelling mammals, in the Northern Territory. Australian Mammalogy 19: 297-308
- Churchill, S. 1998. Australian Bats. Sydney : Reed Books.
- Churchill, S.K. 1991. Distribution, abundance and roost selection of the orange horseshoe-bat, Rhinonycteris aurantius, a tropical cave-dweller. Australian Wildlife Research 18: 343-353
- Churchill, S.K. 1995. Reproductive ecology of the orange horseshoe bat, Rhinonycteris aurantius (Hipposideridae : Chiroptera), a tropical cave dweller. Wildlife Research 22: 687-698
- Churchill, S.K. & Helman, P.M. 1990. Distribution of the ghost bat, Macroderma gigas (Chiroptera: Megadermatidae) in central South Australia. Australian Mammalogy 13: 149-157
- Churchill, S.K., Hall, L.S. & Helman, P.M. 1984. Observations on long-eared bats (Vespertilionidae: Nyctophilus) from northern Australia. Australian Mammalogy 7: 17-28
- Churchill, S.K., Helman, P.M. & Hall, L.S. 1988. Distribution, populations and status of the orange horseshoe bat, Rhinonicteris aurantius (Chiroptera: Hipposideridae). Australian Mammalogy 11: 27-33
- Clague, C.I., Coles, R.B., Whybird, O.J., Spencer, H.J. & Flemons, P. 1999. The occurrence and distribution of the tube-nosed insectivorous bat (Murina florium) in Australia. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 121: 175-191
- Clancey, P.A. 1940. Notes on some Birds from Scotland. Ibis 14 4(1): 91-99 [Date published 1Jan 1940]
- Clancy, G. 1980. Azure Kingfisher Display. Australian Birds 14: 56
- Clancy, G.P. 1977. Boobook Owls in the Sydney District. Australian Birds 12: 12-13 [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp. Waterhouse, F.H. 1885. The Dates of Publication of some of the Zoological Works of the late John Gould, F.R.S. London : R.H. Porter xi 59 pp. [Mathews, G.M. 1925. The Birds of Australia. Supplements 4 & 5. Bibliography of the Birds of Australia Pts 1 & 2. London : H.F. & G. Witherby viii 149 pp. Mathews, G.M. 1919. The Birds of Australia. London : Witherby & Co. Vol. 7 pt 5 pp. 385–499 + xii pls 363–370 Appendixes A & B (Appendix B)]]
- Clancy, G.P. 1980. White-rumped Swiftlet at Iluka, New South Wales. Australian Birds 15: 4
- Clancy, J.H. & Croft, D.B. 1989. Space-use patterns of the common wallaroo Macropus robustus erubescens in the arid zone. pp. 603-609 in Grigg, G., Jarman, P. & Hume, I. (eds). Kangaroos, Wallabies and Rat-Kangaroos. Sydney : Australian Mammal Society and Surrey Beatty 835 pp.
- Clancy, T.F. & Close, R.L. 1997. Queensland rock-wallabies - An overview of their conservation status, threats and management. Australian Mammalogy 19: 169-174
- Clancy, T.F. & Croft, D.B. 1990. Home range of the common wallaroo, Macropus robustus erubescens in far western New South Wales. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 659-673
- Clancy, T.F. & Croft, D.F. 1992. Population dynamics of the common wallaroo (Macropus robustus erubescens) in arid New South Wales. Wildlife Research 19: 1-16
- Clapham, P.J. 1996. The social and reproductive biology of humpback whales: An ecological perspective. Mammal Review 26: 27-49
- Clapperton, B.K. & Matthews, L.R. 1996. Trials of electric fencing for restricting the movements of common brushtail possums, Trichosurus vulpecula Kerr. Wildlife Research 23: 571-579
- Claridge, A.W. 1993. Fungal diet of the long-nosed bandicoot (Perameles nasuta) in south-eastern Australia. Victorian Naturalist 110: 86-91
- Claridge, A.W. & Cork, S.J. 1994. Nutritional value of hypogeal fungal sporocarps for the long-nosed potoroo (Potorous tridactylus), a forest dwelling mycophagus marsupial. Australian Journal of Zoology 42: 701-710
- Claridge, A.W. & Lindenmayer, D.B. 1993. The mountain brushtail possum (Trichosurus caninus Ogilby) : disseminator of fungi in the mountain ash forests of the Central Highlands of Victoria? Victorian Naturalist 110: 91-95
- Claridge, A.W. & Lindenmayer, D.B. 1998. Consumption of hypogeous fungi by the mountain brushtail possum (Trichosurus caninus) in eastern Australia. Mycological Research 102: 269-272
- Claridge, A.W. & May, T.W. 1994. Mycophagy among Australian mammals. Australian Journal of Ecology 19: 251-275
- Claridge, A.W., Cunningham, R.B. & Tanton, M.T. 1993. Foraging patterns of the long-nosed potoroo (Potorous tridactylus) for hypogeal fungi in mixed-species and regrowth eucalypt forest stands in southeastern Australia. Forest Ecology and Management 61: 75-90
- Claridge, A.W., Tanton, M.T. & Cunningham, R.B. 1993. Hypogeal fungi in the diet of the long-nosed potoroo (Potorous tridactylus) in mixed-species and regrowth eucalypt forest stands in south-eastern Australia. Wildlife Research 20: 321-337
- Claridge, A.W., Trappe, J.M. & Claridge, D.L. 2001. Mycophagy by the swamp wallaby (Wallabia bicolor). Wildlife Research 28: 643-645
- Clark, A.H. 1910. A new name for Psephotus multicolor. Auk 27: 80
- Clark, E. 1979. Red-Sea fishes of the family Tripterygiidae with descriptions of eight new species. Israel Journal of Zoology 28(2–3): 63-113 pls 1-5
- Clark, E. & George, A. 1979. Toxic soles, Pardachirus marmoratus from the Red Sea and P. pavoninus from Japan, with notes on other species. Environmental Biology of Fishes 4(2): 103-123 figs 1-13
- Clark, E. & Pohle, M. 1996. Trichonotus halstead, a new sand-diving fish from Papua New Guinea. Environmental Biology of Fishes 45: 1-11
- Clark, H.L. 1901. The pterylosis of Podargus: with notes on the pterylography of the Caprimulgi. Auk 18: 167-171
- Clark, H.L. 1906. The feather tracts of swifts and humming birds. Auk 23: 68-91
- Clark, R.J., Smith, D.G. & Kelso, L.H. 1978. Working Bibliography of Owls of the World, with summaries of current taxonomy and distributional status. Washington, D.C. : Raptor Information Center, National Wildlife Federation Scientific/Technical Series Vol. 1 319 pp.
- Clark, T.W., Gibbs, J.P. & Goldstraw, P.W. 1995. Some demographics of the extirpation from the wild of eastern barred bandicoots (Perameles gunnii) in 1988-91 near Hamilton, Victoria, Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 22: 289-297
- Clarke, C.J. 1965. A comparison between some Australian five-fingered lizards of the genus Leiolopisma Duméril and Bibron (Lacertilia: Scincidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 13: 577-592
- Clarke, F.E. 1878. On two new fishes. Transactions and Proceedings of the New Zealand Institute 10(30): 243-246 pl. 6
- Clarke, F.E. 1879. On some new fishes. Transactions and Proceedings of the New Zealand Institute 11(25): 291-295 pls 14-15 [1878]
- Clarke, F.E. 1897. On two new globe-fish. Transactions of the New Zealand Institute 29: 243-250
- Clarke, J. & Loudon, A.S.I. 1985. The effect of differences in herbage height on the grazing behaviour of lactating Bennett's wallabies (Macropus rufogriseus rufogriseus). Journal of Zoology, London 207: 537-544
- Clarke, J.K., Jones, M.E. & Jarman, P.J. 1989. A day in the life of a kangaroo: activities and movements of eastern grey kangaroos Macropus giganteus at Wallaby Creek. pp. 611-618 in Grigg, G., Jarman, P. & Hume, I. (eds). Kangaroos, Wallabies and Rat-Kangaroos. Sydney : Australian Mammal Society and Surrey Beatty 835 pp.
- Clarke, J.L., Jones, M.E. & Jarman, P.J. 1995. Diurnal and nocturnal grouping and foraging behaviours of free-ranging eastern grey kangaroos. Australian Journal of Zoology 43: 519-529
- Clarke, R.H. 2000. First record of the southern right whale dolphin, Lissodelphis peronii (Lacépède, 1804) (Odontocete: Delphinidae), from waters off South Australia. Transactions of the Royal Society of South Australia 124: 177-178
- Clarke, T.A. 1974. Some aspects of the ecology of stomiatoid fishes in the Pacific Ocean near Hawaii. Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 72(2): 337-351 figs 1-5
- Clarke, T.A. 1984. Diet and morphological variation in snipefishes, presently recognized as Macrorhamphosus scolopax, from southeast Australia: evidence for two sexually dimorphic species. Copeia 1984(3): 595-608
- Clarke, T.A. 1998. Pelagic fishes of the genus Eustomias (Melanostomiidae) presently associated with Eustomias achirus Parin and Pokhilskaya with description of five new species. Copeia 1998(3): 676-686
- Clarke, T.A. 2000. Review of nine species of north Atlantic Eustomias, subgenus Dinematochirus (Pisces: Stomiidae), with descriptions of two new species. Copeia 2000(1): 96-111
- Clarke, T.A. 2001. Pelagic fishes of the genus Eustomias, subgenus Dinematochirus (Stomiidae), in the Indo-Pacific, with the description of twelve new species. Copeia 2001(3): 683-699
- Clayton, M., Wombey, J., Mason, I.J., Chesser, R.T. & Wells, A. 1998. CSIRO List of Australian Vertebrates: A Reference with Conservation Status. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing iv 162 pp.
- Clayton, M., Wombey, J.C., Mason, I.J., Chesser, R.T. & Wells, A. 2005. CSIRO List of Australian Vertebrates: A Reference with Conservation Status. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing iv 162 pp.
- Clayton, M., Wombey, J.C., Mason, I.J., Chesser, R.T. & Wells, A. 2006. CSIRO List of Australian Vertebrates: A Reference with Conservation Status. Melbourne : CSIRO Publishing iv 162 pp.
- Clegg, S.M., Hale & Moritz, C. 1998. Molecular population genetics of the red kangaroo (Macropus rufus): mtDNA variation. Molecular Ecology 7: 679-686
- Cleland, J.B. 1918. The food of Australian birds. An investigation into the character of the stomach and crop contents. N.S.W. Dept. Agri. Sci. Bull. No. 15 112 pp.
- Cleland, J.B. & Sims, E.B. 1968. Food of the Glossy Black Cockatoo. South Australian Ornithologist 25: 47
- Clements, K.D. & Randall, J.E. 1996. Four new records of surgeonfishes (Perciformes: Acanthuridae) from the Great Barrier Reef. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 39(2): 339-342
- Clements, K.D., Alfaro, M.E., Fessler, J.L. & Westneat, M.W. 2004. Relationships of the temperate Australasian labrid fish tribe Odacini (Perciformes; Teleostei). Molecular Phylogenetics and Evolution 32: 575-587
- Clements, K.D., Jawad, L.A. & Stewart, A.L. 2000. The New Zealand triplefin Grahamina signata (Teleostei; Tripterygiidae): a junior synonym of G. gymnota from Tasmania. Journal of the Royal Society of New Zealand 30(4): 373-384 fig. 1
- Cleva, G.M., Stone, G.M. & Dickens, R.K. 1994. Seasonal changes in haematocrit in captive koalas (Phascolarctos cinereus). Australian Journal of Zoology 42: 233-236
- Cleva, G.M., Stone, G.M. & Dickens, R.K. 1994. Variation in reproductive parameters in the captive male koala (Phascolarctos cinereus). Reproduction, Fertility and Development 6: 713-720
- Cloquet, H. 1816. In, Dictionnaire des Sciences Naturelles, dans lequel on Traité Méthodiquement des Differens Etres de la Nature. Paris & Strasbourg.
- Cloquet, H. 1816. [Poissons]. In, Levrault, F.G. (ed.) Dictionnaire des Sciences Naturelles. Strasbourg Vol. 1 suppl. 138 pp.
- Cloquet, H. 1817. [Poissons]. In, Levrault, F.G. (ed.) Dictionnaire des Sciences Naturelles. Strasbourg Vol. 8 369 pp.
- Cloquet, H. 1819. [Poissons]. In, Levrault, F.G. (ed.) Dictionnaire des Sciences Naturelles. Strasbourg Vol. 15 543 pp.
- Close, R.L. 1984. Rates of sex chromosome loss during development in different tissues of the bandicoots Perameles nasuta and Isoodon macrourus (Marsupialia: Peramelidae). Australian Journal of Biological Sciences 37: 53-61
- Close, R.L. & Bell, J.N. 1990. Age estimation of pouch young of the allied rock-wallaby (Petrogale assimilis) in captivity. Australian Wildlife Research 17: 359-367
- Close, R.L., Eldridge, M.D.B., Bell, J.N. & Reside, J. 1994. A genetic study of the brush-tailed rock wallaby Petrogale penicillata in East Gippsland and relevance for management of the species in Victoria. Pacific Conservation Biology 1: 367-371
- Close, R.L., Ingleby, S., Oorschot, R.A.H. van, Gooley, A.A., Briscoe, D.A. & Sharman, G.B. 1988. Identification of rock-wallabies, Petrogale penicillata (Gray, 1825), from the Grampians, Victoria, and comparison with conspecifics by examination of chromosomes, blood proteins, cell surface antigens, parasites and morphology. Australian Journal of Zoology 36: 99-110
- Clout, M. 1989. Foraging behaviour of Glossy Black-Cockatoos. Australian Wildlife Research 16: 467-473 [Sclater, P.L. 1893. List of the dates of delivery of the sheets of the "Proceedings" of the Zoological Society of London, from the commencement in 1830 to 1859 inclusive. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 435–440]
- Clout, M.N. 1982. Determination of age in the brushtail possum using sections from decalcified molar teeth. New Zealand Journal of Zoology 9: 365-371
- Clout, M.N. 1982. Exploitation of brushtail possum populations in theory and practice. New Zealand Journal of Ecology 5: 29-35
- Clout, M.N. & Efford, M.G. 1984. Sex differences in the dispersal and settlement of brushtail possums (Trichosurus vulpecula). Journal of Animal Ecology 53: 737-749
- Clout, M.N. & Gaze, P.D. 1984. Brushtail possums (Trichosurus vulpecula Kerr) in New Zealand beech (Nothofagus) forest. New Zealand Journal of Ecology 7: 147-155
- Cloutier, R. & Ahlberg, P.E. 1996. Morphology, characters and interrelationships of basal sarcopterygians. pp. 445-479 in Stiassny, M.L.J., Parenti, L.R. & Johnson, G.D. (eds). Interrelationships of Fishes. San Diego : Academic Press 496 pp.
- Clutton-Brock, J. 1981. Domesticated Animals from Early Times. London : British Museum 208 pp.
- Clutton-Brock, T.H., Guinness, F.E. & Albon, S.D. 1982. Red Deer Behavior and Ecology of Two Sexes. Edinburgh : Edinburgh Univ. Press xxii 378 pp.
- Coates, B.J. 1985. The Birds of Papua New Guinea, including the Bismarck Archipelago and Bougainville. Non-Passerines. Alderley, Qld : Dove Publications Vol. 1 464 pp. 493 pls.
- Coates, B.J. 1990. The Birds of Papua New Guinea including the Bismarck Archipelago and Bougainville. Alderley : Dove Publications.
- Coblentz, B.E. 1978. The effect of feral goats (Capra hircus) on island ecosystems. Biological Conservation 13: 279-286
- Cocciolone, R.A. & Timms, P. 1992. DNA profiling of Queensland koalas reveals sufficient variability for individual identification and parentage determination. Wildlife Research 19: 279-287
- Cocco, A. 1829. Su di alcuni pesci de'mari di Messina. Giornale di Scienze, Lettere ed Arti per la Sicilia (Palermo) 7 26(77): 138-147
- Cocco, A. 1833. Cenni sui genera Ruvettus e sui caratteri che lo distinguone. Osservationes Peloritani 13: 18
- Cocco, A. 1833. Su di alcuni pesci de'mari di Messina. Giornale di Scienze, Lettere ed Arti per la Sicilia (Palermo) 42(124): 9-21 pl.
- Cocco, A. 1838. Su di alcuni Salmonidi del mare di Messina; lettera al Ch. D. Carle Luciano Bonaparte. Nuovi Annali delle Scienze Naturali. Bologna 1(2): 161-194 pls 5-8
- Cocco, A. 1839. Sopra un nuova genere di pesci dello famiglia de'Centrolofini e di una nuova species di Trachurus. Innominata Messina 3(7): 56-59
- Cochran, D.M. 1961. Type specimens of reptiles and amphibians in the United States National Museum. Bulletin of the United States National Museum 220: 1-291
- Cochran, D.M. & Goin, C.J. 1970. Frogs of Colombia. Bulletin of the United States National Museum 288: i-xii, 1-655
- Cochrane, J.A., Friend, J.A., Hill, S.J.E. 2005. Endozoochory and the Australian bluebell: consumption of Billardiera fusiformis (Labill.) Payer (Pittosporaceae) seeds by three mammal species at Two Peoples Bay Nature Reserve, Western Australia. Journal of the Royal Society of Western Australia 88: 191-196
- Cockburn, A. 1978. The distribution of Pseudomys shortridgei (Muridae: Rodentia) and its relevance to that of other heathland Pseudomys. Australian Wildlife Research 5: 213-219
- Cockburn, A. 1980. The diet of the New Holland Mouse (Pseudomys novaehollandiae) and the House Mouse (Mus musculus) in a Victorian coastal heathland. Australian Mammalogy 3: 31-34
- Cockburn, A. 1981. Diet and habitat preference of the Silky Desert Mouse, Pseudomys apodemoides (Rodentia). Australian Wildlife Research 8: 475-497
- Cockburn, A. 1981. Population processes of the Silky Desert Mouse Pseudomys apodemoides (Rodentia), in mature heathlands. Australian Wildlife Research 8: 499-514
- Cockburn, A. 1981. Population regulation and dispersion of the Smoky Mouse, Pseudomys fumeus 2. Spring decline, breeding success and habitat heterogeneity. Australian Journal of Ecology 6: 255-266
- Cockburn, A. 1981. Population regulation and dispersion of the Smoky Mouse, Pseudomys fumeus I. Dietary determinants of microhabitat preference. Australian Journal of Ecology 6: 231-254
- Cockburn, A. 1992. The duration of lactation in Antechinus stuartii (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 195-204
- Cockburn, A. 1995. Heath Rat Pseudomys shortridgei. pp. 617-618 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Cockburn, A. 1995. Silky Mouse Pseudomys apodemoides. pp. 585-586 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Cockburn, A. 1995. Smoky Mouse Pseudomys fumeus. pp. 598-599 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Cockburn, A. & Lazenby-Cohen, K.A. 1992. Use of nest trees by Antechinus stuartii, a semelparous lekking marsupial. Journal of Zoology, London 226: 657-680
- Cockburn, A., Braithwaite, R.W. & Lee, A.K. 1981. The response of the heath rat, Pseudomys shortridgei, to pyric succession: a temporally dynamic life-history strategy. Journal of Animal Ecology 50: 649-666
- Cockerell, T. D. A. 1916. Some Australian fish-scales. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 5: 52-57
- Cockrill, W.R. (ed.) 1974. The Husbandry and Health of the Domestic Buffalo. Rome : FAO/UN xvi 993 pp.
- Cocteau, J.T. 1836. Études sur les Scincoïdes. Paris.
- Cocteau, J.T. 1837. Tabulae synopticae Scincoideorum (rapport sur un ouvrage manuscrit de M. le Docteur Cocteau, par M. Duméril). Comptes Rendus (Hebdomadaires) des Séances de l'Academie des Sciences. Série D. Sciences Naturelles 4: 14-17
- Cocteau, J.T. 1838. Reptiles de l'île de Cuba. In Sagra, R. de la Histoire physique, politique et naturelle de l'île de Cuba. Paris : de Arthus Bertrand.
- Cogger, H. in Cogger, H., Cameron, E.E. & Cogger, H.M. 1983. Amphibia. pp. 1-56 in Walton, D.W. (ed.). Zoological Catalogue of Australia, Vol. 1. Amphibia and Reptilia. Netley, South Australia : Griffin Press Ltd vi 313 pp.
- Cogger, H., Cameron, E.E. & Cogger, H.M. 1983. Amphibia. pp. 1-56 in Walton, D.W. (ed.). Zoological Catalogue of Australia, Vol. 1. Amphibia and Reptilia. Netley, South Australia : Griffin Press Ltd vi 313 pp.
- Cogger, H.G. 1957. Investigations in the gekkonid genus Oedura Gray. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 82: 167-179
- Cogger, H.G. 1960. The ecology, morphology, distribution and speciation of a new species and subspecies of the genus Egernia (Lacertilia: Scincidae). Records of the Australian Museum 25: 95-105
- Cogger, H.G. 1964. The comparative osteology and systematic status of the gekkonid genera Afroedura Loveridge and Oedura Gray. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 89: 364-372
- Cogger, H.G. 1966. A new hylid frog from Australia. The Australian Zoologist 13: 220-227
- Cogger, H.G. 1970. First record of the pitted-shelled turtle, Carettochelys insculpta, from Australia. Search 1: 41
- Cogger, H.G. 1971. The reptiles of Lord Howe Island. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 96: 23-38
- Cogger, H.G. 1974. Thermal relations of the mallee dragon, Amphibolurus fordi (Lacertilia: Agamidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 22: 319-339
- Cogger, H.G. 1975. New lizards of the genus Pseudothecadactylus (Lacertilia: Gekkonidae) from Arnhem Land and northwestern Australia. Australian Museum Records 30: 87-97
- Cogger, H.G. 1975. The sea snakes of Australia and New Guinea. pp. 59-139 in Dunson, W. (ed.). The Biology of Sea Snakes. Baltimore : University Park Press.
- Cogger, H.G. 1978. Reproductive cycles, fat body cycles and socio-sexual behaviour in the mallee dragon, Amphibolurus fordi (Lacertilia: Agamidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 26: 653-672
- Cogger, H.G. 1979. Reptiles and Amphibians of Australia. Sydney : A.H. & A.W. Reed 608 pp.
- Cogger, H.G. 1983. in Cogger, H.G., Cameron, E.E. & Cogger, H.M. Amphibia and Reptiles. In Walton, D.W. (ed.) Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Vol. 1. Netley, South Australia : Griffin Press Ltd. vi 313 pp.
- Cogger, H.G. 1994. Reptiles and Amphibians of Australia. Sydney : Reed Books 788 pp. [with revised Appendix]
- Cogger, H.G. 1999. Reptiles and Amphibians of Australia. Sydney : Reed/Reed New Holland.
- Cogger, H.G. 2000. Reptiles and Amphibians of Australia. Sydney : Reed New Holland 808 pp.
- Cogger, H.G. 2002. This checklist.
- Cogger, H.G. & Lindner, D.A. 1969. Marine turtles in northern Australia. The Australian Zoologist 15: 150-159
- Cogger, H.G. & Lindner, D.A. 1974. Frogs and reptiles in fauna survey of the Port Essington District, Cobourg Peninsula, Northern Territory of Australia. In Frith, H.J. & Calaby, J.H. (eds) CSIRO Div. Wildl. Res. Tech. Pap. 28: 63–107.
- Cogger, H.G. & Lindner, D.A. 1974. Frogs and reptiles. Fauna Survey of the Port Essington District, Cobourg Peninsula, Northern Territory of Australia. In Frith, H.J. & Calaby, J.H. (eds) CSIRO Div. Wildlf. Tech. Pap. 28: 63–107.
- Cogger, H.G., Cameron, E.E. & Cogger, H.M. 1983. Amphibia and Reptiles. In Walton, D.W. (ed.) Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Vol. 1. Netley, South Australia : Griffin Press Ltd. vi 313 pp.
- Cogger, H.G., Cameron, E.E. & Cogger, H.M. 1983. Amphibia and Reptilia. In, Walton, D.W. (ed.). Zoological Catalogue of Australia. Canberra : Australian Government Publishing Service Vol. 1 313 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. 1958. A revision of the fishes of the subfamily Argentininae. Bulletin of the Florida State Museum. Biological Sciences 3(3): 93-172 figs 1-9
- Cohen, D.M. 1958. Two new species of Bathylagus from the western North Atlantic with notes on other species. Breviora 98: 1-9
- Cohen, D.M. 1961. A new genus and species of deepwater ophidioid fish from the Gulf of Mexico. Copeia 1961(3): 288-292
- Cohen, D.M. 1964. Suborder Argentinoidea. In, Olsen, Y.H. (ed.) Fishes of the Western North Atlantic. Memoir. Sears Foundation of Marine Research 1(4): 1-70 figs 1-20
- Cohen, D.M. 1966. A new tribe and a new species of ophidioid fish. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 79(28): 183-204 figs 1-5
- Cohen, D.M. 1973. Family Eretmophoridae. pp. 322-326 in Hureau, J.-C. & Monod, T. (eds). Checklist of the Fishes of the North-Eastern Atlantic and of the Mediterranean (CLOFNAM). Paris : UNESCO Vol. 1 683 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. 1973. Family Melanonidae. 327 in Hureau, J.-C. & Monod, T. (eds). Checklist of the Fishes of the North-Eastern Atlantic and of the Mediterranean (CLOFNAM). Paris : UNESCO Vol. 1 683 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. 1981. New and rare ophidiiform fishes from the eastern Atlantic: Canary Islands to the Cape of Good Hope. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 94(4): 1085-1103 figs 1-7
- Cohen, D.M. 1984. Gadiformes: overview. 259-265 figs 135-137 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Cohen, D.M. 1987. Notes on the bythitid fish genus Saccogaster with a new species from the Gulf of Mexico. Los Angeles County Museum of Natural History Contributions in Science 385: 1-4
- Cohen, D.M. 1990. Families Bregmacerotidae, Euclichthyidae, Gadidae. pp. 16-89 in Cohen, D.M., Inada, T., Iwamoto, T. & Scialabba, N. FAO Species Catalogue. Gadiform fishes of the world (order Gadiformes). An annotated and illustrated catalogue of cods, hakes, grenadiers and other gadiform fishes known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 10 442 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. 1990. Families Moridae, Muraenolepididae. pp. 346-384 in Cohen, D.M., Inada, T., Iwamoto, T. & Scialabba, N. FAO Species Catalogue. Gadiform fishes of the world (order Gadiformes). An annotated and illustrated catalogue of cods, hakes, grenadiers and other gadiform fishes known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 10 442 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. 1990. Family Melanonidae. 138 in Cohen, D.M., Inada, T., Iwamoto, T. & Scialabba, N. FAO Species Catalogue. Gadiform fishes of the world (order Gadiformes). An annotated and illustrated catalogue of cods, hakes, grenadiers and other gadiform fishes known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 10 442 pp.
- Cohen, D.M. & Atsaides, S.P. 1970. Additions to a revision of argentinine fishes. Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 68(1): 13-36 figs 1-13
- Cohen, D.M. & Davis, W.P. 1969. Vertical orientation in a new gobioid fish from New Britain. Pacific Science 23(3): 317-324 figs 1-3
- Cohen, D.M. & Hutchins, J.B. 1982. Description of a new Dinematichthys (Ophidiiformes : Bythitidae) from Rottnest Island, Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 9(4): 341-347 figs 1-3
- Cohen, D.M. & Nielsen, J.G. 1978. Guide to the identification of genera of the fish order Ophidiiformes with a tentative classification of the order. National Marine Fisheries Service (U.S.). Technical Report 417: 1-72 figs 1-103
- Cohen, D.M. & Nielsen, J.G. 1982. Spottobrotula amaculata, a new ophidiid fish from the Philippines. Copeia 1982(3): 497-500 fig. 1
- Cohen, D.M. & Nielsen, J.G. 2002. Diplacanthopoma kreffti (Pisces, Bythitidae), a new species from the northwest Australian shelf, with comments on the name D. alcockii Goode and Bean, 1896. Archive of Fishery and Marine Research 50(1): 11-15
- Cohen, D.M. & Robins, C.R. 1986. A review of the ophidiid fish genus Sirembo with a new species from Australia. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 22(2): 253-263 pls 1-2
- Cohen, D.M. & Rohr, B.A. 1993. Description of a giant circumglobal Lamprogrammus species (Pisces: Ophidiidae). Copeia 1993(2): 470-475 figs 1-2
- Cohen, D.M. (ed.) 1989. Papers on the systematics of gadiform fishes. Science Series. Natural History Museum of Los Angeles County 32: 1-262
- Cohen, D.M., Hensley, D.A. & Kimmel III, J.J. 1991. The deepsea ophidiid fish genus Lamprogrammus, a senior synonym of Bassobythites, with notes on the synonymy and distribution of L. brunswigi. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 38(2): 125-132
- Cohen, D.M., Inada, T., Iwamoto, T. & Scialabba, N. 1990. FAO Species Catalogue. Gadiform fishes of the world (order Gadiformes). An annotated and illustrated catalogue of cods, hakes, grenadiers and other gadiform fishes known to date. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 10 442 pp.
- Colagross, A.M.L. & Cockburn, A. 1993. Vigilance and groupings in the eastern grey kangaroo, Macropus giganteus. Australian Journal of Zoology 41: 325-334
- Cole, C.F. 1913. Description of a new Sericornis. The Emu 13(2): 74-75 [Date published 1 Oct 1913]
- Cole, C.F. 1919. Notes upon the food of the Yellow Parrot (Platycercus flaveolus). The Emu 18: 272-285
- Cole, J.R. & Gibson, D.F. 1990. Distribution of stripe-faced dunnarts Sminthopsis macroura and desert dunnarts S. youngsoni (Marsupialia: Dasyuridae) in the Northern Territory. Australian Mammalogy 14: 129-131
- Cole, J.R., Langford, D.G. & Gibson, D.F. 1994. Capture myopathy in Lagorchestes hirsutus (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). Australian Mammalogy 17: 137-138
- Colefax, A.N. 1956. New information on the corroboree frog (Pseudophryne corroboree Moore). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 80: 258-266
- Coleman, E. 1946. Foods of the Tawny Frogmouth. Victorian Naturalist 63: 111-115
- Coleman, E. 1946. Voices of the Frogmouth and his Nightjar relations. Victorian Naturalist 63: 123-125
- Coleman, G.J., O'Reilly, H.M. & Armstrong, S.M. 1989. Food-deprivation induced phase shifts in Sminthopsis macroura froggatti. Journal of Biological Rhythms 4: 49-60
- Coleman, J.D. & Green, W.O. 1984. Variations in the sex and age distributions of brush-tailed possum populations. New Zealand Journal of Zoology 11: 313-318
- Coleman, J.D., Green, W.Q. & Polson, J.G. 1985. Diet of brushtail possums over a pasture-alpine gradient in Westland, New Zealand. New Zealand Journal of Zoology 12: 21-35
- Coleman, N. 1974. Australian Marine Fishes in Colour. Sydney : A.H. & A.W. Reid 108 pp.
- Coleman, N. 1980. Australian Sea Fishes South of 30ºS. Lane Cove, NSW : Doubleday Australia Pty Ltd 309 pp.
- Coleman, N. 1981. Australian Sea Fishes North of 30°S. Lane Cove, NSW : Doubleday Australia Pty Ltd 297 pp.
- Coleman, N. 1996. Australia's Sharks & Rays. Frenchs Forest : National 63 pp.
- Coles, R.B. & Guppy, A. 1986. Biophysical aspects of directional hearing in the tammar wallaby, Macropus eugenii. Journal of Experimental Biology 121: 371-394
- Coles, R.B. & Lumsden, L. 1993. Report on the survey of bats in the heathland area of Cape York Peninsula. pp. 247-259 in Feeney, P. (ed.). Cape York Peninsula Scientific Expedition Report: Wet Season 1992. Brisbane : Royal Geographic Society of Queensland Vol. 2(4).
- Colgan, D., Flannery, T.F., Trimble, J. & Aplin, K. 1993. Electrophoresis and morphological analysis of the systematics of the Phalanger orientalis (Marsupialia) species complex in Papua New Guinea and the Solomon Islands. Australian Journal of Zoology 41: 355-378
- Colgan, D.J. & Flannery, T.F. 1992. Biochemical systematic studies in the genus Petaurus (Marsupialia: Petauridae). Australian Journal of Zoology 40: 245-256 [Thomas, O. 1888. Catalogue of the Marsupialia and Monotremata in the Collection of the British Museum (Natural History). London : British Museum xiii 401 pp. 28 pls [3 Nov. 1888]]
- Colgan, D.J. & Paxton, J.R. 1997. Biochemical genetics and recognition of a western stock of the common gemfish, Rexea solandri (Scombroidea: Gempylidae). Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 48(2): 103-118
- Collett, R. 1879. Fiske fra Nordhvas-Expeditiones sidste Togt, Sommeren 1878. Bulletin of the Mauritius Institute 1878(14): 1-106
- Collett, R. 1884. Echidna acanthion, en sandsynligvis ubeskreven art myre-pindsvin fra Nord-Queensland. Bulletin of the Mauritius Institute 1884(13): 1-12
- Collett, R. 1884. On some apparently new marsupials from Queensland. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1884: 381-389 pls 29-32 [1 Oct. 1884]
- Collett, R. 1886. On a pediculate fish from the sea off Madeira. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1886: 138-143 pl. 15
- Collett, R. 1887. On a collection of mammals from central and northern Queensland. Zoologische Jahrbücher 2: 829-940
- Collett, R. 1889. Diagnoses de poissons nouveaux provenant des campagnes de l'Hirondelle. III. Description d'une espèce nouvelle du genre Hoplostethus. Bulletin de la Société Zoologique de France 14: 306
- Collett, R. 1895. On a new Pseudochirus from N.W. Australia. Zoologischer Anzeiger 18(490): 464-468 [2 Dec. 1895]
- Collett, R. 1896. Poissons provenant des campagnes du yacht l'Hirondelle (1885–1888). Résultats des Campagnes Scientifiques accomplies par le Prince Albert I. Monaco 10: 1-198 pls 1-6
- Collett, R. 1897. On a collection of mammals from north and north-west Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1897: 317-336 pl. 23 [1 Aug. 1897]
- Collett, R. 1898. On some pigeons and parrots from north and north-west Australia. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1898: 353-357
- Collett, R. 1905. On some fishes from the sea off the Azores. Zoologischer Anzeiger 28(21/22): 723-730
- Collette, B.B. 1974. The garfishes (Hemiramphidae) of Australia and New Zealand. Records of the Australian Museum 29(2): 11-105 figs 1-23
- Collette, B.B. 1986. Family No. 249: Scombridae. pp. 831-838, 20 figs in Smith, M.M. & Heemstra, P.C. (eds). Smith's Sea Fishes. Johannesburg : Macmillan South Africa xx + 1047 pp. 144 pls.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Belonidae. pp. 2151-2161 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Coryphaenidae. pp. 2656-2658 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Echeneidae. pp. 2652-2654 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Hemiramphidae. pp. 2180-2196 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Pomatomidae. 2650 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Family Rachycentridae. 2655 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 4 2069-2790 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 1999. Mackerels, molecules, and morphology. pp. 149-164 in Séret, B. & Sire, J.-Y (eds). Proceedings of the 5th Indo-Pacific Fish Conference. Nouméa, 3-8 November 1997. Paris : Société Française d'Ichtyologie 888 pp.
- Collette, B.B. 2001. Ammodytidae. 3518 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Collette, B.B. 2001. Scombridae. pp. 3721-3756 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, T.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 6 pp. 3381-4218.
- Collette, B.B. 2003. Family Belonidae Bonaparte 1832 — needlefishes. California Academy of Sciences Annotated Checklists of Fishes 16: 1-22
- Collette, B.B. 2004. Family Hemiramphidae Gill 1859 — halfbeaks. California Academy of Sciences Annotated Checklists of Fishes 22: 1-35
- Collette, B.B. & Aadland, C.R. 1996. Revision of the frigate tunas (Scombridae, Auxis), with descriptions of two new subspecies from the eastern Pacific. Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 94(3): 423-441 figs 1-13
- Collette, B.B. & Banarescu, P. 1977. Systematics and zoogeography of the fishes of the family Percidae. Journal of the Fisheries Research Board of Canada 34(10): 1450-1463 figs 1-27
- Collette, B.B. & Berry, F.H. 1965. Recent studies on the needlefishes (Belonidae) : an evaluation. Copeia 1965(3): 386-392
- Collette, B.B. & Chao, L.N. 1975. Systematics and morphology of the bonitos (Sarda) and their relatives (Scombridae, Sardini). Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 73(3): 516-625 figs 1-70
- Collette, B.B. & Gillis, G.B. 1992. Morphology, systematics, and biology of the double-lined mackerels (Grammatorcynus, Scombridae). Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 90: 13-53, 27 figs
- Collette, B.B. & Nauen, C.E. 1983. FAO Species Catalogue. Scombrids of the world. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of tunas, mackerels, bonitos and related species known to date. Fisheries Synopsis No. 125, Vol. 2. Rome : FAO. 137 pp. 81 figs
- Collette, B.B. & Parin, N.V. 1970. Needlefishes (Belonidae) of the eastern Atlantic Ocean. Atlantide Report 11: 7-60 figs 1-13
- Collette, B.B. & Randall, J.E. 2000. Ammodytoides leptus, a new species of sand lance (Teleostei: Ammodytidae) from Pitcairn Island. Proceedings of the Biological Society of Washington 113: 397-400
- Collette, B.B. & Russo, J.L. 1980. Scomberomorus munroi, a new species of Spanish mackerel from Australia and New Guinea. Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 31(2): 241-250 figs 1-3
- Collette, B.B. & Russo, J.L. 1985. Interrelationships of the spanish mackerels (Pisces: Scombridae: Scomberomorus) and their copepod parasites. Cladistics 1(2): 151-158, figs 1-15
- Collette, B.B. & Russo, J.L. 1985. Morphology, systematics, and biology of the Spanish mackerels (Scomberomorus, Scombridae). Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 82: 545-692, 70 figs
- Collette, B.B. & Su, J.-X. 1986. The halfbeaks (Pisces, Beloniformes, Hemiramphidae) of the Far East. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 138: 250-302
- Collette, B.B., McGowen, G.E., Parin, N.V. & Mito, S. 1984. Beloniformes: development and relationships. 335-354 figs 172-185 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Collette, B.B., Potthoff, T., Richards, W.J., Ueyanagi, S., Russo, J.L. & Nishikawa, Y. 1984. Scombroidei: Development and Relationships. 591-620 in Moser, H.G. et al. (eds). Ontogeny and Systematics of Fishes. American Society of Ichthyologists and Herpetologists. Special Publication 1: 1-760
- Collette, B.B., Reeb, C. & Block, B.A. 2001. Systematics of the tunas and mackerels (Scombridae). pp. 1-33 in Block, B.A & Stevens, E.D. (eds). Tuna: Physiology, Ecology, and Evolution. Fish Physiology. London : Academic Press Vol. 19 350 pp.
- Collins, B.G., Wooller, R.D. & Richardson, K.C. 1988. Torpor by the honey possum, Tarsipes rostratus (Marsupialia: Tarsipedidae), in response to food shortage and low environmental temperature. Australian Mammalogy 11: 51-57
- Collins, C.T. & Brooke, R.K. 1976. A review of the swifts of the genus Hirundapus (Aves: Apodidae). Los Angeles County Museum of Natural History Contributions in Science 282: 1-22
- Collins, P. 1983. Morphological features of the surface of the subcommisural organ and aqueduct in the red necked wallaby (Wallabia rufogrisea). Journal of Anatomy 137: 665-674
- Collins, S.P. & Baron, M.P. 1981. Demersal and pelagic trawling survey of the M.T. Denebola in southern Australian waters, 1979–80 summer. Tasmanian Fisheries Research 24: 2-48 figs 1-22
- Collins, W.R. 1973. Monotremes and Marsupials a Reference for Zoological Institutions. Washington : Smithsonian Institution Press vi 323 pp.
- Collins, [D.] 1802. An Account of the English Colony of New South Wales, from its first settlement, in January 1788, to August 1801 …. London : T. Cadell jun. & W. Davies 2 xvi 336 pp.
- Coman, B.J. 1988. The age structure of a sample of red foxes (Vulpes vulpes L.) taken by hunters in Victoria. Australian Wildlife Research 15: 223-229
- Coman, B.J., Robinson, J. & Beaumont, C. 1991. Home range, dispersal and density of red foxes (Vulpes vulpes L.) in central Victoria. Wildlife Research 18: 215-223
- Commonwealth of Australia 2005. National Marine Bioregionalisation of Australia. Summary. Canberra : Department of Environment and Heritage 142 pp.
- Compagno, L J.V. & Stevens, J.D. 1993. Galeus gracilis n. sp., a new sawtail catshark from Australia, with comments on the systematics of the genus Galeus Rafinesque, 1810 (Carcharhiniformes: Scyliorhinidae). Records of the Australian Museum 45(2): 171-194
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1970. Systematics of the genus Hemitriakis (Selachii : Carcharhinidae), and related genera. Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 38(4): 63-98 figs 1-8
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1973. Gogolia filewoodi, a new genus and species of shark from New Guinea (Carcharhiniformes : Triakidae), with a redefinition of the family Triakidae and a key to triakid genera. Proceedings of the California Academy of Sciences 39(19): 383-410 figs 1-7
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1973. Interrelationships of living elasmobranchs. Journal of the Linnean Society of London, Zoology 53(suppl. 1): 15-61 pls 1-2
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1977. Phyletic relationships of living sharks and rays. American Zoologist 17(2): 303-322
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1984. FAO Species Catalogue. Sharks of the World. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of shark species known to date. Carcharhiniformes. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 4(2) 251-655 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1984. FAO Species Catalogue. Sharks of the World. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of shark species known to date. Hexanchiformes to Lamniformes. FAO Fisheries Synopsis No. 125. Rome : FAO Vol. 4(1) 1-249 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1984. Sharks. [unnumbered pages]. In, Fischer, W. & Bianchi, G. (eds) FAO Species Identification Sheets for Fishery Purposes. Western Indian Ocean (Fishing Area 51). Rome : FAO Vol. 5.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1988. Sharks of the Order Carcharhiniformes. Princeton, New Jersey : Princeton University Press 572 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Families Ginglymostomatidae, Stegostomatidae, Rhincodontidae. pp. 1260-1263 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Families Pseudocarchariidae, Alopiidae, Lamnidae. pp. 1268-1278 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Family Hemigaleidae. pp. 1305-1311 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Family Pristiophoridae. 1233 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Family Pseudotriakidae. 1296 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1998. Family Sphyrnidae. pp. 1361-1366 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1999. Checklist of living elasmobranchs. In, Hamlett, W.C. (ed.). Sharks, Skates, and Rays: the Biology of Elasmobranch Fishes. Baltimore & London : John Hopkins University Press 515 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 1999. Chimaeras. pp. 1532-1537 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 2001. Sharks of the World. An annotated and illustrated catalogue of shark species known to date. Bullhead, mackerel and carpet sharks (Heterodontiformes, Lamniformes and Orectolobiformes). Rome : FAO, FAO Species Catalogue for Fisheries Purposes No. 1 Vol. 2 269 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. 2003. Sharks. pp. 357-505 in Carpenter, K.E. (ed.). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Atlantic. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 1 601 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Families Gymnuridae, Myliobatidae, Rhinopteridae, Mobulidae. pp. 1505-1529 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Families Narkidae, Hypnidae, Torpedinidae. pp. 1443-1451 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Families Pristidae, Rhinidae, Rhinobatidae, Platyrhinidae. pp. 1410-1432 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Family Hexatrygonidae. pp. 1477-2478 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 1999. Family Plesiobatidae. pp. 1467-1468 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 3 1397-2068 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Last, P.R. 2008. A new species of wedgefish, Rhynchobatus palpebratus sp. nov. (Rhynchobatoidei: Rhynchobatidae), from the Indo–West Pacific. 227-240 in Last, P.R., White, W.T. & Pogonoski, J.J. (eds). Descriptions of new Australian chondrichthyans. CSIRO Marine and Atmospheric Research Paper No. 022: 1-358
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Families Scyliorhinidae, Proscylliidae. pp. 1279-1292 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Families Squatinidae, Heterodontidae, Parascylliidae, Brachaeluridae, Orectolobidae, Hemiscylliidae. pp. 1235-1259 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Family Carcharhinidae. pp. 1312-1360 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Family Odontaspididae. pp. 1264-1267 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Family Triakidae. pp. 1297-1304 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Niem, V.H. 1998. Hexanchidae, Echinorhinidae, Squalidae. pp. 1208-1232 in Carpenter, K.E. & Niem, V.H. (eds). The Living Marine Resources of the Western Central Pacific. FAO Species Identification Guide for Fisheries Purposes. Rome : FAO Vol. 2 687-1396 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Roberts, T.R. 1982. Freshwater stingrays (Dasyatidae) of Southeast Asia and New Guinea, with description of a new species of Himantura and reports of unidentified species. Environmental Biology of Fishes 7(4): 321-339 figs 1-12
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Springer, S. 1971. Iago, a new genus of carcharhinid sharks, with a redescription of I. omanensis. Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 69(3): 615-626
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Stevens, J.D. 1993. Atelomycterus fasciatus n. sp., a new catshark (Chondrichthyes: Carcharhiniformes: Scyliorhinidae) from tropical Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 45(2): 147-169
- Compagno, L.J.V. & Stevens, J.D. 1993. Hemitriakis falcata n. sp. and H. abdita n. sp., two new houndsharks (Carcharhiniformes: Triakidae) from Australia. Records of the Australian Museum 45(2): 195-220
- Compagno, L.J.V., Dando, M. & Fowler, S. 2005. A Field Guide to the Sharks of the World. London : Collins 368 pp.
- Compagno, L.J.V., Last, P.R., Stevens, J.D. & Alava, M.N.R. 2005. Checklist of Philippine Chondrichthys. CSIRO Marine Laboratory. Report 243: 1-103
- Compagno, L.J.V., Stehmann, M. & Ebert, D.A. 1990. Rhinochimaera africana sp. n., a new longnosed chimaera from southern Africa, with comments on the systematics and distribution of the genus Rhinochimaera Garman, 1901 (Chondrichthyes, Chimaeriformes, Rhinochimaeridae). South African Journal of Marine Science 9: 201-222
- Compagno, L.J.V., Stevens, J.D. & Last, P.R. 1999. Australian spotted catsharks of the genus Asymbolus (Carcharhinidae: Scyliorhinidae). Part 1: Descriptions of three new species from Western Australia. pp. 2-18, figs 1-3 in Last, P.R. (ed.). Australian catsharks of the genus Asymbolus (Carcharhiniformes: Scyliorhinidae). CSIRO Marine Laboratory. Report 239: 1-35, 6 figs
- Comport, S.S. & Hume, I.D. 1998. Gut morphology and rate of passage of fungal spores though the gut of a tropical rodent, the giant white-tailed rat (Uromys caudimaculatus). Australian Journal of Zoology 46: 461-471
- Comport, S.S., Ward, S.J. & Foley, W.J. 1996. Home ranges, time budgets, and food tree use in a high density tropical population of greater gliders, Petauroides volans minor (Pseudocheiridae, Marsupialia). Wildlife Research 23: 401-419
- Compton, A. & Johnson, P.M. 1983. Observations of the sheath-tailed bat, Taphozous saccolaimus Temminck (Chiroptera: Emballonuridae), in the Townsville region of Queensland. Australian Mammalogy 6: 83-87
- Conacher, M.J., Lanzing, W.J.R. & Larkum, A.W.D. 1976. Ecology of Botany Bay. II. Aspects of the feeding ecology of the fanbellied leatherjacket, Monacanthus chinensis (Pisces: Monacanthidae), in Posidonia australis seagrass beds in Quibray Bay, Botany Bay, New South Wales. Australian Journal of Marine and Freshwater Research 30: 387-400
- Conder, P. 1995. Dusky Flying-fox Pteropus brunneus. pp. 433-434 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Condon, H.T. 1941. Further records of lizards and frogs from Kangaroo Island. Records of the South Australian Museum 7: 111-116
- Condon, H.T. 1941. The Australian broadtailed parrots (subfamily Platycercinae). Records of the South Australian Museum 7: 117-144
- Condon, H.T. 1942. The Ground Parrot (Pezoporus wallicus) in South Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 16: 4-7
- Condon, H.T. 1951. Notes on the birds of South Australia: occurrence, distribution and taxonomy. South Australian Ornithologist 20: 26-68
- Condon, H.T. 1962. Australian quail-thrushes of the genus Cinclosoma. Records of the South Australian Museum 14: 337-370
- Condon, H.T. 1966. The Western Whipbird. Preliminary notes on the discovery of a new subspecies on southern Yorke Peninsula, South Australia. South Australian Ornithologist 24(5): 79-92 [Date published Mar 1966]
- Condon, H.T. 1968. A Handlist of the Birds of South Australia. 2nd Edn revised and enlarged. Adelaide : South Australian Ornithol. Assoc. 141 pp.
- Condon, H.T. 1969. A Handlist of the Birds of South Australia. Adelaide : South Australian Ornithologists Association 141 pp. [Date published 7/1/1969]
- Condon, H.T. 1969. A new subspecies of the Western Grass-wren, Amytornis textilis (Dumont) in north-western Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 15(3): 205-206 [Date published 28 May 1969]
- Condon, H.T. 1975. Checklist of the Birds of Australia. Part 1 Non-Passerines. Melbourne : Royal Australasian Ornithologists Union xx 311 pp.
- Condon, H.T. 1976. Vertebrate type-specimens in the South Australian Museum IV. Birds. Records of the South Australian Museum 17: 189-193
- Condé, B. 1977. Nouvelles observations sur les scorpénidés du genre Rhinopias à Maurice. Revue Française d'Aquariologie et Herpetologie 4: 19-20
- Connolly, J.H., Obendorf, D.L., Whittington, R.J. & Muir, D.B. 1998. Causes of morbidity and mortality in platypus (Ornithorhynchus anatinus) from Tasmania, with particular reference to Mucor amphibiorum infection. Australian Mammalogy 20: 177-187
- Connor, R.C., Heithaus, M.R. & Barre, L.M. 1999. Superalliance of bottlenose dolphins. Nature 397: 571-572
- Conole, L.E. 1996. The little pygmy-possum Cercartetus lepidus; an addition to the fauna of southwest-Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 113: 20-24
- Cook, J. 1773. An Account of the Voyages under taken by the Order of his present Majesty for Making Discoveries in the Southern Hemisphere and successively performed by Commodore Byron, Captain Wallis, Captain Carteret and Captain Cook. London : J. Hawkesworth 2 p. 18 pp. [Sclater, P.L. 1893. List of the dates of delivery of the sheets of the "Proceedings" of the Zoological Society of London, from the commencement in 1830 to 1859 inclusive. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 435–440 Mathews, G.M. 1914. Note on Platycercus (haematogaster), Gould. South Australian Ornithologist 1(2): 15–17]
- Cook, R. 1973. The wall lizard, Cryptoblepharus boutonii virgatus. Herpetofauna 6: 15-16
- Cooke, B.D. 1982. A shortage of water in natural pastures as a factor limiting a population of rabbits, Oryctolagus cuniculus (L.), in arid, north-eastern South Australia. Australian Wildlife Research 9: 65-476
- Cooke, B.D. 1983. Changes in the age-structure and size of populations of wild rabbits in South Australia, following the introduction of European rabbit fleas, Spilopsyllus cuniculi (Dale), as vectors of myxomatosis. Australian Wildlife Research 10: 105-120
- Cooke, B.D. 1996. Analysis of the spread of rabbit calicivirus from Wardang Island through mainland Australia. Australian & New Zealand rabbit calicivirus disease program, Canberra. 25 pp.
- Cooke, B.N. 1979. Field observations of the behaviour of the macropod marsupial Thylogale stigmatica (Gould). Unpublished M.Sc. thesis, Brisbane : University of Queensland.
- Cooper, D.W. & McKenzie, M. 1997. Genetics of tammar wallabies. pp. 120-131 in Saunder, N.R. & Hinds, L.A. (eds). Marsupial Biology: Recent research, new perspectives. Sydney : University of N.S.W. Press 413 pp.
- Cooper, D.W. & Woolley, P. 1983. Confirmation of a new species of small dasyurid marsupial by electrophoretic analysis of enzymes and proteins. Australian Journal of Zoology 31: 743-751
- Cooper, D.W., Johnston, P.G., Vandeberg, J.L. & Robinson, E.S. 1990. X-chromosome inactivation in marsupials. Australian Journal of Zoology 37: 467-479
- Cooper, J.A. & Chapleau, F. 1998. Monophyly and intrarelationships of the family Pleuronectidae (Pleuronectiformes), with a revised classification. Fishery Bulletin (U.S.) 69(4): 686-726
- Cooper, J.A., Graham, K. & Chapleau, F. 1994. New record of the tongue flatfish, Plagiopsetta glossa (Samaridae, Pleuronectiformes) from Australia. Japanese Journal of Ichthyology 41: 215-218
- Cooper, M.L. 1998. Geographic variation in size and shape in the southern brown bandicoot, Isoodon obesulus, (Peramelidae: Marsupialia) in Western Australia. Australian Journal of Zoology 46: 145-152
- Cooper, N.K. 1993. Identification of Pseudomys chapmani, P. hermannsburgensis, P. delicatulus and Mus musculus using footpad patterns. Western Australian Naturalist 19: 69-73
- Cooper, N.K. 1994. Identification of Pseudomys albocinereus, P. occidentalis, P. shortridgei, Rattus rattus and R. fuscipes using footpad patterns. Western Australian Naturalist 19: 279-283
- Cooper, N.K., Adams, M., Anthony, C. & Schmitt, L.H. 2003. Morphological and genetic variation in Leggadina (Thomas, 1910) with special reference to Western Australian populations. Records of the Western Australian Museum 21: 333-351
- Cooper, N.K., Aplin, K.P. & Adams, M. 2000. A new species of false antechinus (Marsupialia: Dasyuromorphia: Dasyuridae) from the Pilbara region, Western Australia. Records of the Western Australian Museum 20: 115-136
- Cooper, N.K., Bertozzi, T., Baynes, A. & Teale, R.J. 2003. The relationship between eastern and western population of the heath rat, Pseudomys shortridgei (Rodentia: Muridae). Records of the Western Australian Museum 21: 367-370
- Cooper, R.P. 1962. A revision of the distribution of the Brown Pigeon. The Emu 61: 253-269
- Cooper, S.J.B., Day, P.R., Reardon, T. & Schulz, M. 2000. Assessment of species boundaries in Australian Myotis (Chiroptera: Vespertilionidae) using mitochondrial DNA. Journal of Mammalogy 82: 328-338
- Cooper, S.J.B., Reardon, T.B. & Skilins, J. 1998. Molecular systematics of Australian rhinolophid bats (Chiroptera: Rhinolophidae). Australian Journal of Zoology 46: 203-220
- Cope, E.D. 1864. On the characters of the higher groups of Reptilia-Squamata and especially of the Diploglossa. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 1864: 224-231
- Cope, E.D. 1864. On the limits and relations of the Raniformes. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 1864: 181-183
- Cope, E.D. 1865. Sketch of the primary groups of Batrachia Salientia. Natural History Review 5: 97-120
- Cope, E.D. 1866. On the structure and distribution of the genera of arciferous Anura. Journal of the Academy of Natural Sciences, Philadelphia 2 6: 67-112
- Cope, E.D. 1867. On the families of raniform Anura. Journal of the Academy of Natural Sciences, Philadelphia 2 6: 189-206
- Cope, E.D. 1869. Observations on reptiles of the Old World. Article II. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 1868: 316-323
- Cope, E.D. 1869. Seventh contribution to the herpetology of tropical America. Proceedings of the American Philosophical Society 11: 147-169
- Cope, E.D. 1871. Contribution to the ichthyology of the Lesser Antilles. Transactions of the Australian Entomological Society 14(3): 445-483 figs 1-10
- Cope, E.D. 1889. The Batrachia of North America. Bulletin of the United States National Museum 34: 1-515
- Cope, E.D. 1892. On degenerate types of scapular and pelvic arches in the Lacertilia. Journal of Morphology 7: 227-244
- Copland, S.J. 1946. Catalogue of reptiles in the Macleay Museum I. Sphenomorphus pardalis (Macleay) and Sphenomorphus nigricaudis nigricaudis (Macleay). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 70: 291-311
- Copland, S.J. 1946. Geographic variation in the lizard Hemiergis decresiensis (Fitzinger). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 70: 62-92 [1945 on title page]
- Copland, S.J. 1947. Catalogue of reptiles in the Macleay Museum. II. Sphenomorphus spaldingi (Macleay). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 71: 136-144
- Copland, S.J. 1947. Taxonomic notes on the genus Ablepharus (Sauria: Scincidae). I. A new species from the Darling River. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 71: 282-286
- Copland, S.J. 1949. Taxonomic notes on the genus Ablepharus (Sauria: Scincidae). II. The race of Ablepharus burnetti Oudemans. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 73: 362-371 [1948 on title page]
- Copland, S.J. 1952. Taxonomic notes on the genus Ablepharus (Sauria: Scincidae). III. A new species from north-west Australia. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 77: 121-125
- Copland, S.J. 1953. Recent Australian herpetology. The blood vascular system of the trunk of the goanna Varanus varius (Shaw). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 78: v-xviii
- Copland, S.J. 1957. Presidential address. Australian tree frogs of the genus Hyla. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 82: 9-108
- Copland, S.J. 1960. A new tree-frog (genus Hyla) from Queensland. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 85: 154-156
- Copland, S.J. 1961. A new name for Hyla pearsoni, preoccupied. (Amphibia). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 86: 168
- Copland, S.J. 1962. Hyla phyllochrous Günther (Amphibia) as an addition to the fauna of Victoria, with the description of a new race and a note on the name of the genus. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 87: 137-140
- Copland, S.J. 1962. Rediscovery of a little known Victorian frog. Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 86: 258-261
- Copland, S.J. 1963. Size at metamorphosis of the frog Hyla aureus raniformis (Keferstein). Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales 88: 105-107
- Copley, P. 1988. The stick-nest rats of Australia. A final report to World Wildlife Fund (Australia). Department of Environment and Planning: Adelaide. 277 pp.
- Copley, P. 1999. Natural histories of Australia’s stick-nest rats, genus Leporillus (Rodentia: Muridae). Wildlife Research 26: 513-539
- Copley, P.B. & Alexander, P.J. 1997. Overview of the status of rock-wallabies in South Australia. Australian Mammalogy 19: 153-162
- Copley, P.B. & Robertson, A.C. 1983. Studies on the yellow-footed rock-wallaby, Petrogale xanthopus Gray (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). II. Diet. Australian Wildlife Research 10: 63-76
- Copley, P.B. & Robinson, A.C. 1983. Studies on the yellow-footed rock-wallaby, Petrogale xanthopus Gray (Marsupialia Macropodidae) II. Diet. Australian Wildlife Research 10: 63-76
- Copley, P.B., Read, V.T., Robinson, A.C. & Watts, A.C. 1990. Preliminary studies of the Nuyts Archipelago bandicoot Isoodon obesulus nauticus on the Franklin Islands, South Australia. pp. 345-356 in Seebeck, J.H., Brown, P.R., Wallis, R.L. & Kemper, C.M. (eds). Bandicoots and Bilbies. Chipping Norton : Surrey Beatty & Sons 392 pp.
- Copson, G.R. 1986. The diet of the introduced rodents Mus musculus L. and Rattus rattus L. on subantarctic Macquarie Island. Australian Wildlife Research 13: 441-445
- Corben, C. & Ingram, G.J. 1987. A new barred river frog (Myobatrachidae: Mixophyes). Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 26(1): 233-237
- Corben, C., Roberts, G. & Smyth, A. 1982. Roosting of a White-throated Needletail. Sunbird 12: 47-48
- Corben, C.J., Ingram, G.J. & Tyler, M.J. 1974. Gastric brooding: unique form of parental care in an Australian frog. Science (Washington, D.C.) 186: 946-947
- Corbet, G.B. 1978. The Mammals of the Palaearctic Region: A taxonomic review. London & Ithaca : British Museum & Cornell Univ. Press 314 pp.
- Corbet, G.B. 1983. A review of classification in the family Leporidae. Acta Zoologica Fennica 174: 11-15
- Corbet, G.B. & Hill, J.E. 1980. A World List of Mammalian Species. London : British Museum viii 226 pp.
- Corbett, L. 1995. Does dingo predation or buffalo competition regulate feral pig populations in the Australian wet-dry tropics? An experimental study. Wildlife Research 22: 65-74
- Corbett, L. 1995. The Dingo in Australia and Asia. Sydney : University of New South Wales Press 200 pp.
- Corbett, L.K. 1975. Geographical distribution and habitat of the marsupial mole, Notoryctes typhlops. Australian Mammalogy 1: 375-378
- Corbett, L.K. 1985. Morphological comparisons of Australian and Thai dingoes: A reappraisal of dingo status, distribution and ancestry. Proceedings of the Ecological Society of Australia 13: 277-291
- Corbett, L.K. 1995. Bali Banteng Bos javanicus. pp. 726-728 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Corbett, L.K. 1995. Dingo Canis lupus dingo. pp. 696-698 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Corbett, L.K. 1995. Swamp Buffalo Bubalus bubalis. pp. 723-725 in Strahan, R. (ed.). The Mammals of Australia: The National Photographic Index of Australian Wildlife. Sydney : Reed New Holland 756 pp.
- Corbett, L.K. 2004. Dingo Canis lupus dingo. pp. 223-230 in Sillero-Zubiri, C., Hoffmannm M. & Macdonald, D.W. (eds). Canids: Foxes, Woves, Jackals and Dogs : Status Survey and Conservation Action Plan. Gland, Switzerland and Cambridge, England : IUCN/SSC Canid Specialist Group.
- Corbett, L.K. & Newsome, A.E. 1987. The feeding ecology of the dingo. III. Dietary relationships with widely fluctuating prey populations in arid Australia: an hypothesis of alternation of predation. Oecologia (Berlin) 74: 215-227
- Corbin, K.W. 1968. Taxonomic relationships of some Columba species. Condor 70: 1-13
- Corfe, B. 1977. A sighting of the fig-parrot in south-east Queensland. Sunbird 8: 44
- Cork, S.J. 1986. Foliage of Eucalyptus punctata and the maintenance nitrogen requirements of koalas, Phascolarctos cinereus. Australian Journal of Zoology 34: 17-23
- Cork, S.J. 1990. Digestive physiology of koalas. Proceedings of the Australian Physiological and Pharmacological Society 21: 95-104
- Cork, S.J. & Dove, H. 1986. Milk consumption in late lactation in a marsupial, the tammar wallaby (Macropus eugenii). Proceedings of the Nutrition Society of Australia 11: 93
- Cork, S.J. & Dove, H. 1989. Lactation in the tammar wallaby (Macropus eugenii). II. Intake of milk components and maternal allocation of energy. Journal of Zoology, London 219: 399-409
- Cork, S.J. & Hume, I.D. 1983. Microbial digestion in the koala (Phascolarctos cinereus, Marsupialia), an arboreal folivore. Journal of Comparative Physiology B 152: 131-136
- Cork, S.J. & Pahl, L. 1984. The possible influence of nutritional factors on diet and habitat selection by the ringtail possum (Pseudocheirus peregrinus). pp. 269-276 in Smith, A. & Hume, I. (eds). Possums and Gliders. Sydney : Surrey Beatty & Sons, Australian Mammal Society 598 pp.
- Cork, S.J. & Warner, A.C.I. 1983. The passage of digesta markers through the gut of a folivorous marsupial, the koala Phascolarctos cinereus. Journal of Comparative Physiology B 152: 43-52
- Cork, S.J., Hume, I.D. & Dawson, T.J. 1983. Digestion and metabolism of a natural foliar diet (Eucalyptus punctata) by an arboreal marsupial, the koala (Phascolarctos cinereus). Journal of Comparative Physiology B 153: 181-190
- Corkeron, P.J. 1990. Aspects of the behavioural ecology of inshore dolphins, Tursiops truncatus and Sousa chinensis in Moreton Bay, Australia. pp. 285-294 in Leatherwood, S. & Reeves, R.R. (eds). The bottlenose dolphin. San Diego : Academic Press.
- Corkeron, P.J. 1995. Humpback whales (Megaptera novaeangliae) in Hervy Bay, Queensland: Behaviour and responses to whale-watching vessels. Canadian Journal of Zoology 73: 1290-1299
- Corkeron, P.J. & Bryden, M.M. 1991. Sightings of Risso's dolphin, Grampus griseus (Cetacea: Delphinidae) off Fraser Island, Queensland. Australian Mammalogy 15: 129-130
- Corkeron, P.J., Brown, M., Slade, R.W. & Bryden, M.M. 1994. Humpback whales, Megaloptera novaeangliae (Cetacea: Balaenopteridae), in Hervy Bay, Queensland. Wildlife Research 21: 293-305
- Corkeron, P.J., Bryden, M.M. & Hedstrom, K. 1990. Feeding by bottlenose dolphins in association with trawling operations in Moreton Bay, Australia. pp. 329-336 in Leatherwood, S. & Reeves, R.R. (eds). The bottlenose dolphin. San Diego : Academic Press.
- Corkerton, P.J., Morris, R.J. & Bryden, M.M. 1987. Interactions between bottlenose dolphins and sharks in Moreton Bay, Queensland. Aquatic Mammals 13: 109-113
- Cornell, C. 1974. The Journal of Post Captain Nicolas Baudin Commander-in-Chief of the Corvettes Geographe and Naturaliste. Adelaide : Library Board of South Australia 468 pp. [Sclater, P.L. 1893. List of the dates of delivery of the sheets of the "Proceedings" of the Zoological Society of London, from the commencement in 1830 to 1859 inclusive. Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London 1893: 435–440]
- Corrigan, S. & Beheregaray, L.B. 2009. A recent shark radiation: molecular phylogeny, biogeography and speciation of wobbegong sharks (family: Orectolobidae). Molecular Phylogenetics and Evolution 52: 205-216
- Costa, D.P. & Gales, N.J. 2003. Energetics of a benthic diver: Seasonal foraging ecology of the Australian sea lion, Neophoca cinerea. Ecological Monographs 73: 27-43
- Cotton, J. 1848. List of birds which frequent the upper portion of the River Goulburn in the district of Port Phillip, New South Wales. Tasmanian Journal of Natural Science 3(5): 361-365 [Date published Jul 1848]
- Coues, E 1882. The Coues check list of North American birds. Boston : Estes & Lauriat 165 pp.
- Coues, E. 1861. [Title]. Proceedings of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia 13: 190
- Coues, E. 1891. Scenopoetes dentirostris. Auk 8: 115 [Date published Jan 1891]
- Coulson, G. 1988. The history of kangaroo populations in Hattah-Kulkyne National Park, north-western Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 105: 68-73
- Coulson, G. 1989. Repertoires of social behaviour in the Macropodoidea. pp. 457-473 in Grigg, G., Jarman, P. & Hume, I. (eds). Kangaroos, Wallabies and Rat-Kangaroos. Sydney : Australian Mammal Society and Surrey Beatty 835 pp.
- Coulson, G. 1990. Applied behaviour: its role in conservation of the eastern barred bandicoot. pp. 77-87 in Clark, T.W. & Seebeck, J.H. (eds). Management and conservation of small populations. Brookfield : Chicago Zoological Society 295 pp.
- Coulson, G. 1990. Habitat separation in the grey kangaroos, Macropus giganteus Shaw and M. fuliginosus (Desmarest) (Marsupialia: Macropodidae), in Grampians National Park, Victoria. Australian Mammalogy 13: 219-221
- Coulson, G. 1993. The influence of population density and habitat on grouping in the western grey kangaroo, Macropus fuliginosus. Wildlife Research 20: 151-162
- Coulson, G. 1993. Use of heterogeneous habitat by the western grey kangaroo, Macropus fuliginosus. Wildlife Research 20: 137-149
- Coulson, G. 1996. A safe and selective draw-string trap to capture kangaroos moving under fences. Wildlife Research 23: 621-627
- Coulson, G. 1997. Repertoires of social behaviour in captive and free-ranging grey kangaroos, Macropus giganteus and Macropus fuliginosus (Marsupialia: Macropodidae). Journal of Zoology, London 242: 119-130
- Coulson, G. & Norbury, G. 1988. Ecology and management of western grey kangaroos (Macropus fuliginosus) at Hattah-Kulkine National Park. Arthur Rylah Institute for Environmental Research Technical Report Series. No. 72. 45 pp.
- Coulson, G. & Troy, S. 1992. First record of the eastern grey kangaroo, Macropus giganteus at Hattah-Kulkyne National Park, northwestern Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 109: 49-50
- Coulson, G., Norbury, G. & Walters, B. 1990. Forage biomass and kangaroo populations (Marsupialia: Macropodidae) in summer and autumn at Hattah-Kalkyne National Park, Victoria. Australian Mammalogy 13: 219-222
- Coulson, G.M. 1979. Extension of range of the western grey kangaroo, Macropus fuliginosus, in Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 97: 4-5
- Coulson, G.M. 1981. The management of forester kangaroos. 189-229 in Jones, R. (ed.). Exploited and endangered wildlife. Centre for Environmental Studies, University of Tasmania Occasional Papers No. 12
- Coulson, G.M. & Hutchinson, C. 1983. Extension of range of the eastern grey kangaroo, Macropus giganteus, in Victoria. Victorian Naturalist 100: 204-206
- Coulson, R.I. & Heron, D.C. 1981. Population, trade and management of the brush possum. 37-72 in Jones, R. (ed.). Exploitation of endangered wildlife. Centre for Environmental Studies, University of Tasmania Occasional Papers 12
- Coulter, A.R., Broad, A.J. & Sutherland, S.K. 1979. Isolation and properties of a high molecular weight neurotoxin from the eastern brown snake (Pseudonaja textilis). 160 in Chubb, I.W. & Greffen, L.B. (eds). Neurotoxins: Fundamental and Clinical Advances. Adelaide : Adelaide University Union Press.
- Couper, P.J. 1993. A new species of Lygisaurus de Vis (Reptilia: Scincidae) from mideastern Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 33(1): 163-166
- Couper, P.J. & Ingram, G.J. 1992. A new species of skink of Lerista from Queensland and a re-appraisal of L. allanae (Longman). Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 32(1): 55-59
- Couper, P.J. & Keim, L.D. 1998. Two new species of Saproscincus (Reptilia: Scincidae) from Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 42(2): 465-473
- Couper, P.J. & Pianka, E.R. 1997. Synonymy of Ctenotus monticola Storr, 1981 and Ctenotus hypatia Ingram and Czechura, 1990. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 42(1): 12
- Couper, P.J. in Couper, P.J. & Gregson, R.A.M 1984. Redescription of Nephrurus asper Günther, and description of N. amyae sp. nov. and N. sheai sp. nov. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 37(1): 67-81
- Couper, P.J., Amey, A.P. & Kutt, A.S. 2002. A new species of Ctenotus (Scincidae) from central Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 48: 85-91
- Couper, P.J., Covacevich, J.A. & Lethbridge, P.J. 1994. Carlia parrhasius, a new Queensland skink. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 35(1): 31-33
- Couper, P.J., Covacevich, J.A. & Moritz, C. 1993. A review of the leaf-tailed geckos endemic to eastern Australia: a new genus, four new species, and other new data. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 34(1): 95-124
- Couper, P.J., Covacevich, J.A. & Wilson, S.K. 1998. Two new species of Ramphotyphlops (Squamata: Typhlopidae) from Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 42(2): 459-464
- Couper, P.J., Covacevich, J.A., Marsterson, S.P. & Shea, G.M. 1996. Coggeria naufragus gen, et sp. nov., a sand-swimming skink from Fraser Island, Queensland. Memoirs of the Queensland Museum 39(2): 233-241
